Survey
* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
1 THE BRITISH LIBRARY THE UNITED STATES AND THE 1930S A SELECTIVE GUIDE TO MATERIALS IN THE BRITISH LIBRARY BY ANNE SHARP WELLS THE ECCLES CENTRE FOR AMERICAN STUDIES 2 INTRODUCTION Amid political turmoil and social unrest, the United States underwent tremendous changes during the 1930s. As the period began, domestic concerns related to the early stages of the Great Depression absorbed the country. By the close of 1939, the nation's involvement with international affairs had intensified, a course which would lead, in spite of strong isolationist sentiment, to formal participation in the Second World War. During the intervening period, Franklin D. Roosevelt succeeded Herbert C. Hoover as president and inaugurated the 'New Deal', a diverse collection of programs intended to alleviate the impact of the depression. In addition to transforming the size and role of the federal government, the New Deal affected institutions and individuals throughout the country in programs ranging, for example, from the electrification of rural homes to the establishment of the Social Security system to the reform of laws covering Native Americans. The country's detailed examination of its economy, society and culture throughout the decade resulted in a large body of printed works, photographs and art. The British Library holds a wealth of items, both contemporary and retrospective, about this important phase of United States history. This guide includes selected publications arranged by subject, geographical location or personal name. It does not contain journal articles. Each citation ends with the shelfmark in parentheses. The designation 'DSC' means that the work is held by the Document Supply Collections at Boston Spa but can be ordered for use at St. Pancras. 3 CONTENTS I. BIBLIOGRAPHIES, ENCYCLOPEDIAS AND HISTORICAL DICTIONARIES II. GENERAL STUDIES III. GOVERNMENT AND POLITICS A. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES B. BIOGRAPHIES AND PERSONAL NARRATIVES 1. DEWEY, THOMAS E. 2. HOOVER, HERBERT 3. HOPKINS, HARRY 4. HULL, CORDELL 5. ICKES, HAROLD 6. LANDON, ALFRED M. 7. MORGENTHAU, HENRY 8. PERKINS, FRANCES 9. ROOSEVELT, ELEANOR 10. ROOSEVELT, FRANKLIN D. 11. STIMSON, HENRY L. 12. TUGWELL, REXFORD G. 13. WELLES, SUMNER 14. COLLECTIVE BIOGRAPHIES AND OTHER WORKS C. PUBLIC OPINION D. PRESIDENCY 1. GENERAL STUDIES 2. HOOVER ADMINISTRATION 4 E. 3. ROOSEVELT ADMINISTRATION/NEW DEAL 4. ELECTIONS CONGRESS 1. GENERAL STUDIES 2. HOUSE COMMITTEE ON UN-AMERICAN ACTIVITIES F. FEDERALISM AND THE STATES G. JUDICIAL AND LEGAL SYSTEM H. FEDERAL BUREAU OF INVESTIGATION I. OPPOSITION PARTIES AND PROTEST MOVEMENTS [See also VIII.C. Foreign Relations: Isolationism, Pacifism and Neutrality] 1. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES 2. BONUS MARCH 3. COMMUNISM [See also VIII.F.2.i. Foreign Relations: of Soviet Socialist Republics] 4. COUGHLIN, CHARLES E. 5. LONG, HUEY P. [See also VII.A.19. U.S. States: Louisiana] 6. SOCIALISM AND RADICALISM 7. STUDENT ACTIVISM 8. TOWNSEND MOVEMENT Union IV. ECONOMY A. GENERAL STUDIES B. AGRICULTURE C. BANKING AND MONETARY POLICY D. ECONOMY AND FOREIGN AFFAIRS E. FARM SECURITY ADMINISTRATION [See also VI.R. Cultural and Intellectual History: Photography] 5 F. INCOME, WAGES, COST OF LIVING, DISTRIBUTION OF WEALTH G. INDUSTRY H. LABOR/WORKERS I. NATIONAL INDUSTRIAL RECOVERY ACT/NATIONAL RECOVERY ADMINISTRATION J. NATURAL RESOURCES, PUBLIC WORKS AND CONSERVATION GENERAL STUDIES 2. CIVILIAN CONSERVATION CORPS 3. PARKS 4. TENNESSEE VALLEY AUTHORITY K. RECONSTRUCTION FINANCE CORPORATION L. SHARECROPPERS AND TENANT FARMERS M. TAXATION N. TRANSPORTATION AND TRAVEL O. V. 1. 1. GENERAL STUDIES 2. AIR TRANSPORTATION 3. AUTOMOBILES 4. RAILROADS UTILITIES AND ENERGY SOCIAL HISTORY A. GENERAL STUDIES B. CHILDREN AND YOUTH C. CLOTHING D. CRIME 6 1. GENERAL STUDIES [See also III.G.; H. Government and Politics: Judicial and Legal System; Federal Bureau of Investigation] 2. LINDBERGH KIDNAPPING E. FAMILY F. FOOD G. HOUSING H. PHILANTHROPY I. POPULATION AND INTERNAL MIGRATION J. PROHIBITION K. RACIAL AND ETHNIC GROUPS 1. GENERAL STUDIES 2. AFRICAN AMERICANS a. GENERAL STUDIES b. COMMUNISM c. DRAMA, THEATRE AND MUSIC d. FOREIGN AND MILITARY AFFAIRS e. LABOR 3. HISPANICS 4. JEWS [See also IX.E. Foreign Relations: Immigration, Refugees, Jews and the Holocaust] 5. NATIVE AMERICANS L. RURAL LIFE M. TOWNS AND CITIES N. WELFARE, RELIEF AND SOCIAL SECURITY O. WOMEN 7 VI. CULTURAL AND INTELLECTUAL HISTORY A. BIBLIOGRAPHIES AND GUIDES B. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES C. ADVERTISING D. ARCHITECTURE AND INDUSTRIAL DESIGN E. CARTOONS: POLITICAL F. DANCE G. DRAMA AND THEATRE H. EDUCATION I. EXPOSITIONS AND WORLD FAIRS 1. GENERAL STUDY 2. CHICAGO CENTURY OF PROGRESS INTERNATIONAL EXPOSITION, 1933-1934 J. Regions 3. GOLDEN GATE INTERNATIONAL EXPOSITION, 1939 4. NEW YORK WORLD'S FAIR, 1939 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT [See also VII. U.S. States, and Territories] K. FILM L. JOURNALISM AND MASS MEDIA M. 1. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES 2. RADIO [See also III.I.4. Government and Politics: Opposition Parties and Protest Movements: Coughlin, Charles E.] LEISURE, RECREATION AND SPORTS 1. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES 2. OLYMPICS 8 VII. N. O. LIBRARIES LITERARY CRITICISM, COLLECTIONS AND MEMOIRS P. MEDICINE AND HEALTH Q. MUSIC R. PHOTOGRAPHY S. RELIGION [See also III.I.4. Government and Politics: Opposition Parties and Movements: Coughlin, Charles; V.K.4. Social History: Racial and Ethnic Groups: Jews] T. SCIENCE U. TECHNOLOGY AND TECHNOCRACY U.S. STATES, REGIONS AND TERRITORIES A. STATES 1. ALABAMA 2. ALASKA see TERRITORIES 3. ARIZONA 4. ARKANSAS 5. CALIFORNIA 6. COLORADO 7. CONNECTICUT 8. DELAWARE 9. DISTRICT OF COLUMBIA 10. FLORIDA 11. GEORGIA 12. HAWAII see TERRITORIES 13. IDAHO 14. ILLINOIS 9 15. 16. INDIANA IOWA 17. KANSAS 18. KENTUCKY 19. LOUISIANA [See also III.I.5. Government and Politics: Opposition Parties and Protest Movements: Long, Huey P.] 20. MAINE 21. MARYLAND 22. MASSACHUSETTS 23. MICHIGAN 24. MINNESOTA 25. MISSISSIPPI 26. MISSOURI 27. MONTANA 28. NEBRASKA 29. NEVADA 30. NEW HAMPSHIRE 31. NEW JERSEY 32. NEW MEXICO 33. NEW YORK [See also VI.I.4. Cultural and Intellectual History: Expositions and World Fairs: New York World's Fair, 1939] 34. NORTH CAROLINA 35. NORTH DAKOTA 36. OHIO 37. OKLAHOMA 38. OREGON 10 B. C. 39. PENNSYLVANIA 40. RHODE ISLAND 41. SOUTH CAROLINA 42. SOUTH DAKOTA 43. TENNESSEE 44. TEXAS 45. UTAH 46. VERMONT 47. VIRGINIA 48. WASHINGTON 49. WEST VIRGINIA 50. WISCONSIN 51. WYOMING REGIONAL STUDIES 1. GENERAL STUDIES 2. MIDWEST AND WEST 3. SOUTH [See also IV.J.4. Economy: Tennessee Valley Authority] TERRITORIES 1. GENERAL STUDIES 2. ALASKA 3. GUAM 4. HAWAII 5. PANAMA CANAL ZONE 6. PHILIPPINE ISLANDS 11 7. PUERTO RICO 8. VIRGIN ISLANDS VIII. MILITARY AFFAIRS IX. FOREIGN RELATIONS A. GENERAL STUDIES B. APPROACH TO ENTRY INTO SECOND WORLD WAR C. ISOLATIONISM, PACIFISM AND NEUTRALITY D. ARMAMENTS AND NAVAL LIMITATION E. IMMIGRATION, REFUGEES, JEWS, AND THE HOLOCAUST [See also V.K.4. Social History: Racial and Ethnic Groups: Jews] F. SPECIFIC AREAS 1. 2. REGIONS a. ASIA b. EUROPE c. MIDDLE EAST d. WESTERN HEMISPHERE COUNTRIES a. CANADA b. CUBA c. FRANCE d. GERMANY [See also VI.M.2. Cultural and Intellectual History: Leisure, Recreation and Sports: Olympics] e. ITALY f. MEXICO g. SPAIN 12 h. i. TURKEY UNION OF SOVIET SOCIALIST REPUBLICS [See also III.I.3. Government and Politics: Opposition Movements and Protest Movements: Communism] j. UNITED KINGDOM 13 I. BIBLIOGRAPHIES, ENCYCLOPEDIAS AND HISTORICAL DICTIONARIES BURKE, ROBERT E. and RICHARD LOWITT, comps. The New Era and the New Deal, 1920-1940. Arlington Heights, Ill.: Harlan Davidson, 1981, 215 pp. (X.800/36391) BURNS, RICHARD D. Herbert Hoover: A Bibliography of His Times and Presidency. Wilmington, Del.: Scholarly Resources, 1991, 247 pp. (DSC q95/10372) GRAHAM, OTIS L., JR. and MEGHAN R. WANDER, eds. Franklin D. Roosevelt: His Life and Times: An Encyclopedic View. Boston: G. K. Hall, 1985, 483 pp. (DSC 85/21712) THE GREAT DEPRESSION: A HISTORICAL BIBLIOGRAPHY. Santa Barbara, Calif., and Oxford, England: ABC-Clio Information Services, 1984, 260 pp. (X.800/38943) HIRATA, YOSHIHIKO. Prosperity, Great Depression and New Deal: A Bibliography of American Economy during the Interwar Period. Tokyo: Yushodo, 1972, 262 pp. (X.525/8134) KYVIG, DAVID E. and MARY-ANN BLASIO, comps. New Day/New Deal: A Bibliography of the Great American Depression, 1929-1941. New York and London: Greenwood, 1988, 306 pp. (2725.d.843) O'BRIEN, PATRICK G. Herbert Hoover: A Bibliography. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1993, 373 pp. (2725.g.1750) OLSON, JAMES S. Historical Dictionary of the 1920s: From World War I to the New Deal, 1919-1933. New York: Greenwood, 1988, 420 pp. (YA.1994.b.3488) OLSON, JAMES S. Historical Dictionary of the New Deal: From Inauguration to Preparation for War. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1985, 611 pp. (DSC 89/11383) STEWART, WILLIAM J., comp. The Era of Franklin D. Roosevelt: A Selected Bibliography of Periodical and Dissertation Literature, 1945-1966. Hyde Park, N.Y.: Franklin D. Roosevelt Library, 1967, 175 pp. (A.S.792/41) STEWART, WILLIAM J., comp. The Era of Franklin D. Roosevelt: A Selected Bibliography of Periodical, Essay and Dissertation Literature, 1945-1971. Hyde Park, N.Y.: Franklin D. Roosevelt Library, 1974, 360 pp. (A.S.258/73; A.S.288/73) TRACEY, KATHLEEN. Herbert Hoover: A Bibliography: His Writings and Addresses. Stanford, Calif.: Hoover Institution Press, 1977, 202 pp. (Ac:2692.nf/3(58)) II. GENERAL STUDIES 14 ALLEN, FREDERICK LEWIS. Since Yesterday: The Nineteen-thirties in America. London: Hamish Hamilton, London, 1940, 307 pp. (010410.a.31) BASKERVILLE, STEPHEN W. and RALPH WILLET, eds. Nothing Else to Fear: New Perspectives on America in the Thirties. Manchester: Manchester University Press, 1985, 294 pp. (X.809/67046; YH.1987.a.336) BEARD, CHARLES A. America Faces the Future. Boston and New York: Houghton Mifflin, 1932, 416 pp. (08229.pp.8) BEARD, CHARLES A. and MARY R. BEARD. America in Midpassage. London: Cape, 1939, 977 pp. (9605.i.3) BEARD, CHARLES A. and GEORGE H. E. SMITH. The Old Deal and the New. New York: Macmillan, 1940, 294 pp. (08175.a.38) BERNSTEIN, MICHAEL A. The Great Depression: Delayed Recovery and Economic Change in America, 1929-1939. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1987, 269 pp. (YH.1988.b.453) BRINKLEY, ALAN. The End of Reform: New Deal Liberalism in Recession and War. New York: Knopf, 1995, 371 pp. (DSC 95/15552) BURG, DAVID F. The Great Depression: An Eyewitness History. New York: Facts on File, 1996, 390 pp. (YK.1997.b.1769) CASHMAN, SEAN D. America in the Twenties and Thirties: The Olympian Age of Franklin Delano Roosevelt. New York and London: New York University Press, 1989, 632 pp. (YH.1989.b.454) CHAMBERS, CLARKE A., ed. The New Deal at Home and Abroad, 1929-1945. New York: Free Press; London: Collier-Macmillan, 1965, 273 pp. (X.0709/78.(9.)) CHANDLER, LESTER V. America's Greatest Depression, 1929-1941. New York: Harper and Row, 1970, 260 pp. (X.510/3016) CHASE, STUART. The Road We Are Traveling, 1914-1942: Guide Lines to America's Future. New York: Twentieth Century Fund, 1946, 106 pp. (X.529/17179); reprint, New York: Greenwood, 1968, 106 pp. (X.809/20964) CONGDON, DON, ed. The Thirties: A Time to Remember. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1962, 625 pp. (X.800/1525) DUBOFSKY, MELVIN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. The Great Depression and the New Deal. 2 vols. New York and London: Garland, 1990. (YC.1991.b.518; YC.1991.b.456) DULLES, ELEANOR L. Depression and Reconstruction: A Study of Causes and Controls. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1936, 340 pp. (8232.bb.56) 15 FRASER, STEVE and GARY GERSTLE, eds. The Rise and Fall of the New Deal Order, 1930-1980. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1989, 311 pp. (YH.1990.b.233) FRISCH, MORTON J. and MARTIN DIAMOND, eds. The Thirties: A Reconsideration in the Light of the American Political Tradition. De Kalb: Northern Illinois Press, 1968, 154 pp. (X.809/10290) GORDON, COLIN. New Deals: Business, Labor and Politics in America, 1920-1935. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994, 329 pp. (YC.1995.a.371) HEARN, CHARLES R. The American Dream in the Great Depression. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1977, 222 pp. (X.809/42700) HILL, KIM Q. Democracies in Crisis: Public Policy Responses to the Great Depression. Boulder, Colo.: Westview, 1988, 147 pp. (DSC 89/01920) KENNEDY, DAVID M. Freedom from Fear: The American People in Depression and War, 1929-1945. New York: Oxford University Press, 1999, 936 pp. (YC.1999.b.4895) KINDLEBERGER, CHARLES P. The World in Depression, 1929-1939. Rev. ed., Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1987, 355 pp. (YC.1988.a.549) LEIGHTON, ISABEL, ed. The Aspirin Age, 1919-41. London: Bodley Head, 1950, 491 pp. (10414.bb.15); Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1964, 495 pp. (12208.a.1/2110) LEUCHTENBURG, WILLIAM E. The Perils of Prosperity, 1914-32. Chicago: University of Chicago, 1958, 313 pp. (W.P.3542/6) MCCOY, DONALD R. Coming of Age: The United States during the 1920's and 1930's. Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1973, 364 pp. (X.708/41406); Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1977, 364 pp. (X.708/21088; X.708/41406) MCELVAINE, ROBERT S., ed. Down and Out in the Great Depression: Letters from the 'Forgotten Man'. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1983, 251 pp. (X.529/55566) MCELVAINE, ROBERT S. The Great Depression: America, 1929-1941. New York: Times Books, 1984, 402 pp. (YH.1988.b.780) MARQUIS, ALICE G. Hopes and Ashes: The Birth of Modern Times, 1929-1939. New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan, 1986, 274 pp. (DSC 87/03546) MELTZER, MILTON. Brother, Can You Spare a Dime? The Great Depression, 19291933. New York: Facts on File, 1991, 130 pp. (YC.1996.b.6590) MITCHELL, BROADUS. Depression Decade: From New Era through New Deal, 19291941. New York and Toronto: Rinehart, 1955, 462 pp. (W.P.1734/9) 16 NASH, GERALD D. The Crucial Era: The Great Depression and World War II, 19291945. 2d ed., New York: St. Martin's Press, 1992, 213 pp. (YK.1993.a.14572) PARRISH, MICHAEL E. Anxious Decades: America in Prosperity and Depression, 1920-1941. New York: Norton, 1992, 529 pp. (YA.1993.b.6849) PHILLIPS, CABELL. The New York Times Chronicle of American Life: From the Crash to the Blitz, 1929-1939. New York: Macmillan; London: Collier-Macmillan, 1969, 596 pp. (X.0800/683) ROBINSON, HENRY M. Fantastic Interim: A Hindsight History of American Manners, Morals and Mistakes between Versailles and Pearl Harbor. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1943, 341 pp. (10413.pp.22) ROTHBARD, MURRAY N. America's Great Depression. Princeton, N.J.: Van Nostrand, 1963, 361 pp. (08233.yy.5) SCOTT, QUINCY. Best of Quincy Scott: A Picture Panorama of the Turbulent Depression and World War II Years. Portland, Ore.: Oregon Historical Society, 1980, 196 pp. (DSC 81/21880) SELDES, GILBERT. The Years of the Locust (America, 1929-1932). Boston: Little, Brown, 1933, 355 pp. (08223.ee.74) SHANNON, DAVID A. Between the Wars: America, 1919-1941. 2d ed., Boston and London: Houghton Mifflin, 1979, 301 pp. (X.709/33191) SHANNON, DAVID A., ed. The Great Depression. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall, 1960, 171 pp. (8233.r.10) SIMON, RITA J., ed. As We Saw the Thirties: Essays on Social and Political Movements of a Decade. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1967, 253 pp. (X.709/6001) SHERWIN, MARK and CHARLES L. MARKMANN. One Week in March. [March 1-7, 1933] New York: Putnam's, 1961, 254 pp. (09057.i.25) SMITH, PAGE. Redeeming the Time: A People's History of the 1920's and the New Deal. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1987, 1205 pp. (DSC 89/12018) STEARNS, HAROLD E., ed. America Now: An Inquiry into Civilization in the United States by Thirty-six Americans. New York and London: Scribner's, 1938, 606 pp. (010410.l.19) STERNSHER, BERNARD, ed. Hitting Home: The Great Depression in Town and Country. Rev. ed., Chicago: Ivan R. Dee, 1989, 289 pp. (DSC 90/14659) STILLMAN, EDMUND. American Heritage History of the 1920's and 1930's. Reprint, New York: American Heritage/Bonanza Books, 1987, 416 pp. (YV.1989.b.1794) 17 TEMIN, PETER. Lessons from the Great Depression. Cambridge, Mass., and London: MIT Press, 1989, 193 pp. (YC.1991.a.3473) TERKEL, STUDS, ed. Hard Times: An Oral History of the Great Depression. London: Allen Lane, 1970, 462 pp. (X.520/3328) WATKINS, T. H. The Great Depression: America in the 1930s. Boston and London: Little, Brown: 1993, 375 pp. (YC.1995.a.2694) WATKINS, T. H. The Hungry Years: A Narrative History of the Great Depression in America. New York: Holt, 1999, 587 pp. (DSC 99/38063) WECTER, DIXON. The Age of the Great Depression, 1929-1941. New York: Macmillan, 1948, 362 pp. (Mic.A.10110) WERSTEIN, IRVING. A Nation Fights Back: The Depression and Its Aftermath. New York: Julian Messner, 1963, 191 pp. (X.519/3696) III. GOVERNMENT AND POLITICS A. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES ANDERSEN, KRISTI. After Suffrage: Women in Partisan and Electoral Politics before the New Deal. Chicago and London: University of Chicago, 1996, 191 pp. (DSC 96/26553) ANDERSEN, KRISTI. The Creation of a Democratic Majority, 1928-1936. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1979, 160 pp. (X.809/44756) BUNCHE, RALPH J. The Political Status of the Negro in the Age of FDR. Edited by Dewey W. Grantham. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1973, 682 pp. (X.800/8791) DONNELLY, THOMAS C., ed. Rocky Mountain Politics. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1940, 340 pp. (X.800/42068) DORSETT, LYLE W. The Pendergast Machine. New York: Oxford University Press, 1968, 163 pp. (X.709/6593) DOUGLAS, PAUL H. The Coming of a New Party. New York and London: McGraw-Hill Book Co., 1932, 236 pp. (08176.aa.37) GARRETT, CHARLES. The La Guardia Years: Machine and Reform Politics in New York City. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1961, 423 pp. (X.709/799) GIESKE, MILLARD L. Minnesota Farmer-Laborism: The Third-Party Alternative. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1979, 398 pp. (X.520/30230) 18 GOSNELL, HAROLD F. Machine Politics: Chicago Model. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1937, 229 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36.(35.)); 2d ed., Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1968, 247 pp. (X.708/4456) GOSNELL, HAROLD F. Negro Politicians: The Rise of Negro Politics in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1935, 404 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36(33.)); Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1967, 396 pp. (X.709/5487) HAYNES, JOHN E. Dubious Alliance: The Making of Minnesota's DFL Party. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1984, 264 pp. (DSC 84/22325) HEARD, ALEXANDER and DONALD S. STRONG. Southern Primaries and Elections, 1920-1949. Freeport, N.Y.: Books for Libraries Press, 1970, 206 pp. (YA.1992.b.2826) HICKS, JOHN D. Republican Ascendancy, 1921-1933. New York: Harper and Row, 1963, 317 pp. (W.P.c.131/31); London: Hamish Hamilton, 1960, 318 pp. (W.P.c.131/18) HUTHMACHER, JACOB J. Massachusetts People and Politics, 1919-1933. Cambridge, Mass.: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1959, 328 pp. (9088.ff.8) JENKIN, THOMAS P. Reactions of Major Groups to Positive Government in the United States, 1930-1940: A Study in Contemporary Political Thought. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1945, 408 pp. (Ac.2689.g/55) KELLEY, BEVERLY M., with JOHN J. PITNEY, CRAIG R. SMITH and HERBERT E. GOOCH III. Reelpolitik: Political Ideologies in '30s and '40s Films. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1998, 194 pp. (YC.1999.b.1138) KUZNICK, PETER J. Beyond the Laboratory: Scientists as Political Activists in 1930s America. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1987, 363 pp. (YK.1988.b.3806) LAWSON, RICHARD A. The Failure of Independent Liberalism, 1930-1941. New York: Putnam's, 1971, 322 pp. (X.809/16890) LEE, DAVID D. Tennessee in Turmoil: Politics in the Volunteer State, 1920-1932. Memphis, Tenn.: Memphis State University Press, 1979, 204 pp. (X.800/32229) LIPPMANN, WALTER. The Good Society. London: Allen & Unwin, 1938, 402 pp. (08008.cc.66) LIPPMANN, WALTER. The New Imperative. New York: Macmillan, 1935, 52 pp. (20020.c.53) LISIO, DONALD J. Hoover, Blacks and Lily-Whites: A Study of Southern Strategies. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1985, 373 pp. (DSC 85/29520) 19 LORENCE, JAMES J. Gerald J. Boileau and the Progressive-Farmer-Labor Alliance: Politics of the New Deal. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1994, 324 pp. (YC.1994.b.3865) MCADAM, DOUG. Political Process and the Development of Black Insurgency, 19301970. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1982, 304 pp. (X.520/30314) MATHEWS, THOMAS G. Puerto Rican Politics and the New Deal. Gainesville: University of Florida Press, 1960, 345 pp. (X.700/365) MICHIE, ALLAN A. and FRANK RHYLICH. Dixie Demagogues. New York: Vanguard Press, 1939, 298 pp. (20033.b.25) MILLER, JOHN E. Governor Philip F. La Follette, the Wisconsin Progressives and the New Deal. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1982, 229 pp. (DSC 83/01017) ORTQUIST, RICHARD T. Depression Politics in Michigan, 1929-1933. New York and London: Garland, 1982, 276 pp. (YA.1986.b.3188) PLOTKE, DAVID. Building a Democratic Political Order: Reshaping American Liberalism in the 1930s and 1940s. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1996, 388 pp. (YC.1996.b.4379) ROSENOF, THEODORE. Dogma, Depression and the New Deal: The Debate of Political Leaders over Economic Recovery. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1975, 155 pp. (X.529/30837) SCHRIFTGIESSER, KARL. This Was Normalcy: An Account of Party Politics during Twelve Republican Years, 1920-1932. Boston: Little, Brown, 1948, 325 pp. (08176.c.12) TATUM, ELBERT L. The Changed Political Thought of the Negro, 1915-1940. Reprint, Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1974, 205 pp. (X.809/21906) WEED, CLYDE P. The Nemesis of Reform: The Republican Party during the New Deal. New York and Chichester: Columbia University Press, 1994, 293 pp. (YC.1996.b.3474) WEISS, NANCY J. Farewell to the Party of Lincoln: Black Politics in the Age of FDR. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1983, 333 pp. (X.800/39339) WHITE, LEONARD D. Trends in Public Administration. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 365 pp. (X.800/1629.(4.)) B. BIOGRAPHIES AND PERSONAL NARRATIVES 1. Dewey, Thomas E. 20 BEYER, BARRY K. Thomas E. Dewey, 1937-1947: A Study in Political Leadership. New York and London: Garland, 1979, 368 pp. (X.800/32107) DEWEY, THOMAS E. The Case against the New Deal. New York and London: Harper, 1940, 165 pp. (08176.cc.4) HUGHES, RUPERT. Thomas E. Dewey, Attorney for the People. London: Constable, 1940, 315 pp. (10888.f.10) SMITH, RICHARD NORTON. Thomas E. Dewey and His Times. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1984, 703 pp. (X.800/42288) STOLBERG, MARY M. Fighting Organized Crime: Politics, Justice and the Legacy of Thomas E. Dewey. Boston: Northeastern University Press, 1995, 315 pp. (DSC 95/35704) 2. Hoover, Herbert C. BEST, GARY D. Herbert Hoover: The Postpresidential Years, 1933-1964. 2 vols. Stanford, Calif.: Hoover Institution Press, 1983, 522 pp. (YH.1987.b.151) BURNER, DAVID. Herbert Hoover: A Public Life. New York: Knopf, 1979, 433 pp. (X.800/30710) DODGE, MARK M., ed. Herbert Hoover and the Historians: Essays. West Branch, Iowa: Herbert Hoover Presidential Library Association, 1989, 141 pp. (DSC 95/32100) EMERSON, EDWIN. Hoover and His Times: Looking Back through the Years. Garden City, N.Y.: Garden City Pub. Co., 1932, 632 pp. (10881.pp.21) HOOVER, HERBERT C. Addresses upon the American Road, 1933-1938. New York: Scribner's, 1938, 390 pp. (20033.c.15) HOOVER, HERBERT C. The Challenge to Liberty. New York and London: Scribner's, 1934, 212 pp. (8004.e.26) HOOVER, HERBERT C. Further Addresses upon the American Road, 1938-1940. New York: Scribner's, 1940, 265 pp. (12302.b.1) HOOVER, HERBERT C. The Memoirs of Herbert Hoover. 3 vols. London: Hollis & Carter, 1952. (X.809/19057) HOOVER, HERBERT C. Shall We Send Our Youth to War? New York: CowardMcCann, 1939, 36 pp. (8011.aa.3) JOSLIN, THEODORE G. Hoover Off the Record. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1934, 367 pp. (010885.eee.14) 21 LOCHNER, LOUIS P. Herbert Hoover and Germany. New York: Macmillan, 1960, 244 pp. (9196.1.27) LYONS, EUGENE. Our Unknown Ex-President: A Portrait of Herbert Hoover. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, 1949, 340 pp. (10889.bb.22) MYERS, WILLIAM S., ed. The State Papers and Other Public Writings of Herbert Hoover. Edited by William S. Myers. 2 vols. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1934. (012295.c.6) NASH, LEE, ed. Understanding Herbert Hoover: Ten Perspectives. Stanford, Calif.: Hoover Institution Press, 1987, 196 pp. (YA.1989.b.7887) NYE, FRANK T. Doors of Opportunity: The Life and Legacy of Herbert Hoover. West Branch, Iowa: Herbert Hoover Presidential Library Association, 1988, 445 pp. (YA.1992.b.1539) ROBINSON, EDGAR E. and VAUGHN D. BORNET. Herbert Hoover, President of the United States. Stanford, Calif.: Hoover Institution Press, 1975, 398 pp. (X.800/26317; X.800/42789) SMITH, RICHARD N. An Uncommon Man: The Triumph of Herbert Hoover. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1984, 488 pp. (DSC 84/18482) WILSON, JOAN HOFF. Herbert Hoover: Forgotten Progressive. Boston: Little, Brown, 1975, 307 pp. (X.708/22232) WOOD, CLEMENT. Herbert Clark Hoover: An American Tragedy. New York: Michael Swain, 1932, 330 pp. (010885.ee.18) 3. Hopkins, Harry L. ADAMS, HENRY H. Harry Hopkins: A Biography. New York: Putnam, 1977, 448 pp. (X.800/14973) CHARLES, SEARLE F. Minister of Relief: Harry Hopkins and the Depression. Syracuse, N.Y.: Syracuse University Press, 1963, 286 pp. (X.519/3542) HOPKINS, HARRY L. Spending to Save: The Complete Story of Relief. Seattle and London: University of Washington Press, 1972, 197 pp. (X.529/15526) MCJIMSEY, GEORGE. Harry Hopkins: Ally of the Poor and Defender of Democracy. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1987, 474 pp. (YH.1988.b.484) 4. Hull, Cordell 22 BUTLER, MIC HAEL A. Cautious Visionary: Cordell Hull and Trade Reform, 19331937. Kent, Ohio, and London: Kent State University Press, 1998, 240 pp. (DSC 98/29466) GELLMAN, IRWIN F. Secret Affairs: Franklin D. Roosevelt, Cordell Hull and Sumner Welles. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1995, 499 pp. (YC.1995.b.4950) HULL, CORDELL. The Memoirs of Cordell Hull. 2 vols. London: Hodder & Stoughton, 1948. (10890.f.14) PRATT, JULIUS W. Cordell Hull, 1933-1944. 2 vols. New York: Cooper Square Pub., 1974, 840 pp. (X.0709/218.(12.); X.0709/218.(13.); X.709/3773) RIGGS, A. R. and TOM VELK. Cordell Hull, The New Deal and Inter-American Trade. Montreal: Dept. of Economics, McGill University, 1993, 17 pp. (DSC 9349.7383 2/93) 5. Ickes, Harold L. CLARKE, JEANNE N. Roosevelt's Warrior: Harold L. Ickes and the New Deal. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1996, 414 pp. (YC.1996.b.2589) ICKES, HAROLD L. The Autobiography of a Curmudgeon. New York: Reynal & Hitchcock, 1943, 350 pp. (10890.bb.11) ICKES, HAROLD L. Back to Work: The Story of PWA. New York: Macmillan, 1935, 276 pp. (8287.a.34) ICKES, HAROLD L. The Secret Diary of Harold L. Ickes. 3 vols. London: Weidenfeld & Nicolson, 1955. (W.P.d.134); A Reader's Guide to the People in The Secret Diary of Harold L. Ickes. (W.P.d.134a) WATKINS, T. H. Righteous Pilgrim: The Life and Times of Harold L. Ickes, 1874-1952. New York: Holt, 1990, 1010 pp. (YA.1993.b.4598) WHITE, GRAHAM and JOHN MAZE. Harold Ickes of the New Deal: His Private Life and Public Career. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1985, 263 pp. (YC.1988.b.6096) 6. Landon, Alfred M. MCCOY, DONALD R. Landon of Kansas. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1966, 607 pp. (X.800/4189) LANDON, ALFRED M. America at the Crossroads: Alfred M. Landon's Program for American Government, His Interpretation of the Political, Economic and Social Principles of the 23 Republican Party. Reprint, Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1971, 95 pp. (X.809/10427) PALMER, FREDERICK. This Man Landon: The Record and Career of Governor Alfred M. Landon of Kansas. Rev. ed., New York: Dodd, Mead, 1936, 332 pp. (X.808/9024) 7. Morgenthau, Henry BLUM, JOHN M. From the Morgenthau Diaries. Vol. 1, Years of Crisis, 1928-1938. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1959, 583 pp. (8221.e.6); Vol. 2, Years of Urgency, 19381941.. Cambridge, Mass.: Riverside Press; Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1965, 443 pp. (X.709/4529) EVEREST, ALLAN S. Morgenthau, the New Deal and Silver: A Story of Pressure Politics. New York: King's Crown Press, Columbia University, 1950, 209 pp. (8177.1.15) 8. Perkins, Frances MARTIN, GEORGE. Madam Secretary: Frances Perkins. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1976, 589 pp. (X.800/28712) MOHR, LILLIAN H. Frances Perkins: That Woman in FDR's Cabinet! Croton-onHudson, N.Y.: North River Press, 1979, 328 pp. (X.800/36983) PERKINS, FRANCES. The Roosevelt I Knew. New York: Viking, 1946, 408 pp. (10888.c.28); New York and London: Harper and Row, 1964, 409 pp. (X.709/2776) 9. Roosevelt, Anna Eleanor BEASLEY, MAURINE. The White House Press Conferences of Eleanor Roosevelt. New York and London: Garland, 1983, 354 pp. (X.809/59952) COOK, BLANCHE WIESEN. Eleanor Roosevelt. Vol. 1, 1884-1933. London: Bloomsbury, 1993. (YC.1993.b.7942) HOFF-WILSON, JOAN and MARJORIE LIGHTMAN, eds. Without Precedent: The Life and Career of Eleanor Roosevelt. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1984, 266 pp. (YA.1988.b.662) LASH, JOSEPH. Eleanor and Franklin: The Story of Their Relationship, Based on Eleanor Roosevelt's Private Papers. London: Deutsch, 1972, 765 pp. (X.800/6619) ROOSEVELT, ANNA ELEANOR. This is My Story. New York and London: Harper, 1937, 365 pp. (Cup.407.d.12); The Lady of the White House: An Autobiography. London: Hutchinson, 1938, 287 pp. (010883.ff.40); London: Hutchinson, 1938, 184 pp. (10888.a.18) 24 SCHARF, LOIS. Eleanor Roosevelt: First Lady of American Liberalism. Boston: Twayne, 1987, 202 pp. (YC.1991.b.3285) YOUNGS, J. WILLIAM T. Eleanor Roosevelt: A Personal and Private Life. Edited by Oscar Handlin. Boston: Little, Brown, 1985, 246 pp. (DSC 85/12463) 10. Roosevelt, Franklin D. ABBOTT, PHILIP. The Exemplary Presidency: Franklin D. Roosevelt and the American Political Tradition. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press, 1990, 233 pp. (YC.1991.a.490) ALSOP, JOSEPH. FDR, 1882-1945: The Life and Times of Franklin D. Roosevelt. London: Thames and Hudson, 1982, 255 pp. (X.805/2224) BUHITE, RUSSELL D. and DAVID W. LEVY, eds. FDR's Fireside Chats. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1992, 326 pp. (YC.1993.b.6057) BURNS, JAMES MACGREGOR. Roosevelt: The Lion and the Fox. London: Secker & Warburg, 1956, 553 pp. (10892.b.24) DAVIS, KENNETH S. FDR, Into the Storm, 1937-1940: A History. New York: Random House, 1993, 691 pp. (YA.1995.b.4215) DAVIS, KENNETH S. FDR: The New Deal Years, 1933-1937. New York: Random House, 1986, 756 pp. (DSC 86/25230) DAVIS, KENNETH S. FDR: The New York Years, 1928-1933. New York: Random House, 1985, 512 pp. (DSC 86/03601) FREIDEL, FRANK. F.D.R. and the South. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 102 pp. (X.708/3048) FREIDEL, FRANK. Franklin D. Roosevelt. 4 vols. Boston: Little, Brown, 19521973. (X.809/19213) FREIDEL, FRANK. Franklin D. Roosevelt: A Rendezvous of Destiny. Boston: Little, Brown, 1990, 710 pp. (YA.1991.b.6231) GORDENKER, LEON and J. W. SCHULTE NORDHOLT. FDR's Place in Past and Present: An Evaluation Forty Years After His Death. Middelburg, Netherlands: Roosevelt Study Center, 1986, 23 pp. (YA.1994.a.10549) GREER, THOMAS H. What Roosevelt Thought: The Social and Political Ideas of Franklin D. Roosevelt. London: Angus & Robertson; East Lansing: Michigan State University Press, 1958, 244 pp. (8178.c.24) HALASZ, NICHOLAS. Roosevelt Through Foreign Eyes. Princeton, N.J.: Van Nostrand, 1961, 340 pp. (10866.cc.26) 25 JOHNSON, GERALD W. Roosevelt: An American Study. London: Hamish Hamilton, 1942, 228 pp. (10889.b.2) JONES, ALFRED H. Roosevelt's Image Brokers: Poets, Playwrights and the Use of the Lincoln Symbol. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: National University Publications, Kennikat Press, 1974, 134 pp. (X.809/20378) LEUCHTENBURG, WILLIAM E. The FDR Years: On Roosevelt and His Legacy. New York and Chichester: Columbia University Press, 1995, 377 pp. (YC.1996.b.4686) MANEY, PATRICK J. The Roosevelt Presence: The Life and Legacy of FDR. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1998, 255 pp. (YC.1998.a.4955) MATLOFF, MAURICE. Mr. Roosevelt's Three Wars: FDR as War Leader. Colorado Springs, Colo.: U.S. Air Force Academy, 1964, 21 pp. (A.S.1030/4) MILLER, NATHAN. FDR: An Intimate History. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, 1983, 563 pp. (X.800/40780) MINNEN, CORNELIS A. VAN and JOHN F. SEARS, eds. FDR and His Contemporaries: Foreign Perceptions of an American President. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1992, 248 pp. (YC.1993.a.919) MORGAN, TED. FDR: A Biography. London: Grafton, 1986, 830 pp. (YC.1986.b.1566; YC.1988.a.10534) PERKINS, DEXTER. The New Age of Franklin Roosevelt, 1932-45. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1957, 193 pp. (W.P.3542/3) ROBINSON, EDGAR E. The Roosevelt Leadership, 1933-1945. Philadelphia and New York: Lippincott, 1955, 491 pp. (8178.b.1) ROOSEVELT, ELLIOTT, ed. As He Saw It. New York: Duell, Sloan & Pearce, 1946, 270 pp. (9103.k.34) ROOSEVELT, ELLIOTT, ed. The Roosevelt Letters, Being the Personal Correspondence of Franklin Delano Roosevelt. 3 vols. London: Harrap, 1949-1952. (10922.dd.23) ROOSEVELT, ELLIOTT and JAMES BROUGH. A Rendezvous with Destiny: The Roosevelts of the White House. London: W. H. Allan, 1977, 446 pp. (X.809/42271) ROOSEVELT, FRANKLIN D. Looking Forward. London: William Heinemann, 1933, 279 pp. (08176.a.39; X.529/16581) ROOSEVELT, FRANKLIN D. On Our Way. New York: John Day, 1934, 300 pp. (08176.a.45) 26 ROSENBAUM, HERBERT D. and ELIZABETH BARTELME, eds. Franklin D. Roosevelt: The Man, the Myth, the Era, 1882-1945. New York and London: Greenwood, 1987, 411 pp. (YH.1988.b.1347) ROSENMAN, SAMUEL I., ed. The Public Papers and Addresses of Franklin D. Roosevelt. 13 vols. New York: Random House, 1938-1950. (012296.e.4) ROSENMAN, SAMUEL I. Working with Roosevelt. London: Rupert Hart-Davis, 1952, 510 pp. (10890.fff.20) RYAN, HALFORD R. Franklin D. Roosevelt's Rhetorical Presidency. New York and London: Greenwood, 1988, 206 pp. (YC.1988.b.7450) SAVAGE, SEAN J. Roosevelt: the Party Leader, 1932-1945. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1991, 232 pp. (DSC 91/16437) SCHLESINGER, ARTHUR M. The Age of Roosevelt. 3 vols. London: Heinemann, 1957-1961. (W.P.5889/2(1-3)) THOMPSON, KENNETH W., ed. The Roosevelt Presidency: Four Intimate Perspectives of FDR. Washington, D.C.: University Press of America, 1982, 85 pp. (DSC 6555.869 no 1) VENN, FIONA. Franklin D. Roosevelt. London: Cardinal, 1990, 139 pp. (YC.1990.a.8934) WHITE, GRAHAM. FDR and the Press. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1979, 186 pp. (X.809/44494) WINFIELD, BETTY H. FDR and the News Media. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1990, 276 pp. (YA.1993.b.6235); New York and Chichester: Columbia University Press, 1994, 276 pp. (YC.1995.a.4833) ZEVIN, B. D., ed. Nothing to Fear: The Selected Addresses of Franklin Delano Roosevelt, 1932-1945. London: Hodder & Stoughton, 1947, 470 pp. (12302.bb.152) 11. Stimson, Henry L. CURRENT, RICHARD N. Secretary Stimson: A Study in Statecraft. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1954, 272 pp. (10892.bb.42) FERRELL, ROBERT H. Frank B. Kellogg-Henry L. Stimson. New York: Cooper Square Pub., 1963, 360 pp. (X.0709/218) HODGSON, GODFREY. The Colonel: The Life and Wars of Henry Stimson, 18671950. New York: Knopf, 1990, 402 pp. (YA.1993.b.5314) MORISON, ELTING E. Turmoil and Tradition: A Study of the Life and Times of Henry L. Stimson. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1960, 686 pp. (10865.gg.6) 27 STIMSON, HENRY L. The Far Eastern Crisis: Recollections and Observations. New York and London: Harper, 1936, 293 pp. (9059.cc.26) STIMSON, HENRY L. and MCGEORGE BUNDY. On Active Service in Peace and War. London: Hutchinson, 1949, 422 pp. (10891.bb.12); New York: Harper, 1948, 689 pp. (10891.c.12) 12. Tugwell, Rexford G. NAMORATO, MICHAEL V. Rexford G. Tugwell: A Biography. New York and London: Praeger, 1988, 192 pp. (YC.1988.b.7838) STERNSHER, BERNARD. Rexford Tugwell and the New Deal. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1964, 535 pp. (X.510/1167) TUGWELL, REXFORD G. The Art of Politics, as Practiced by Three Great Americans: Franklin Delano Roosevelt, Luis Munoz Marin and Fiorello H. La Guardia. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, 1958, 295 pp. (8025.ddd.8) TUGWELL, REXFORD G. The Battle for Democracy. New York: Columbia University Press, 1935, 330 pp. (20018.g.17) TUGWELL, REXFORD G. The Diary of Rexford G. Tugwell: The New Deal, 19321935. Edited by Michael V. Namorato. New York and London: Greenwood, 1992, 525 pp. (YC.1992.b.4357) TUGWELL, REXFORD G. FDR: Architect of an Era. New York: Macmillan, 1967, 270 pp. (X.709/5348) TUGWELL, REXFORD G. The Industrial Discipline and the Governmental Arts. New York: Columbia University Press, 1933, 241 pp. (20017.c.4) 13. Welles, Sumner GELLMAN, IRWIN F. Secret Affairs: Franklin D. Roosevelt, Cordell Hull and Sumner Welles. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1995, 499 pp. (YC.1995.b.4950) GRAFF, FRANK W. Strategy of Involvement: A Diplomatic Biography of Sumner Welles. New York and London: Garland, 1988, 459 pp. (YC.1991.b.3162) WELLES, BENJAMIN. Sumner Welles: FDR's Global Strategist: A Biography. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1997, 437 pp. (YC.1988.b.1399) 14. Collective Biographies and Other Works ALSOP, JOSEPH W. and ROBERT KINTNER. Men around the President. New York: Doubleday, Doran, 1939, 212 pp. (10888.a.9) 28 BARBER, JAMES G. and FREDERICK S. VOSS. Portraits from the New Deal. Washington, D.C.: published for the National Portrait Gallery by Smithsonian Institution Press, 1983, 40 pp. (YV.1987.b.790) COLE, WAYNE S. Senator Gerald P. Nye and American Foreign Relations. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1963, 293 pp. (9317.i.13) DAVIS, POLLY A. Alben W. Barkley: Senate Majority Leader and Vice President. London and New York: Garland, 1979, 343 pp. (X.809/49809) FARLEY, JAMES A. Behind the Ballots: The Personal History of a Politician. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1938, 392 pp. (20034.b.20) FARLEY, JAMES A. Jim Farley's Story: The Roosevelt Years. New York and Toronto: Whittlesey House, 1948, 388 pp. (X.700/3035) FINE, SIDNEY. Frank Murphy. 3 vols. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1975-1984. (X.0809/644) FRANKFURTER, FELIX. Felix Frankfurter Reminiscences. New York: Reynal, 1969, 310 pp. (10818.p.12; 10866.ff.37) FRANKFURTER, FELIX. From the Diaries of Felix Frankfurter. New York: Norton, 1975, 366 pp. (X.800/11115) HUTHMACHER, JACOB J. Senator Robert F. Wagner and the Rise of Urban Liberalism. New York: Atheneum, 1968, 362 pp. (X.800/5515) JAMES, MARQUIS. Mr. Garner of Texas. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill., 1939, 158 pp. (10888.b.18) ISRAEL, FRED L. Nevada's Key Pittman. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1963, 210 pp. (X.800/1794) JOHNSON, CLAUDIUS O. Borah of Idaho. New York and Toronto: Longmans, 1936, 511 pp. (010885.g.37); Seattle and London: University of Washington Press, 1967, 511 p. (X.709/6849) LIBBEY, JAMES K. Dear Alben: Mr. Barkley of Kentucky. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1979, 118 pp. (X.809/48914) LOWITT, RICHARD. George W. Norris: The Persistence of a Progressive, 1913-1933. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1971, 590 pp. (X.800/6696) LOWITT, RICHARD. George W. Norris: The Triumph of a Progressive, 1933-1944. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1978, 493 pp. (X.800/35892) 29 MCFARLAND, KEITH D. Harry H. Woodring: A Political Biography of FDR's Controversial Secretary of War. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1975, 346 pp. (X.800/28060) MCKENNA, MARIAN C. Borah. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1961, 450 pp. (10865.m.20) MADDOX, ROBERT J. William E. Borah and American Foreign Policy. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1969, 272 pp. (X.809/10112) MAY, IRVIN M. Marvin Jones: The Public Life of an Agrarian Advocate. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1980, 296 pp. (X.800/41195) MOLEY, RAYMOND. After Seven Years. New York: Harper, 1939, 446 pp. (X.809/18095; Mic.A.9219) MOONEY, BOOTH. Roosevelt and Rayburn: A Political Partnership. Philadelphia and New York: Lippincott, 1971, 228 pp. (X.809/15693) NEWMAN, ROGER K. Hugo Black: A Biography. 2d ed., New York: Fordham University Press, 1997, 741 pp. (YC.1999.a.3439) NORDIN, DENNIS S. The New Deal's Black Congressman: A Life of Arthur Wergs Mitchell. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1997, 320 pp. (YC.1998.b.362) OHL, JOHN K. Hugh S. Johnson and the New Deal. De Kalb: Northern Illinois University Press, 1985, 374 pp. (DSC 86/08043) ROLLINS, ALFRED B. Roosevelt and Howe. New York: Knopf, 1962, 479 pp. (X.709/2783) ROOSEVELT, FRANKLIN D. Roosevelt and Frankfurter: Their Correspondence, 19281945. London: Bodley Head, 1968, 772 pp. (X.700/3081) SALMOND, JOHN A. A Southern Rebel: The Life and Times of Aubrey Willis Williams, 1890-1965. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1983, 337 pp. (YA.1986.b.226) SANDILANDS, ROGER J. The Life and Political Economy of Lauchlin Currie: New Dealer, Presidential Adviser and Development Economist. Durham: Duke University Press, 1990, 441 pp. (YA.1993.b.7882) SCHACHT, JOHN N., ed. Three Progressives from Iowa: Gilbert N. Haugen, Herbert C. Hoover, Henry A. Wallace. Iowa City, Iowa: Centre for the Study of the Recent History of the United States, 1980, 80 pp. (X.800/37834) SHERWOOD, ROBERT E. Roosevelt and Hopkins: An Intimate History. New York: Harper, 1948, 979 pp. (X.709/4347) 30 SMITH, T. V. and ROBERT A. TAFT. Foundations of Democracy: A Series of Debates. New York: Knopf, 1939, 346 pp. (Mic.A.17179) STILES, LELA. The Man Behind Roosevelt: The Story of Louis McHenry Howe. Cleveland: World, 1954, 311 pp. (10892.dd.32) SWAIN, MARTHA H. Ellen S. Woodward: New Deal Advocate for Women. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1995, 275 pp. (YC.1996.b.6704) SWAIN, MARTHA H. Pat Harrison: The New Deal Years. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1978, 316 pp. (X.809/49765) TAFT, ROBERT A. The Papers of Robert A. Taft. Vol. 1, 1889-1939. Edited by Clarence Wunderlin, Jr. Kent, Ohio, and London: Kent State University Press, 1997, 620 pp. (YC.1998.b.3610) TIMMONS, BASCOM N. Garner of Texas: A Personal History. New York: Harper, 1948, 249 pp. (Mic.A.18190) TOMPKINS, C. DAVID. Senator Arthur H. Vandenberg: The Evolution of a Modern Republican, 1884-1945. East Lansing: Michigan State University Press, 1970, 312 pp. (X.800/7593) WALLACE, HENRY A. America Must Choose: The Advantages and Disadvantages of Nationalism, of World Trade and of a Planned Middle Course. New York: Foreign Policy Association; Boston: World Peace Foundation, 1934, 33 pp. (X.510/993) WALLACE, HENRY A. New Frontiers. London: Hamish Hamilton; New York: Reynal & Hitchcock, 1936, 314 pp. (8231.c.27) C. PUBLIC OPINION CANTRIL, HADLEY and MILDRED STRUNK. Public Opinion, 1935-1946. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1951, 1191 pp. (8289.k.5) GALLUP, GEORGE H. The Gallup Poll: Public Opinion, 1935-1971. New York: Random House, 1972. (Mic.A.17309) LEIGH, MICHAEL. Mobilizing Consent: Public Opinion and American Foreign Policy, 1937-1947. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 187 pp. (X.809/42070) D. PRESIDENCY 1. General Studies CORWIN, EDWARD S. The Presidency: Office and Powers: History and Analysis of Practice and Opinion. 2d ed., New York: New York University Press, 1941, 476 pp. (Ac.2686.ca.(4.)) 31 JOHNSON, WALTER. 1600 Pennsylvania Avenue: Presidents and the People, 19291959. Boston and Toronto: Little, Brown, 1960, 390 pp. (09080.b.85) ROSEN, ELLIOT A. Hoover, Roosevelt and the Brains Trust: From Depression to New Deal. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1977, 446 pp. (X.800/26299) WALCH, TIMOTHY and DWIGHT M. MILLER, eds. Herbert Hoover and Franklin D. Roosevelt: A Documentary History. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1998, 221 pp. (YC.1998.b.4150) 2. Hoover Administration BARBER, WILLIAM J. From New Era to New Deal: Herbert Hoover, the Economists and American Economic Policy, 1921-1933. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1985, 237 pp. (YC.1998.b.2016) DARLING, JAY N. As Ding Saw Herbert Hoover. Ames: Iowa State University Press, 1996, 144 pp. (YA.1998.a.12272) FAULKNER, HAROLD U. From Versailles to the New Deal: A Chronicle of the Harding-Coolidge-Hoover Era. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1950, 388 pp. (X.709/1384.(51.)) FAUSOLD, MARTIN L., ed. The Hoover Presidency: A Reappraisal. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1974, 224 pp. (X.800/26765) FAUSOLD, MARTIN L. The Presidency of Herbert C. Hoover. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1985, 288 pp. (YA.1990.b.3628) KROG, CARL E. and WILLIAM R. TANNER, eds. Herbert Hoover and the Republican Era: A Reconsideration. Lanham, Md., and London: University Press of America, 1984, 268 pp. (X.809/66274) LIEBOVICH, LOUIS. Bylines in Despair: Herbert Hoover, the Great Depression, and the U.S. News Media. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1994, 223 pp. (YC.1994.b.6954) MYERS, WILLIAM S. The Foreign Policies of Herbert Hoover, 1929-1933. New York and London: Scribner's, 1940, 259 pp. (08004.ee.59) MYERS, WILLIAM S. and WALTER H. NEWTON. The Hoover Administration: A Documented Narrative. New York and London: Scribner's, 1936, 553 pp. (20020.d.9) OLSON, JAMES S. Herbert Hoover and the Reconstruction Finance Corporation, 19311933. Ames: Iowa State University Press, 1977, 246 pp. (X.950/30416) 32 ROMASCO, ALBERT U. The Poverty of Abundance: Hoover, the Nation, the Depression. New York: Oxford University Press, 1965, 282 pp. (X.519/2157) SCHWARZ, JORDAN A. The Interregnum of Despair: Hoover, Congress and the Depression. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1970, 281 pp. (X.520/3937) SOBEL, ROBERT. Herbert Hoover at the Onset of the Great Depression, 1929-1930. Philadelphia: Lippincott, 1975, 113 pp. (X.709/33831) WARREN, HARRIS G. Herbert Hoover and the Great Depression. New York: Oxford University Press, 1959, 372 pp. (9617.g.29) WILSON, JOHN R. M. Herbert Hoover and the Armed Forces: A Study of Presidential Attitudes and Policy. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 275 pp. (YC.1993.b.5264) WOODDY, CARROLL H. The Growth of the Federal Government, 1915-1932. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1934, 577 pp. (X.800/1629.(12.)) 3. Roosevelt Administration/New Deal ADAMS, D. K. Franklin D. Roosevelt and the New Deal. London: Historical Association, 1979, 40 pp. (WP.3175/96) ALLSWANG, JOHN M. The New Deal and American Politics: A Study in Political Change. New York and Chichester: Wiley, 1978, 155 pp. (X.529/32767) BADGER, Anthony J. The New Deal: The Depression Years, 1933-1940. Basingstoke: Macmillan Education, 1989, 392 pp. (DSC 89/28131) BAILEY, STANLEY H. Mr. Roosevelt's Experiments. London: L. and Virginia Woolf at the Hogarth Press, 1935, 48 pp. (012211.bb.1/24) BEARD, CHARLES A. and GEORGE H. E. SMITH. The Future Comes: A Study of the New Deal. New York: Macmillan, 1933, 178 pp. (08207.e.59) BEST, GARY D. The Critical Press and the New Deal: The Press versus Presidential Power, 1933-1938. Westport, Conn.: Praeger, 1993, 198 pp. (DSC 93/10729) BEST, GARY D. Pride, Prejudice and Politics: Roosevelt versus Recovery, 1933-1938. New York and London: Praeger, 1991, 267 pp. (YC.1991.b.1715) BILES, ROGER. A New Deal for the American People. De Kalb: Northern Illinois University Press, 1991, 274 pp. (DSC 92/12245) BROGAN, DENIS W. The Era of Franklin D. Roosevelt: A Chronicle of the New Deal and Global War. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1950, 382 pp. (X.709/1384.(52.)); Roosevelt and the New Deal. London: Oxford University Press, 1952, 259 pp. (10889.aa.45) 33 CARTER, JOHN F. The New Dealers. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1934, 414 pp. (X.800/9380) CLAWSON, MARION. New Deal Planning: The National Resources Planning Board. Baltimore, Md., and London: published for Resources for the Future by Johns Hopkins University Press, 1981, 356 pp. (X.520/25283) COHEN, WILBUR J.,ed. The New Deal Fifty Years After: A Historical Assessment. Austin, Tex.: Lyndon Baines Johnson Library, 1984, 154 pp. (DSC 86/15672) CONKIN, PAUL K. FDR and the Origins of the Welfare State. New York: Crowell, 1967, 118 pp. (X.529/11337) CONKIN, PAUL K. The New Deal. 3rd ed., Arlington Heights, Ill.: Harlan Davidson, 1992, 122 pp. (DSC 92/13025) DICKINSON, MATTHEW J. Bitter Harvest: FDR, Presidential Power and the Growth of the Presidential Branch. Cambridge and New York: Cambridge University Press, 1997, 267 pp. (YC.1997.b.2654) DAYNES, BYRON W., WILLIAM D. PEDERSON and MICHAEL P. RICCARDS, eds. The New Deal and Public Policy. London: Macmillan, 1998, 293 pp. (YC.1998.a.1771) DORSETT, LYLE W. Franklin D. Roosevelt and the City Bosses. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1977, 134 pp. (X.809/42933) EDEN, ROBERT, ed. The New Deal and Its Legacy: Critique and Reappraisal. New York and London: Greenwood, 1989, 263 pp. (YC.1989.b.7468) EINAUDI, MARIO. The Roosevelt Revolution. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1959; London: Constable, 1960, 372 pp. (8025.b.8; 9088.g.15) ELIOT, THOMAS H. and THOMAS HOPKINSON Recollections of the New Deal: When the People Mattered. Boston: Northeastern University Press, 1992. (YA.1995.b.9461) FREIDEL, FRANK. Franklin D. Roosevelt and the New Deal . . . An Inaugural Lecture Delivered before the University of Oxford on 1 May 1956. Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1956, 19 pp. (9617.e.13) FREIDEL, FRANK B., ed. The New Deal and the American People. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall, 1964, 151 pp. (X.708/201) FRISCH, MORTON J. Franklin D. Roosevelt: The Contribution of the New Deal to American Political Thought and Practice. Boston: Twayne, 1975, 165 pp. (X.808/12228) 34 FUSFELD, DANIEL R. The Economic Thought of Franklin D. Roosevelt and the Origins of the New Deal. New York: Columbia University Press, 1956, 337 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(586.)) GRAHAM, OTIS L. An Encore for Reform: The Old Progressives and the New Deal. New York: Oxford University Press, 1967, 256 pp. (X.709/4835) HOSEN, FREDERICK E. The Great Depression and the New Deal: Legislative Acts in Their Entirety (1932-1933) and Statistical Economic Data (1926-1946). Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1992, 318 pp. (YC.1993.b.1655) JACOB, CHARLES E. Leadership in the New Deal: The Administrative Challenge. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall, 1967, 101 pp. (X.709/5551) KARL, BARRY D. Executive Reorganization and Reform in the New Deal: The Genesis of Administrative Management, 1900-1939. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1963, 292 pp. (X.709/2812) KELLER, MORTON, ed. The New Deal: What Was It? New York: Holt, Rinehart & Winston, 1963, 122 pp. (09136.I.9/2) KEMLER, EDGAR. The Deflation of American Ideals: An Ethical Guide for New Dealers. Reprint, Seattle and London: University of Washington Press, 1967, 184 pp. (X.709/6792) LASH, JOSEPH P. Dealers and Dreamers: A New Look at the New Deal. New York: Doubleday, 1988, 510 pp. (DSC 89/03357) LEUCHTENBURG, WILLIAM E. Franklin D. Roosevelt and the New Deal. New York: Harper and Row, 1963, 393 pp. (W.P.c.131/25) LEUCHTENBURG, WILLIAM E., ed. The New Deal: A Documentary History. New York: Harper and Row, 1968. (X.708/4341); Columbia: University of South Carolina Press, 1969, 263 pp. (X.800/4859) LEVINE, RHONDA F. Class Struggle and the New Deal: Industrial Labor, Industrial Capital and the State. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1988, 233 pp. (YC.1989.b.3039) LINDLEY, ERNEST K. The Roosevelt Revolution: First Phase. London: Victor Gollancz, 1934, 287 p. (08176.a.42); New York: Viking, 1933, 328 pp. (08176.aa.43) LOUCHHEIM, KATIE, ed. The Making of the New Deal: The Insiders Speak. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1983, 368 pp. (X.800/38819) POLENBERG, RICHARD, ed. Radicalism and Reform in the New Deal. Reading, Mass., and London: Addison-Wesley, 1972, 188 pp. (X.700/11660) 35 POLENBERG, RICHARD. Reorganizing Roosevelt's Government: The Controversy over Executive Reorganization, 1936-1939. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1966, 275 pp. (X.709/4794) RAUCH, BASIL. The History of the New Deal, 1933-1938. New York: Creative Age Press, 1944, 368 pp. (08176.a.62) ROMASCO, ALBERT U. Politics of Recovery: Roosevelt's New Deal. New York: Oxford University Press, 1965, 282 pp. (X.519/2157); New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1983, 276 pp. (X.809/58433) ROZELL, MARK J. and WILLIAM D. PEDERSON, eds. FDR and the Modern Presidency: Leadership and Legacy. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1997, 242 pp. (YC.1998.b.15) ROZWENC, EDWIN C., ed. The New Deal: Revolution or Evolution? Rev. ed., Boston: Heath, 1959, 113 pp. (9196.k.5) ROZWENC, EDWIN C. and THOMAS T. LYONS. Presidential Power in the New Deal. Boston: Heath, 1963, 66 pp. (8184.f.20) SALMOND, JOHN. The New Deal. London and New York: Frederick Warne, 1970, 44 pp. (X.809/9337) SARGENT, JAMES E. Roosevelt and the Hundred Days: Struggle for the Early New Deal. New York and London: Garland, 1981, 355 pp. (X.800/36853) SCHWARZ, JORDAN A. The New Dealers: Power Politics in the Age of Roosevelt. New York: Knopf, 1993, 411 pp. (YA.1994.b.9560) SELIGMAN, LESTER G. and ELMER E. CORNWELL, JR., eds. New Deal Mosaic: Roosevelt Confers with his National Emergency Council, 1933-1936. Eugene: University of Oregon, 1965, 578 pp. (X.702/332) SITKOFF, HARVARD, ed. Fifty Years Later: The New Deal Evaluated. Philadephia: Temple University Press, 1985, 240 pp. (DSC 85/11096) STEELE, RICHARD W. Propaganda in an Open Society: The Roosevelt Administration and the Media, 1933-1941. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1985, 231 pp. (YC.1988.a.3654) STERNSHER, BERNARD, ed. Hope Restored: How the New Deal Worked in Town and Country. Chicago: Ivan R. Dee, 1999, 247 pp. (DSC 99/30478) SUSSMANN, LEILA A. Dear FDR: A Study of Political Letter-Writing. Totawa: Bedminister Press, 1963, 194 pp. (X.709/5213) WANN, A. J. The President as Chief Administrator: A Study of Franklin D. Roosevelt. Washington, D.C.: Public Affairs Press, 1968, 219 pp. (X.800/5622) 36 4. Elections ALLEN, ROBERT S. Why Hoover Faces Defeat. New York: Brewer, Warren & Putnam, 1932, 118 pp. (20018.e.49) KENNEDY, JOSEPH P. I'm for Roosevelt. New York: Reynal & Hitchcock, 1936, 149 pp. (08175.c.35) KEY, V. O. The Responsible Electorate: Rationality in Presidential Voting, 1936-1960. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1966, 158 pp. (X.709/3148) MENCKEN, H. L. Making a President: A Footnote to the Saga of Democracy. New York: Knopf, 1932, 185 pp. (08176.a.36) OULAHAN, RICHARD. The Man Who . . . The Story of the 1932 Democratic National Convention. New York: Dial, 1971, 147 pp. (X.800/8012) PEEL, ROY V. and THOMAS C. DONNELLY. The 1932 Campaign: An Analysis. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1973, 242 pp. (YA.1986.a.3489) ROBINSON, EDGAR E. They Voted for Roosevelt: The Presidential Vote, 1932-1944. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1947, 207 pp. (8177.1.10) WHITE, WILLIAM ALLEN. What It's All About: Being a Reporter's Story of the Early Campaign of 1936. New York: Macmillan, 1936, 146 pp. (20029.ee.55) E. CONGRESS 1. General Studies COULTER, MATTHEW W. The Senate Munitions Inquiry of the 1930s: Beyond the Merchants of Death. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1977, 182 pp. (YC.1998.b.198) DETZER, DOROTHY. Appointment on the Hill. New York: Henry Holt, 1948, 262 pp. (10891.aa.21) FEINMAN, ROBERT L. Twilight of Progressivism: The Western Republican Senators and the New Deal. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1981, 262 pp. (DSC 4672.031, v.1 99th series) PATTERSON, JAMES T. Congressional Conservatism and the New Deal: The Growth of the Conservative Coalition in Congress, 1933-1939. Lexington: University of Kentucky Press, 1967, 369 pp. (X.709/10622) PORTER, DAVID L. Congress and the Waning of the New Deal. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: National University Publications, Kennikat Press, 1980, 169 pp. (X.809/49545) 37 PORTER, DAVID L. The Seventy-Sixth Congress and World War II, 1939-1940. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1979, 236 pp. (X.800/29169) SCHWARZ, JORDAN A. The Interregnum of Despair: Hoover, Congress and the Depression. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1970, 281 pp. (X.520/3937) WILTZ, JOHN E. In Search of Peace: The Senate Munitions Inquiry, 1934-1936. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1963, 277 pp. (X.631/703) 2. House Committee on Un-American Activities BENTLEY, ERIC, ed. Thirty Years of Treason: Excerpts from Hearings before the House Committee on Un-American Activities, 1938-1968. London: Thames and Hudson, 1972, 991 pp. (X.200/5920) DIES, MARTIN. The Trojan Horse in America. New York: Dodd, Mead, 1940, 366 pp. (08157.f.85) GOODMAN, WALTER. The Committee: The Extraordinary Career of the House Committee on Un-American Activities. London: Secker & Warburg, 1969, 564 pp. (X.700/3537) OGDEN, AUGUST R. The Dies Committee: A Study of the Special House Committee for the Investigation of Un-American Activities, 1938-1944. 2d ed., Washington, D.C.: Catholic University of America Press, 1945, 318 pp. (8177.e.35) O'REILLY, KENNETH. Hoover and the Un-Americans: The FBI, HUAC and the Red Menace. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1983, 411 pp. (YA.1986.b.271) F. FEDERALISM AND THE STATES BUCK, ARTHUR E. The Reorganization of State Governments in the United States. New York: Columbia University Press, 1938, 299 pp. (8282.p.1/16) CLARK, JANE P. The Rise of a New Federalism: Federal-State Cooperation in the United States. New York: Columbia University Press, 1938, 347 pp. (08286.eee.23) FINEGOLD, KENNETH and THEDA SKOCPOL. State and Party in America's New Deal. Madison and London: University of Wisconsin Press, 1995, 342 pp. (YC.1998.a.1987) MACMAHON, ARTHUR W. Administering Federalism in a Democracy. New York: Oxford University Press, 1972, 196 pp. (X.809/15103) METTLER, SUZANNE. Dividing Citizens: Gender and Federalism in New Deal Public Policy. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1998, 239 pp. (DSC 98/22624) 38 PATTERSON, JAMES T. The New Deal and the States: Federalism in Transition. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1969, 226 pp. (X.809/7076) G. JUDICIAL AND LEGAL SYSTEM ALSOP, JOSEPH W. and TURNER CATLEDGE. The 168 Days. New York: Doubleday, Doran, 1938, 312 pp. (20032.a.21) BRANT, IRVING. Storm Over the Constitution. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill, 1936, 294 pp. (20020.eee.43) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. Social Work and the Courts: Select Statutes and Judicial Decisions. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934, 610 pp. (Ac.2691.d/29.(6.)) CHADBOURN, JAMES H. Lynching and the Law. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina, 1933, 221 pp. (Ac.2685.kc.(60.)) CORWIN, EDWARD S. Court over Constitution: A Study of Judicial Review as an Instrument of Popular Government. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1938, 273 pp. (20032.a.45) CORWIN, EDWARD S. The Twilight of the Supreme Court: A History of Our Constitutional Theory. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1934, 237 pp. (20018.ff.35) COUDERT, FREDERIC R. The New Deal and the United States Supreme Court. Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1936, 57 pp. (Mic.A.10526(8)) CUSHMAN, BARRY. Rethinking the New Deal Court: The Structure of a Constitutional Revolution. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1998, 320 pp. (YC.1998.b.4045) DAWSON, NELSON L. Louis D. Brandeis, Felix Frankfurter and the New Deal. Hamden, Conn.: Archon Books, 1980, 272 pp. (X.200/47467) DOUGLAS, WILLIAM O. The Court Years, 1939-1975: An Autobiography. New York: Random House, 1980, 434 pp. (X.200/39704) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. The Law and the New Deal: Selected Articles on Legal Issues surrounding the Depression and Roosevelt's Policies. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 329 pp. (YC.1991.b.566) EMERSON, THOMAS I. Young Lawyer for the New Deal: An Insider's Memoir of the Roosevelt Years. Edited by Joan P. Emerson. Savage, Md.: Rowman & Littlefield, 1991, 337 pp. (YA.1993.b.3271) ERIKSSON, ERIK M. The Supreme Court and the New Deal: A Study of Recent Constitutional Interpretation. Rosemead, Calif.: Rosemead Review Press, 1940, 252 pp. (X.200/47210) 39 GERALD, JAMES E. The Press and the Constitution, 1931-1947. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1948, 173 pp. (11868.h.19) HENDEL, SAMUEL. Charles Evans Hughes and the Supreme Court. New York: King's Crown Press, 1951, 337 pp. (10891.bb.28) HOCKETT, JEFFREY D. New Deal Justice: The Constitutional Jurisprudence of Hugo L. Black, Felix Frankfurter and Robert H. Jackson. Lanham, Md., and London: Rowman & Littlefield, 1996, 322 pp. (YC.1997.a.1602) IRONS, PETER H. The New Deal Lawyers. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1982, 351 pp. (X.520/27971) JACKSON, ROBERT H. The Struggle for Judicial Supremacy: A Study of a Crisis in American Power Politics. New York: Knopf, 1941, 361 pp. (08175.bb.36) LEONARD, CHARLES A. A Search for a Judicial Philosophy: Mr. Justice Roberts and the Constitutional Revolution of 1937. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1971, 212 pp. (X.200/5561) LEUCHTENBURG, WILLIAM E. The Supreme Court Reborn: The Constitutional Revolution in the Age of Roosevelt. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1995, 350 pp. (YC.1997.a.2254) LIPPMANN, WALTER. The Supreme Court--Independent or Controlled? New York and London: Harper, 1937, 56 pp. (20031.aaa.10) MAIDMENT, RICHARD A. The Judicial Response to the New Deal: The U.S. Supreme Court and Economic Regulation, 1934-1936. Manchester: Manchester University Press, 1991. (YC.1991.a.5552) MANGUM, CHARLES S. The Legal Status of the Negro. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1940, 436 pp. (6618.bb.1) MASON, ALPHEUS T. The Supreme Court: Vehicle of Revealed Truth or Power Group, 1930-1937. Boston: Boston University Press, 1953, 58 pp. (Ac.2690.b/2) MURPHY, PAUL L. The Constitution in Crisis Times, 1918-1969. New York: Harper and Row, 1972, 570 pp. (W.P.c.131/42) PASCHAL, JOEL P. Mr. Justice Sutherland: A Man against the State. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1951, 267 pp. (10888.f.30) PEARSON, DREW and ROBERT S. ALLEN. The Nine Old Men. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1936, 325 pp. (06617.de.20) PEARSON, DREW and ROBERT S. ALLEN. Nine Old Men at the Crossroads. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1937, 57 pp. (20030.bb.37) 40 PRITCHETT, CHARLES H. The Roosevelt Court: A Study in Judicial Politics and Values, 1937-1947. New York: Octagon, 1963, 314 pp. (X.200/1590) PUSEY, MERLO J. The Supreme Court Crisis. New York: Macmillan, 1937, 108 pp. (20031.ee.15) SHAMIR, RONEN. Managing Legal Uncertainty: Elite Lawyers in the New Deal. Durham, N.C., and London: Duke University Press, 1995, 252 pp. (YC.1996.b.5569) STONE, I. F. The Court Disposes. New York: Covici, Friede, 1937, 127 pp. (Mic.A.10069) TUSHNET, MARK V. Making Civil Rights Law: Thurgood Marshall and the Supreme Court, 1936-1961. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1994, 339 pp. (YC.1994.b.4106) TUSHNET, MARK V. The NAACP's Legal Strategy Against Segregated Education, 1925-1950. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1987, 222 pp. (YC.1991.b.4992) UROFSKY, MELVIN I. Louis D. Brandeis and the Progressive Tradition. Boston: Little, Brown, 1981, 183 pp. (X.529/65750) H. FEDERAL BUREAU OF INVESTIGATION HOOVER, J. EDGAR. Masters of Deceit: The Story of Communism in America. London: J. M. Dent, 1958, 374 pp. (8177.m.54) KIRCHNER, L. R. Triple Cross Fire! J. Edgar Hoover and the Kansas City Union Station Massacre. Kansas City, Mo.: Janlar Books, 1993, 176 pp. (YA.1997.a.13158) LOWENTHAL, MAX. The Federal Bureau of Investigation. London: Turnstile Press, 1951, 559 pp. (6059.bb.56) LYSING, HENRY. Men Against Crime. New York: D. Kemp, 1938, 265 pp. (6057.t.2) NASH, JAY R. Citizen Hoover: A Critical Study of the Life and Times of J. Edgar Hoover and His FBI. Chicago: Nelson-Hall, 1972, 298 pp. (X.200/8811) O'REILLY, KENNETH. Hoover and the Un-Americans: The FBI, HUAC, and the Red Menace. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1983, 411 pp. (YA.1986.b.271) POWERS, RICHARD G. G-men: Hoover's FBI in American Popular Culture. Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press, 1983, 356 pp. (YA.1987.b.1604) THEOHARIS, ATHAN G. and JOHN STUART COX. The Boss: J. Edgar Hoover and the Great American Inquisition. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1988, 489 41 pp. (YA.1989.b.3835); London: Harrap, 1989, 489 pp. (YH.1989.b.974); London: Virgin, 1993, 545 pp. (YK.1993.a.16951) I. [See also Neutrality] OPPOSITION PARTIES AND PROTEST MOVEMENTS VIII.C. Foreign Relations: Isolationism, Pacifism and 1. Miscellaneous Studies BELL, LELAND V. In Hitler's Shadow: The Anatomy of American Nazism. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1973, 135 pp. (X.800/8554) BENNETT, DAVID H. Demagogues in the Depression: American Radicals and the Union Party, 1932-1936. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1969, 341 pp. (X.800/6557) BINGHAM, ALFRED M. Insurgent America: Revolt of the Middle-Classes. New York and London: Harper, 1935, 253 pp. (20020.h.8) BINGHAM, ALFRED M. and SELDEN RODMAN, eds. Challenge to the New Deal. New York: Falcon Press, 1934, 284 pp. (8231.d.18) BLACKORBY, EDWARD C. Prairie Rebel: The Public Life of William Lemke. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1963, 339 pp. (X.311/1023) JEANSONNE, GLEN. Gerald L. K. Smith: Minister of Hate. London: Yale University Press, 1989, 283 pp. (YH.1989.b.893) MCCOY, DONALD R. Angry Voices: Left-of-Center Politics in the New Deal Era. Lawrence: University of Kansas Press, 1958, 224 pp. (08052.k.20); reprint, Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1971, 224 pp. (X.809/10634) MCGINNIS, PATRICK E. Oklahoma's Depression Radicals: Ira M. Finley and the Veterans of Industry of America. New York: Lang, 1991, 192 pp. (YA.1993.b.1828) MILLS, OGDEN L. Liberalism Fights On. New York: Macmillan, 1936, 160 pp. (8004.ff.34) MILLS, OGDEN L. The Seventeen Million. New York: Macmillan, 1937, 143 pp. (20031.f.25) SCHONBACH, MORRIS. Native American Fascism during the 1930s and 1940s: A Study of Its Roots, Its Growth and Its Decline. New York and London: Garland, 1985, 507 pp. (YC.1988.b.1362) SHOVER, JOHN L. Cornbelt Rebellion: The Farmers' Holiday Association. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1965, 239 pp. (X.311/1349) 42 SMITH, GEOFFREY S. To Save a Nation: American Countersubversives, the New Deal and the Coming of World War II. New York: Basic Books, 1973, 244 pp. (X.800/9320; X.800/8482) WEINSTEIN, JAMES. Ambiguous Legacy: The Left in American Politics. New York: New Viewpoints, 1975, 179 pp. (X.709/31099) WOLFSKILL, GEORGE. The Revolt of the Conservatives: A History of the American Liberty League, 1934-1940. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1962, 303 pp. (X.519/2427) 2. Bonus March BEST, GARY D. FDR and the Bonus Marchers, 1933-1935. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1992. (YC.1992.a.3363) DANIELS, ROGER. The Bonus March: An Episode of the Great Depression. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1971, 370 pp. (X.809/17279) LISIO, DONALD J. The President and Protest: Hoover, MacArthur and the Bonus Riot. New York: Fordham University Press, 1994, 346 pp. (YC.1995.a.683) WATERS, WALTER W., as told to WILLIAM C. WHITE. B.E.F.: The Whole Story of the Bonus Army. New York: J. Day, 1933, 288 pp. (010409.ee.45) 3. Communism [See also VIII.F.2.i. Foreign Relations: Union of Soviet Socialist Republics] AARON, DANIEL. Writers on the Left: Episodes in American Literary Communism. New York: Harcourt, Brace & World, 1961, 460 pp. (W.P.16742/6); Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1977, 460 pp. (X.908/41541) ALEXANDER, ROBERT J. The Right Opposition: The Lovestoneites and the International Communist Opposition of the 1930s. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1981, 342 pp. (YH.1986.b.535) BILLINGSLEY, LLOYD. Hollywood Party: How Communism Seduced the American Film Industry in the 1930s and 1940s. Rocklin, Calif.: Forum, 1998. (DSC 99/17289) BROWDER, EARL R. Communism in the United States. London: Martin Lawrence, 1935, 352 pp. (8286.h.9) BROWDER, EARL R. The People's Front. London: Lawrence & Wishart, 1938, 354 pp. (20033.g.5; 20032.e.12) BROWDER, EARL R. The Second Imperialist War. New York: International Pub., 1940, 309 pp. (Mic.A.10154) CRENSHAW, FILES and KENNETH A. MILLER. Scottsboro, the Firebrand of Communism. Montgomery, Ala.: Brown Printing Co., 1936, 336 pp. (06617.df.18) 43 DYSON, LOWELL K. Red Harvest: The Communist Party and American Farmers. Lincoln and London: University of Nebraska Press, 1982, 259 pp. (X.529/50399) FONER, PHILIP S. and HERBERT SHAPIRO, EDS. American Communism and Black Americans: A Documentary History, 1930-1934. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1991, 381 pp. (YA.1992.b.5483) GITLOW, BENJAMIN. I Confess: The Truth about American Communism. New York: E. P. Dutton, 1940, 611 pp. (10888.g.4) GITLOW, BENJAMIN. The Whole of Their Lives: Communism in America--A Personal History and Intimate Portrayal of Its Leaders. New York: Scribner's, 1948, 387 pp. (8154.cc.46) HOOVER, J. EDGAR. Masters of Deceit: The Story of Communism in America. London: J. M. Dent, 1958, 374 pp. (8177.m.54) HOWE, IRVING and LEWIS A. COSER. The American Communist Party: A Critical History, 1919-1957. Boston: Beacon Press, 1957, 593 pp. (8177.1.60) KELLEY, ROBIN D. G. Hammer and Hoe: Alabama Communists during the Great Depression. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1990, 369 pp. (YA.1993.b.8285) KLEHR, HARVEY. The Heyday of American Communism: The Depression Decade. New York: Basic Books, 1984, 511 pp. (X.800/40598; X.800/43057) KLEHR, HARVEY, JOHN EARL HAYNES and FRIDRIKH IGOREVICH FIRSOV. The Secret World of American Communism. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1995, 348 pp. (YC.1995.b.3902) KLEHR, HARVEY, JOHN EARL HAYNES and KYRILL M. ANDERSON. The Soviet World of American Communism. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1998, 378 pp. (YC.1998.b.2936) LATHAM, EARL. The Communist Controversy in Washington: From the New Deal to McCarthy. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1966, 446 pp. (X.700/1898) LEVENSTEIN, HARVEY A. Communism, Anticommunism and the CIO. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1981, 364 pp. (X.800/31852) LIEBERMAN, ROBBIE. My Song Is My Weapon: People's Songs, American Communism and the Politics of Culture, 1930-1950. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1989, 201 pp. (YA.1994.b.3000) LYONS, EUGENE. The Red Decade: The Stalinist Penetration of America. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill, 1941, 423 pp. (8289.cc.11) 44 MYERS, CONSTANCE A. The Prophet's Army: Trotskyists in America, 1928-1941. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1977, 281 pp. (X.809/42532) NAISON, MARK. Communists in Harlem during the Depression. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1983, 355 pp. (X.800/40619) OTTANELLI, FRASER M. The Communist Party of the United States: From the Depression to World War II. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1991, 307 pp. (YA.1993.b.8864) RECORD, WILSON. The Negro and the Communist Party. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1951, 340 pp. (8177.n.7) RECORD, WILSON. Race and Radicalism: The NAACP and the Communist Party in Conflict. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1964, 237 pp. (Ac.2692.g/14.(25.)); Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1966, 237 pp. (X.708/3671) SCHWARTZ, LAWRENCE H. Marxism and Culture: The CPUSA and Aesthetics in the 1930s. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1980, 151 pp. (X.809/46019) WARREN, FRANK A. Liberals and Communism: The 'Red Decade' Revisited. Bloomington, London: Indiana University Press, 1966, 276 pp. (X.709/4152) 4. Coughlin, Charles E. ATHANS, MARY C. The Coughlin-Fahey Connection: Father Charles E. Coughlin, Father Denis Fahey, C.S.Sp., and Religious Anti-Semitism in the United States, 1938-1954. New York: Lang, 1991, 265 pp. (YA.1993.b.1393) BRINKLEY, ALAN. Voices of Protest: Huey Long, Father Coughlin and the Great Depression. New York: Knopf, 1982, 348 pp. (X.800/39958) CARPENTER, RONALD H. Father Charles E. Coughlin: Surrogate Spokesman for the Disaffected. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1998, 204 pp. (YC.1998.b.2878) COUGHLIN, CHARLES E. Father Coughlin's Radio Discourses, 1931-1932. Royal Oak, Mich.: Radio League of the Little Flower, 1932, 239 pp. (X.100/15175) COUGHLIN, CHARLES E. A Series of Lectures on Social Justice. Royal Oak, Mich.: Radio League of the Little Flower, 1935, 244 pp. (8287.de.98) MUGGLEBEE, RUTH. Father Coughlin of the Shrine of the Little Flower: An Account of the Life, Work and Message of Reverend Charles E. Coughlin. Boston: L. C. Page, 1933, 321 pp. (4987.bb.22) TULL, CHARLES J. Father Coughlin and the New Deal. Syracuse, N.Y.: Syracuse University Press, 1965, 292 pp. (X.100/3757) 45 WARREN, DONALD I. Radio Priest: Charles Coughlin, the Father of Hate Radio. New York and London: Free Press, 1996, 376 pp. (YA.1997.b.3345) 5. Long, Huey P. [See also VII.A.19. U.S. States: Louisiana] BRINKLEY, ALAN. Voices of Protest: Huey Long, Father Coughlin and the Great Depression. New York: Knopf, 1982, 348 pp. (X.800/39958) CORTNER, RICHARD C. The Kingfish and the Constitution: Huey Long, the First Amendment and the Emergence of Modern Press Freedom in America. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1996, 196 pp. (YC.1996.b.3578) JEANSONNE, GLEN, ed. Huey at 100: Centennial Essays on Huey P. Long. Ruston, La.: McGinty Pub., Dept. of History, Louisiana Tech University, 1995, 237 pp. (DSC 99/23406) LONG, HUEY P. Every Man a King: The Autobiography of Huey P. Long. Chicago: Quadrangle, 1964, 348 pp. (X.809/6094) LONG, HUEY P. Kingfish to America: Share Our Wealth: Selected Senatorial Papers. Edited by Henry M. Christman. New York: Schocken Books, 1985, 145 pp. (DSC 86/08450) LONG, HUEY P. My First Days in the White House. Harrisburg, Pa.: Telegraph Press, 1935, 146 pp. (20030.h.7) WILLIAMS, T. HARRY. Huey Long. New York: Vintage, 1981, 884 pp. (X.809/64003) 6. Socialism and Radicalism BAKER, SUSAN S. Radical Beginnings: Richard Hofstadter and the 1930s. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1985, 268 pp. (DSC 3458.205 no 112) DUNBAR, ANTHONY P. Against the Grain: Southern Radicals and Prophets, 19291959. Charlottesville: University Press of Virginia, 1981, 306 pp. (X.800/40793) MILLER, DONALD L. The New American Radicalism: Alfred M. Bingham and NonMarxian Insurgency in the New Deal Era. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1979, 240 pp. (X.809/45533) PRESTON, WILLIAM. Aliens and Dissenters: Federal Suppression of Radicals, 19031933. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1963, 352 pp. (9386.s.19); New York: Harper and Row, 1966, 349 pp. (X.708/3188) SINCLAIR, UPTON B. I, Governor of California, and How I Ended Poverty: A True Story of the Future. London: T. Wernie Laurie, 1933, 63 pp. (12601.s.4) 46 THOMAS, NORMAN M. America's Way Out: A Program for Democracy. New York: Macmillan, 1931, 324 pp. (08176.aa.31) THOMAS, NORMAN M. After the New Deal, What? New York: Macmillan, 1936, 244 pp. (20029.eee.44) THOMAS, NORMAN M. and BERTRAM D. WOLFE. Keep America Out of War: A Program. New York: Frederick A. Stokes., 1939, 184 pp. (Mic.A.10024) WARREN, FRANK A. An Alternative Vision: The Socialist Party in the 1930's. Bloomington and London: Indiana University Press, 1974, 274 pp. (X.809/40100) 7. Student Activism BRAX, RALPH S. The First Student Movement: Student Activism in the United States during the 1930s. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1981, 121 pp. (X.809/47885) COHEN, ROBERT. When the Old Left Was Young: Student Radicals and America's First Mass Student Movement, 1929-1941. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1993, 432 pp. (YC.1993.b.7319) EAGAN, EILEEN. Class, Culture and the Classroom: The Student Peace Movement of the 1930s. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1981, 319 pp. (X.529/64703) 8. Townsend Movement HOLTZMAN, ABRAHAM. The Townsend Movement: A Political Study. New York: Bookman Associates, 1963, 256 pp. (X.709/4038) NEUBERGER, RICHARD L. and KELLEY LEE. An Army of the Aged: A History and Analysis of the Townsend Old Age Pension Plan. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1973, 329 pp. (X.529/73240) NEW YORK TWENTIETH CENTURY FUND. An Impartial Review of the Townsend Movement and the Probable Effects of the Townsend Plan. New York: Committee on Old Age Security of the Twentieth Century Fund, 1936, 93 pp. (08286.h.72) TOWNSEND, FRANCIS E. New Horizons. Chicago: J. L. Stewart, 1943, 246 pp. (Mic.A.10004) IV. ECONOMY A. GENERAL STUDIES ARNDT, H. W. The Economic Lessons of the Nineteen-Thirties. Reprint, London: Frank Cass, 1963, 314 pp. (08233.n.30) 47 BARBER, WILLIAM J. From New Era to New Deal: Herbert Hoover, the Economists and American Economic Policy, 1921-1933. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1985, 237 pp. (YC.1998.b.2016) BARNES, HARRY E. Money Changers vs. the New Deal: A Candid Analysis of the Inflation Controversy. New York: Ray Long & R. R. Smith, 1934, 150 pp. (8233.a.7) BASTER, ALBERT S. J. The Twilight of American Capitalism: An Economic Interpretation of the New Deal. London: P. S. King, 1937, 218 pp. (8234.f.31) BERLE, ADOLF A. and GARDINER C. MEANS. The Modern Corporation and Private Property. New York: Macmillan, 1933, 396 pp. (8282.v.30) BORDO, MICHAEL D., CHRISTOPHER J. ERCEG and CHARLES L. EVANS. Money, Sticky Wages and the Great Depression. Cambridge, Mass.: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1997, 47 pp. (DSC 6067.7195 6071) BORDO, MICHAEL D., CLAUDIA GOLDIN and EUGENE N. WHITE, eds. The Defining Moment: The Great Depression and the American Economy in the Twentieth Century. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1998, 474 pp. (YC.1999.b.5521) BRENNAN, JOHN A. Silver and the First New Deal. Reno: University of Nevada Press, 1969, 187 pp. (X.520/4817) BROOKS, JOHN N. Once in Golconda: A True Drama of Wall Street, 1920-1938. London: Gollancz, 1970, 307 pp. (X.510/5318; X.529/11304) CAMPBELL, PERSIA C. Consumer Representation in the New Deal. New York: AMS Press, 1968, 298 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(477.)) COLLINS, ROBERT M. The Business Response to Keynes, 1929-1964. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1981, 293 pp. (X.520/26055) COUCH, JIM F. and WILLIAM F. SHUGHART II. The Political Economy of the New Deal. Cheltenham: Edwar Elgar, 1998, 247 pp. (SPIS 338.973009043) COWING, CEDRIC B. Populists, Plungers and Progressives: A Social History of Stock and Commodity Speculation, 1890-1936. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1965, 299 pp. (X.519/2204; X.519/7154) DAVIS, JOSEPH S. The World Between the Wars: 1919-39: An Economist's View. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1975, 436 pp. (X.800/25024) DE BEDTS, RALPH F. The New Deal's SEC: The Formative Years. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1964, 226 pp. (X.510/114) 48 DOUGLAS, WILLIAM O. Democracy and Finance: The Addresses and Public Statements of W. O. Douglas as Member and Chairman of the Securities and Exchange Commission. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1940, 301 pp. (10888.h.13) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. The American Economy during the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 307 pp. (YC.1991.b.565) ECCLES, MARRINER S. Economic Balance and a Balanced Budget: Public Papers of M. S. Eccles. Edited by Rudolph L. Weissman. New York and London: Harper, 1940, 299 pp. (8204.cc.19) EICHENGREEN, BARRY. Golden Fetters: The Gold Standard and the Great Depression, 1919-1939. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1992, 448 pp. (YC.1992.b.3214) FEARON, PETER. The Origins and Nature of the Great Slump, 1929-1932. London: Macmillan, 1979, 69 pp. (X.519/30088) FEARON, PETER. War, Prosperity and Depression: The U.S. Economy, 1917-45. Deddington: Philip Allan, 1987, 294 pp. (YC.1988.b.6709) FUSFELD, DANIEL R. The Economic Thought of Franklin D. Roosevelt and the Origins of the New Deal. New York: Columbia University Press, 1956, 337 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(586.)) GALAMBOS, LOUIS. Competition and Cooperation: The Emergence of a National Trade Association. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1966, 329 pp. (X.510/2392) GALBRAITH, JOHN K. The Great Crash, 1929. London: Hamish Hamilton, 1955, 186 pp. (8208.e.42); Harmondsworth: Penguin Books in association with Hamish Hamilton, 1961, 222 pp. (012209.d.4/540); 3d ed., London: Hamilton, 1973, 212 pp. (X.529/15734); 3d ed. London: Deutsch, 1973, 212 pp. (X.809/43856); 3d ed., Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1975, 223 pp. (X.519/25178); 50th anniversary ed., London: Deutsch, 1980, 184 pp. (X.809/45484) GARRATY, JOHN A. The Great Depression: An Inquiry into the Causes, Course and Consequences of the Worldwide Depression of the Nineteen-Thirties, as Seen by Contemporaries and in the Light of History. San Diego, Calif.: Harcourt Brace Jovanovich, 1986, 292 pp. (DSC 86/20480) HALL, THOMAS E. and J. DAVID FERGUSON. The Great Depression: An International Disaster of Perverse Economic Policies. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1998, 194 pp. (DSC 98/16020) HAWLEY, ELLIS W. The New Deal and the Problem of Monopoly: A Study in Economic Ambivalence. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1966, 525 pp. (X.519/2812; X.519/10419) 49 HIMMELBERG, ROBERT F., ed. Antitrust and Regulation during World War I and the Republican Era, 1917-1932. New York and London: Garland, 1994, 395 pp. (YC.1994.b.3977) HIMMELBERG, ROBERT F., ed. Business-Government Cooperation, 1917-1932: The Rise of Corporatist Policies. New York and London: Garland, 1994, 417 pp. (YC.1994.b.4164) HIMMELBERG, ROBERT F., ed. The Great Depression and American Capitalism. Boston: Heath, 1968, 110 pp. (9196.k.5/52) HIMMELBERG, ROBERT F., ed. The New Deal and Corporate Power: Antitrust and Regulatory Policies during the Thirties and World War II. New York and London: Garland, 1994, 397 pp. (YC.1994.b.3995) HIMMELBERG, ROBERT F., ed. Survival of Corporatism during the New Deal Era, 1933-1945. New York and London: Garland, 1994, 413 pp. (YC.1994.b.4277) HOSEN, FREDERICK E. The Great Depression and the New Deal: Legislative Acts in Their Entirety (1932-1933) and Statistical Economic Data (1926-1946). Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1992, 318 pp. (YC.1993.b.1655) HYMAN, SIDNEY. Marriner S. Eccles: Private Entrepreneur and Public Servant. Stanford, Calif.: Graduate School of Business, Stanford University, 1976, 456 pp. (X.800/34437) KITSON, HARRY D. Finding a Job during the Depression. New York: R. C. Cook, 1933, 32 pp. (W.P.4845/1) KLEIN, LAWRENCE R. Economic Fluctuations in the United States, 1921-1941. New York: Wiley; London: Chapman & Hall, 1950, 174 pp. (Ac.2691.fa/2) KOCH, ALBERT R. The Financing of Large Corporations, 1920-39. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1943, 139 pp. (Mic.A.8716) LEVINE, RHONDA F. Class Struggle and the New Deal: Industrial Labor, Industrial Capital and the State. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1988, 233 pp. (YC.1989.b.3039) MAY, DEAN L. From New Deal to New Economics: The Liberal Response to the Depression. New York: Garland, 1981, 204 pp. (DSC 83/16194) PARRISH, MICHAEL E. Securities Regulation and the New Deal. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1970, 270 pp. (Ac.2692.md/3.[no.93]) PEEK, GEORGE N., with SAMUEL CROWTHER Why Quit Our Own? New York: Van Nostrand, 1936, 353 pp. (8222.aaa.75) 50 REES, MORGAN G. The Great Slump: Capitalism in Crisis, 1929-33. London: Weidenfeld & Nicolson, 1970, 310 pp. (X.529/11724) ROBEY, RALPH W. Roosevelt versus Recovery. New York and London: Harper, 1934, 163 pp. (20018.b.23) ROOSE, KENNETH D. The Economics of Recession and Revival: An Interpretation of 1937-38. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1954, 280 pp. (Ac.2692.ma/22) ROSENOF, THEODORE. Economics in the Long Run: New Deal Theorists and Their Legacies, 1933-1993. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1997, 223 pp. (DSC 97/09341) SMITH, ARTHUR D. H. Men Who Run America: A Study of the Capitalistic System and Its Trends Based on Thirty Case Histories. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill, 1935, 361 pp. (010885.g.46) SOBEL, ROBERT. NYSE: A History of the New York Stock Exchange, 1935-1975. New York: Weybright and Talley, 1975, 398 pp. (X.800/28677) SOBEL, ROBERT. Panic on Wall Street: A History of America's Financial Disasters. New York: Collier; London: Collier-Macmillan, 1972, 469 pp. (X.519/13294) STALEY, ALVAH E. Raw Materials in Peace and War. New York: Council on Foreign Relations, 1937, 326 pp. (8290.d.18) STOLBERG, BENJAMIN and WARREN J. VINTON. The Economic Consequences of the New Deal. London: Gollancz, 1935, 94 pp. (8230.a.56) STONEMAN, WILLIAM E. A History of the Economic Analysis of the Great Depression in America. New York: Garland, 1979, 263 pp. (X.809/51021) SUTTON, ANTONY C. Wall Street and FDR. New Rochelle, N.Y.: Arlington House, 1975, 200 pp. (X.520/14928) WALLACE, BENJAMIN B. and LYNN R. EDMINSTER. International Control of Raw Materials. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1930, 479 pp. (8224.aa.34) WERNE, BENJAMIN, ed. Business and the Robinson Patman Law: A Symposium. New York: Oxford University Press, 1938, 296 pp. (Mic.A.10118) WIGMORE, BARRIE A. The Crash and Its Aftermath: A History of Securities Markets in the United States, 1929-1933. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1985, 731 pp. (DSC 3458.37 no 58) B. AGRICULTURE AHEARN, DANIEL J. The Wages of Farm and Factory Laborers, 1914-1944. New York: Columbia University Press, 1945, 245 pp. (Ac.2688/2) 51 ALBERTSON, DEAN. Roosevelt's Farmer: Claude R. Wickard in the New Deal. New York and London; Columbia University Press, 1961, 424pp. (10713.f.8) ASCH, BERTA and A. R. MANGUS. Farmers on Relief and Rehabilitation. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 226 pp. (A.S.978/7) BARGER, HAROLD and HANS H. LANDSBERG. American Agriculture, 18991939: A Study of Output, Employment and Productivity. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1942, 440 pp. (W.P.651/42) BLACK, JOHN D. The Dairy Industry and the AAA. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 520 pp. (Mic.A.10153) BLAISDELL, DONALD C. Government and Agriculture: The Growth of Federal Farm Aid. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1974, 217 pp. (X.329/18003) BAKER, O. E., RALPH BORSODI and M. L. WILSON. Agriculture in Modern Life. Edited by Baker Brownell. New York and London: Harper, 1939, 303 pp. (8288.g.12) CAMPBELL, PERSIA C. American Agricultural Policy. London: P. S. King, 1933, 304 pp. (8277.s.22) CAMPBELL, CHRISTIANA M. The Farm Bureau and the New Deal: A Study of the Making of National Farm Policy, 1933-40. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1962, 215 pp. (7056.d.21) CHAMBERS, CLARKE A. California Farm Organizations: A Historical Study of the Grange, the Farm Bureau and the Associated Farmers, 1929-1941. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1952, 277 pp. (10414.e.55) DALTON, JOHN E. Sugar: A Case Study of Government Control. New York: Macmillan, 1937, 311 pp. (8234.f.25) DAVIS, JOSEPH S. On Agricultural Policy, 1926-1938. Stanford, Calif.: Food Research Institute, Stanford University, 1939, 494 pp. (Ac.2692.nh) DAVIS, JOSEPH S. Wheat and the AAA. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1973, 468 pp. (X.529/62834) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. Agriculture during the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 251 pp. (YC.1991.b.567) DYSON, LOWELL K. Red Harvest: The Communist Party and American Farmers. Lincoln and London: University of Nebraska Press, 1982, 259 pp. (X.529/50399) FITE, GILBERT C. Farm to Factory: A History of the Consumers Cooperative Association. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1965, 288 pp. (X.311/1335) 52 FITZGERALD, DENNIS A. Livestock under the AAA. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 384 pp. (Mic.A.10044) FROKER, RUDOLPH K. and JOSEPH G. KNAPP. Farmers' Purchasing Associations in Wisconsin. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Farm Credit Administration, 1937, 118 pp. (A.S.929/6) GAUS, JOHN M. and LEON O. WOLCOTT Public Administration and the United States Department of Agriculture. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1975, 534 pp. (YA.1992.a.9175) HAMILTON, DAVID E. From New Day to New Deal: American Farm Policy from Hoover to Roosevelt, 1928-1933. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1991, 333 pp. (YA.1993.b.8347) HARDIN, CHARLES M. The Politics of Agriculture: Soil Conservation and the Struggle for Power in Rural America. Glencoe, Ill.: Free Press, 1952, 282 pp. (7082.e.3) KILE, ORVILLE M. The Farm Bureau through Three Decades. Baltimore, Md.: Waverly Press, 1948, 416 pp. (Mic.A.10109) MCCUNE, WESLEY. The Farm Bloc. New York: Greenwood, 1968, 278 pp. (X.809/7992) NELSON, LAWRENCE J. King Cotton's Advocate: Oscar G. Johnston and the New Deal. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1998, 330 pp. (DSC 99/17903) NOURSE, EDWIN G. Government in Relation to Agriculture. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1940, pp. 864-948. (Mic.A.9991) NOURSE, EDWIN G. Marketing Agreements under the AAA. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 446 pp. (Mic.A.10018) NOURSE, EDWIN G., JOSEPH S. DAVIS and JOHN D. BLACK. Three Years of the Agricultural Adjustment Administration. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1971, 600 pp. (X.329/18004) PERKINS, VAN L. Crisis in Agriculture: The Agricultural Adjustment Administration and the New Deal, 1933. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1969, 245 pp. (Ac.2689.g/11.[vol.81.]) POWERS, ELMER G. Years of Struggle: The Farm Diary of Elmer G. Powers, 19311936. Edited by H. Roger Grant and L. Edward Purcell. Ames: Iowa State University Press, 1976, 158 pp. (X.520/21739) RAU, ALLAN. Agricultural Policy and Trade Liberalization in the United States,19341956: A Study of Conflicting Policies. Genève: Librairie E. Droz; Paris: Librairie Minard, 1957, 160 pp. (W.P.d.405/21) 53 RICHARDS, HENRY I. Cotton and the AAA. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1936, 389 pp. (Mic.A.12345) ROWE, HAROLD B. Tobacco under the AAA. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 317 pp. (Mic.A.10031) ROWLEY, WILLIAM D. M. L. Wilson and the Campaign for the Domestic Allotment. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1970, 219 pp. (X.320/3100) SALOUTOS, THEODORE. The American Farmer and the New Deal. Ames: Iowa State University Press, 1982, 307 pp. (X800/39847) SHOVER, JOHN L. Cornbelt Rebellion: The Farmers' Holiday Association. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1965, 239 pp. (X.311/1349) STOKDYK, ELLIS A. and CHARLES H. WEST. The Farm Board. New York: Macmillan, 1930, 197 pp. (8276.t.1) WHITE, ROLAND A. Milo Reno, Farmers Union Pioneer. New York: Arno, 1975, 207 pp. (YA.1991.b.5553) WILSON, MILBURN L. Farm Relief and the Domestic Allotment Plan. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1933, 59 pp. (Mic.A.9992) WOOFTER, T. J., JR. and ELLEN WINSTON. Seven Lean Years. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1972, 187 pp. (YA.1991.a.16711) C. BANKING AND MONETARY POLICY BORDO, MICHAEL D. and BARRY EICHENGREEN. Implications of the Great Depression for the Development of the International Monetary System. Cambridge, Mass.: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1997, 73 pp. (DSC 6067.7195 5883) BURNS, HELEN M. The Banking Community and New Deal Banking Reforms, 19331935. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1974, 203 pp. (X.529/31504) CALOMIRIS, CHARLES W. and DAVID C. WHEELOCK. Was the Great Depression a Watershed for American Monetary Policy? Cambridge, Mass.: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1997, 65 pp. (DSC 6067.719500 no. 5963) CHANDLER, LESTER V. American Monetary Policy, 1928-1941. New York: Harper and Row, 1971, 371 pp. (X.520/4004) CLARKE, STEPHEN V. O. Central Bank Cooperation, 1924-1931. New York: Federal Reserve Bank of New York, 1967, 234 pp. (X.510/6676) CRAWFORD, ARTHUR W. Monetary Management under the New Deal: The Evolution of a Managed Currency System: Its Problems and Results. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Public Affairs, 1940, 382 pp. (8231.d.53) 54 COLT, CHARLES C. and NATHANIEL S. KEITH. 28 Days: A History of the Banking Crisis. New York: Greenberg, 1933, 86 pp. (8230.aa.34) DONALDSON, JOHN. The Dollar: A Study of the 'New' National and International Monetary System. New York: Oxford University Press, 1937, 271 pp. (8204.c.14) FRIEDMAN, MILTON and ANNA J. SCHWARTZ. A Monetary History of the United States, 1867-1960. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1963, 860 pp. (8247.t.40) FRIEDMAN, MILTON and ANNA J. SCHWARTZ. Monetary Trends in the United States and the United Kingdom: Their Relation to Income, Prices and Interest Rates, 18671975. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1982, 664 pp. (X.520/29807) GARLOCK, FRED L. Country Banking in Wisconsin during the Depression. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of Agriculture, 1941, 112 pp. (A.S.800/2) GARRETT, GARET and MURRAY N. ROTHBARD. The Great Depression and New Deal Monetary Policy. San Francisco, Calif.: Cato Institute, 1980, 131 pp. (YA.1986.a.11143) JOHNSON, GOVE G. The Treasury and Monetary Policy, 1933-1938. New York: Russell & Russell, 1967, 230 pp. (Ac.2992.am/33) NADLER, MARCUS and JULES I. BOGEN. The Banking Crisis: The End of an Epoch. London: Allen & Unwin, 1934, 210 pp. (08206.eee.68) O'CONNOR, J. F. T. The Banking Crisis and Recovery under the Roosevelt Administration. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1971, 167 pp. (X.800/38628) PARIS, JAMES D. Monetary Policies of the United States, 1932-1938. New York: Columbia University Press, 1938, 198 pp. (8232.eee.13) PATRICK, SUE C. Reform of the Federal Reserve System in the Early 1930s: The Politics of Money and Banking. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 349 pp. (YC.1993.b.5240) PHILLIPS, C. A., T. F. MCMANUS and R. W. NELSON. Banking and the Business Cycle: A Study of the Great Depression in the United States. New York: Macmillan, 1937, 274 pp. (8234.f.38) STEINDL, FRANK G. Monetary Interpretations of the Great Depression. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1995, 197 pp. (DSC 96/16771) TEMIN, PETER. Did Monetary Forces Cause the Great Depression? New York: Norton, 1976, 201 pp. (X.529/34626) 55 UPHAM, CYRIL B. and EDWIN LAMKE. Closed and Distressed Banks: A Study in Public Administration. Washington, D.C.: Institute of Economics, 1934, 285 pp. (8232.aa.26) VOLPE, PAUL A. The International Financial and Banking Crisis, 1931-1933. Washington, D.C.: Catholic University of America Press, 1945, 123 pp. (Ac.2692.y/15) WHITTLESEY, CHARLES R. Banking and the New Deal. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1935, 24 pp. (W.P.10274/16) WICKER, ELMUS. The Banking Panics of the Great Depression. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1996, 174 pp. (YC.1996.b.6190) WICKER, ELMUS R. Federal Reserve Monetary Policy, 1917-1933. New York: Random House, 1966, 221 pp. (X.529/20026) D. ECONOMY AND FOREIGN AFFAIRS ADAMS, FREDERICK C. Economic Diplomacy: The Export-Import Bank and American Foreign Policy, 1934-1939. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1976, 289 pp. (X.520/11681) BARBER, WILLIAM J. Designs within Disorder: Franklin D. Roosevelt, the Economists and the Shaping of American Foreign Policy, 1933-1945. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1996, 178 pp. (YC.1997.b.200) BECKETT, GRACE. The Reciprocal Trade Agreements Program. New York: Columbia University Press, 1941, 142 pp. (8222.bb.23) BLOOMFIELD, ARTHUR I. Capital Imports and the American Balance of Payments, 1934-39: A Study in Abnormal International Capital Transfers. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1950, 340 pp. (8230.bb.47) BODAYLA, STEPHEN D. Financial Diplomacy: The United States and Mexico, 19191933. New York and London: Garland, 1987, 216 pp. (YC.1988.a.8196) BUELL, RAYMOND L. The Hull Trade Program and the American System. New York: Foreign Policy Association, 1938, 48 pp. (Mic.A.12246(7)) BUTLER, MICHAEL A. Cautious Visionary: Cordell Hull and Trade Reform, 19331937. Kent, Ohio, and London: Kent State University Press, 1998, 240 pp. (DSC 98/29466) CLAVIN, PATRICIA. The Failure of Economic Diplomacy: Britain, Germany, France and the United States, 1931-36. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1996, 279 pp. (YC.1996.a.640) 56 DRUMMOND, IAN and NORMAN HILLMER. Negotiating Freer Trade: The United Kingdom, the United States, Canada and the Free Trade Agreements of 1938. Waterloo, Ont.: Wilfred Laurier University Press, 1989, 197 pp. (DSC 89/l4851) FEIS, HERBERT. The Diplomacy of the Dollar: First Era, 1919-1932. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1950, 81 pp. (Ac.2689/5) GARDNER, LLOYD C. Economic Aspects of New Deal Diplomacy. Madison: University of Wisconsin, 1964, 409 pp. (X.700/2309) HIGHAM, CHARLES. Trading with the Enemy: An Exposé of the Nazi-American Money Plot, 1933-1949. London: Hale, 1983, 277 pp. (X.809/57463) HILTON, STANLEY E. Brazil and the Great Powers, 1930-1939: The Politics of Trade Rivalry. Austin and London: University of Texas Press, 1976, 304 pp. (X.800/12344; X.0700/112 (38)) LEWIS, CLEONA. America's Stake in International Investments. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1938, 710 pp. (Ac.2391.(13.)) LOCKWOOD, WILLIAM W. The Foreign Trade Policy of the United States. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 58 pp. (Ac.1915.b.) LOCKWOOD, WILLIAM W. Trade and Trade Rivalry between the United States and Japan. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 66 pp. (Ac.1915.b) MADDEN, JOHN T., MARCUS NADLER and HARRY C. SAUVAIN. America's Experience as a Creditor Nation. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1937, 333 pp. (Mic.A.8712) PEARCE, CHARLES A. NRA Trade Practice Programs. New York: Columbia University Press, 1939, 225 pp. (08230.ee.20) RAU, ALLAN. Agricultural Policy and Trade Liberalization in the United States,19341956: A Study of Conflicting Policies. Genève: Librairie E. Droz; Paris: Librairie Minard, 1957, 160 pp. (W.P.d.405/21) RIGGS, A. R. and TOM VELK. Cordell Hull, The New Deal and Inter-American Trade. Montreal: Dept. of Economics, McGill University, 1993, 17 pp. (DSC 9349.7383 2/93) ROWLAND, BENJAMIN M. Commercial Conflict and Foreign Policy: A Study in Anglo-American Relations, 1932-1938. New York: Garland, 1987, 431 pp. (YC.1988.a.8209) SCHATTSCHNEIDER, ELMER E. Politics, Pressures and the Tariff: A Study of Free Private Enterprise in Pressure Politics, as Shown in the 1929-1930 Revision of the Tariff. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1935, 301 pp. (20030.c.1) 57 SCHUKER, STEPHEN A. American 'Reparations' to Germany, 1919-33: Implications for Third World Debt Crisis. Princeton, N.J.: Dept. of Economics, Princeton University, 1988, 170 pp. (DSC 6612.955 61) STEWARD, DICK. Trade and Hemisphere: The Good Neighbor Policy and Reciprocal Trade. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1975, 307 pp. (X.520/11498) TASCA, HENRY J. The Reciprocal Trade Policy of the United States: A Study in Trade Philosophy. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1938, 371 pp. (8231.f.4) TAYLOR, ALONZO E. The New Deal and Foreign Trade. New York: Macmillan, 1935, 301 pp. (8231.aa.14; 8232.b.44) WALLACE, HENRY A. America Must Choose: The Advantages and Disadvantages of Nationalism, of World Trade and of a Planned Middle Course. New York: Foreign Policy Association; Boston: World Peace Foundation, 1934, 33 pp. (X.510/993) WILSON, JOAN HOFF. Ideology and Economics: U.S. Relations with the Soviet Union, 1918-1933. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1974, 192 pp. (X.529/20092) E. FARM SECURITY ADMINISTRATION [See also VI.R. Cultural and Intellectual History: Photography] BALDWIN, SIDNEY. Poverty and Politics: The Rise and Decline of the Farm Security Administration. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1968, 438 pp. (X.320/2354) GAER, JOSEPH. Toward Farm Security: The Problem of Rural Poverty and the Work of the Farm Security Administration. Washington, D.C.: Farm Security Administration, 1941, 246 pp. (A.S.895/3) GREY, MICHAEL R. New Deal Medicine: The Rural Health Programs of the Farm Security Administration. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1999, 238 pp. (DSC 99/19733) F. INCOME, WAGES, COST OF LIVING, DISTRIBUTION OF WEALTH AHEARN, DANIEL J. The Wages of Farm and Factory Laborers, 1914-1944. New York: Columbia University Press, 1945, 245 pp. (Ac.2688/2) BARGER, HAROLD. Outlay and Income in the United States, 1921-1938. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1942, 391 pp. (W.P.13012) BENEY, M. ADA. Cost of Living in the United States, 1914-1936. New York: National Industrial Conference Board, 1936, 99 pp. (8287.ee.28) BENEY, M. ADA. Differentials in Industrial Wages and Hours in the United States. New York: National Industrial Conference Board, 1938, 203 pp. (8289.dd.2) 58 BENEY, M. ADA. Wages, Hours and Employment in the United States, 1914-1936. New York: National Industrial Conference Board, 1936, 197 pp. (Mic.A.8311) DOANE, ROBERT R. The Anatomy of American Wealth: The Story of Our Physical Assets and Their Allocation as to Form and Use among the People. New York and London: Harper, 1940, 345 pp. (08230.h.46) GOODRICH, CARTER. Earnings and Standard of Living of 1,000 Railway Employees during the Depression. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of Labor, 1934, 56 pp. (A.S.108/11) KUZNETS, SIMON S. National Income and Its Composition, 1919-1938. 2 vols. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1941. (Mic.A.10064) KUZNETS, SIMON S. National Income and Capital Formation, 1919-1935: A Preliminary Report. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1937, 86 pp. (W.P.651/32) LUNDBERG, FERDINAND. America's 60 Families. New York: Vanguard Press, 1937, 544 pp. (10388.l.17); New York: Vanguard Press, 1938, 578 pp. (010410.l.25) STECKER, MARGARET L. Intercity Differences in Costs of Living in March 1935, 59 Cities. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 216 pp. (A.S.978/7) WILLEFORD, MARY BRISTOW. Income and Health in Remote Rural Areas: A Study of 400 Families in Leslie County, Kentucky. New York: Columbia University, 1932, 88 pp. (08285.h.27) G. INDUSTRY BARGER, HAROLD and SAM H. SCHURR. The Mining Industries, 1899-1939: A Study of Output, Employment and Productivity. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1944, 452 pp. (W.P.651/43) COBB, JAMES C. Industrialization and Southern Society, 1877-1984. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1984, 185 pp. (YC.1988.a.11787) COBB, JAMES C. The Selling of the South: The Southern Crusade for Industrial Development, 1936-1980. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1982, 293 pp. (X.520/29042) DAUGHERTY, CARROLL R., MELVIN G. DE CHAZEAU and SAMUEL S. STRATTON. The Economics of the Iron and Steel Industry. 2 vols. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1937, 1188 pp. (8231.ee.41) DUNN, ROBERT W. and JACK HARDY. Labor and Textiles: A Study of Cotton and Wool Manufacturing. New York: International Pub., 1931, 256 pp. (Mic.A.19493) 59 FELDMAN, HERMAN. Racial Factors in American Industry. New York and London: Harper, 1931, 318 pp. (8285.w.31) FINE, SIDNEY. The Automobile under the Blue Eagle: Labor, Management and the Automobile Manufacturing Code. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1963, 566 pp. (8280.cc.11) HERRING, HARRIET L. Southern Industry and Regional Development. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1940, 103 pp. (Mic.A.10120) HODGES, JAMES A. New Deal Labor Policy and the Southern Cotton Textile Industry, 1933-1941. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1986, 252 pp. (DSC 88/31623) KATZ, HAROLD. The Decline of Competition in the Automobile Industry, 1920-1940. New York: Arno, 1977, 504 pp. (X.800/36891) KUHN, ARTHUR J. GM Passes Ford, 1918-1938: Designing the General Motors Performance-Control System. University Park: Pennsylvania State University Press, 1986, 308 pp. (DSC 86/21557) LEMERT, BENJAMIN F. The Cotton Industry of the Southern Appalachian Piedmont. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1933, 188 pp. (8231.bb.27) MILLER, CHARLES W. The Automobile Gold Rushes and Depression Era Mining. Moscow: University of Idaho Press, 1998, 200 pp. (DSC 98/28419) OATES, MARY J. The Role of the Cotton Textile Industry in the Economic Development of the American Southeast, 1900-1940. New York: Arno, 1975, 221 pp. (X.520/14988) ROSENBLOOM, JOSHUA L. and WILLIAM A. SUNDSTROM. The Sources of Regional Variation in the Severity of the Great Depression: Evidence from U.S. Manufacturing, 1919-1937. Cambridge, Mass.: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1997, 24 pp. (DSC 6067.7195 6288) H. LABOR/WORKERS AHEARN, DANIEL J. The Wages of Farm and Factory Laborers, 1914-1944. New York: Columbia University Press, 1945, 245 pp. (Ac.2688/2) ALLEN, RUTH A. Chapters in the History of Organized Labor in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1941, 258 pp. (Mic.A.8328) ALLEN, RUTH A. and SAM B. BARTON. Wage Earners Meet the Depression. Austin: University of Texas, 1935, 105 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) BERNHEIM, ALFRED L. and DOROTHY VAN DOREN, eds. Labor and the Government: An Investigation of the Role of the Government in Labor Relations. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1935, 413 pp. (20019.g.50) 60 BERNSTEIN, IRVING. A Caring Society: The New Deal Confronts the Great Depression: A History of the American Worker, 1933-1941. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1985, 338 pp. (DSC 85/31056; DSC 85/38392) BERNSTEIN, IRVING. The Lean Years: A History of the American Worker, 19201933. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1960, 577 pp. (08277.p.13) BERNSTEIN, IRVING. The New Deal Collective Bargaining Policy. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1975, 178 pp. (X.800/38627) BOW, FRANK T. Independent Labor Organizations and the National Labor Relations Act. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1940, 120 pp. (Mic.A.19504) BRAZEAL, B. R. The Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters: Its Origin and Development. New York and London: Harper, 1946, 258 pp. (8236.e.27; 8288.f.68) BROOKS, ROBERT R. Unions of Their Own Choosing: An Account of the National Labor Relations Board and Its Work. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1939, 296 pp. (8288.2.12) BROWN, MALCOLM J. and ORIN CASSMORE. Migratory Cotton Pickers in Arizona. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1939, 23 pp. (A.S.978/43) CAYTON, HORACE R. and GEORGE S. MITCHELL. Black Workers and the New Unions. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1939, 473 pp. (8289.dd.7) CHATEAUVERT, MELINDA. Marching Together: Women of the Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1998, 267 pp. (DSC 98/11466) CHENG, LUCIE and EDNA BONACICH, eds. Labor Immigration under Capitalism: Asian Workers in the United States before World War II. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1984, 634pp. (X.800/41614) COHEN, LIZABETH. Making a New Deal: Industrial Workers in Chicago, 1919-1939. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1990, 526 pp. (YC.1991.b.1030); Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1992, 526 pp. (YK.1992.a.8514) CHRISTENSON, CARROLL L. and RICHARD A. MYREN. Wage Policy under the Walsh-Healey Public Contracts Act: A Critical Review. Bloomington and London: Indiana University Press, 1966, 239 pp. (Ac.2692.w/10; X.510/2190) CORTNER, RICHARD C. The Wagner Act Cases. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1964, 208 pp. (X.200/1478) CROSS, IRA B. A History of the Labor Movement in California. Berkeley, Calif.: University of California Press, 1935, 354 pp. (Ac.2689.g/19; X.520/9067) 61 CUMMINS, EARL E. The Labor Problem in the United States. London: Macmillan, 1932, 857 pp. (8286.ff.62) DANIEL, CLETUS E. The ACLU and the Wagner Act: An Inquiry into the Depressionera Crisis of American Liberalism. New York: New York State School of Industrial and Labor Relations, Cornell University, 1980, 142 pp. (X.529/63986) DANIEL, CLETUS E. Bitter Harvest: A History of California Farmworkers, 1870-1941. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1981, 348 pp. (X.800/31360) DAUGHERTY, CARROLL R. Labor Problems in American Industry. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1933, 959 pp. (08286.b.61); rev. ed., Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1938, 984 pp. (8288.ee.11); 5th ed., Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1941, 1008 pp. (8287.c.65) DAUGHERTY, CARROLL R. Labor under the N.R.A. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1934, 37 pp. (Mic.A.10143) DAVIS, HORACE B. Labor and Steel. London: Martin Lawrence, 1933, 304 pp. (W.P.7662/1) DE WITT, HOWARD. Violence in the Fields: California Filipino Farm Labor Unionization during the Great Depression. Saratoga, Calif.: Century Twenty One, 1980, 139 pp. (DSC 80/33084) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and WARREN VAN TIME. John L. Lewis: A Biography. New York: Quadrangle/New York Times Book Co., 1977, 619 pp. (X.800/14861) DUFFY, SUSAN. American Labor on Stage: Dramatic Interpretations of the Steel and Textile Industries in the 1930s. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1996, 156 pp. (YC.1997.b.598) DUNN, ROBERT W. and JACK HARDY. Labor and Textiles: A Study of Cotton and Wool Manufacturing. New York: International Pub., 1931, 256 pp. (Mic.A.19493) EBY, HERBERT O. The Labor Relations Act in the Courts. New York: Harpers, 1943, 250 pp. (Mic.A.9978) FAUE, ELIZABETH. Community of Suffering and Struggle: Women, Men and the Labor Movement in Minneapolis, 1915-1945. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1991, 295 pp. (YA.1992.b.4587) FINE, SIDNEY. The Automobile under the Blue Eagle: Labor, Management and the Automobile Manufacturing Code. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1963, 566 pp. (8280.cc.11) 62 FONER, PHILIP S. and RONALD L. LEWIS, eds. The Black Worker: A Documentary History from Colonial Times to the Present. Vol. 6, The Era of Post-war Prosperity and the Great Depression, 1920-1936. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1981. (X.0800/1579); Vol. 7, The Black Worker from the Founding of the CIO to the AFL-CIO. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1983. (X.0800/1579) FRANKLIN, CHARLES L. The Negro Labor Unionist of New York: Problems and Conditions among Negroes in the Labor Unions in Manhattan, with Special Reference to the N.R.A. and post-N.R.A. Situations. New York: Columbia University Press, 1936, 417 pp. (08285.h.51); reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1968, 415 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(420.)) FREEMAN, JOSHUA B. In Transit: The Transport Workers Union in New York City, 1933-1936. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1989, 434 pp. (YH.1990.b.507) FRIEDLÄNDER, PETER. The Emergence of a UAW Local, 1936-1939: A Study in Class and Culture. Pittsburgh, Pa.: University of Pittsburgh Press; London: Feffer and Simons, 1976, 155 pp. (X.529/30476) FUJITA, KUNIKO. Black Worker's Struggles in Detroit's Auto Industry, 1935-1975. Saratoga, Calif.: Century Twenty One, 1980, 130 pp. (X.525/8724) GABIN, NANCY F. Feminism in the Labor Movement: Women and the United Auto Workers, 1935-1975. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1990, 257 pp. (YA.1993.b.9139) GALENSON, WALTER. The CIO Challenge to the AFL: A History of the American Labor Movement, 1935-1941. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1960, 732 pp. (Ac.2692.bf.(24.)) GALL, GILBERT J. Pursuing Justice: Lee Pressman, the New Deal and the CIO. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1999, 363 pp. (DSC 99/20702) GRAY, BRENDA C. Black Female Domestics during the Depression in New York City, 1930-1940. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 200 pp. (YC.1993.b.6369) GREGORY, CHARLES O. Policy Development under the National Labor Relations Act. Chicago: University of Chicago, Industrial Relations Center, 1947. (Mic.A.12246(4) GREENE, LORENZO J. and CARTER G. WOODSON. The Negro Wage Earner. Washington, D.C.: Association for the Study of Negro Life and History, 1930, 388 pp. (Ac.8444/5) GRIFFLER, KEITH P. What Price Alliance?: Black Radicals Confront White Labor, 1918-1938. New York: Garland, 1995, 266 pp. (YC.1995.b.3836) GROSS, JAMES A. Reshaping of the National Labor Relations Board: National Labor Policy in Transition, 1937-1947. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1981. (DSC 82/12517) 63 HARRIS, HERBERT. American Labor. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1939, 459 pp. (08286.k.25) HARRIS, WILLIAM H. Keeping the Faith: A. Philip Randolph, Milton P. Webster and the Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters, 1925-37. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1977, 252 pp. (X.520/12431) HEVENER, JOHN W. Which Side Are You On? The Harlan County Coal Miners, 1931-39. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1978, 216 pp. (X.800/29882; X.800/37354) HIGGINS, GEORGE G. Voluntarism in Organized Labor in the United States, 19301940. New York: Arno, 1969, 182 pp. (YA.1991.a.13494) HODGES, JAMES A. New Deal Labor Policy and the Southern Cotton Textile Industry, 1933-1941. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1986, 252 pp. (DSC 88/31623) HUNNICUTT, BENJAMIN K. Kellogg's Six-Hour Day. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1996, 261 pp. (YA.1997.b.3079) JAMIESON, STUART. Labor Unionism in American Agriculture. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, 1945, 457 pp. (A.S.111) JOHNSON, CHRISTOPHER H. Maurice Sugar: Law, Labor and the Left in Detroit, 1912-1950. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1988, 334 pp. (YA.1990.b.4428) KALTENBORN, HOWARD S. Governmental Adjustment of Labor Disputes. Chicago: Foundation Press, 1943, 327 pp. (Mic.A.10055) KOFAS, JON V. The Struggle for Legitimacy: Latin American Labor and the United States, 1930-1960. Tempe: Center for Latin American Studies, Arizona State University, 1992, 425 pp. (YA.1992.b.2973; YA.1993.a.2203) KORTH, PHILIP A. and MARGARET R. BEEGLE. I Remember Like Today: The Auto-Lite Strike of 1934. East Lansing: Michigan State University Press, 1988, 245 pp. (YA.1990.b.3526) LEAB, DANIEL J. A Union of Individuals: The Formation of the American Newspaper Guild, 1933-1956. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1970, 362 pp. (X.520/3752) LEVENSTEIN, HARVEY A. Communism, Anticommunism and the CIO. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1981, 364 pp. (X.800/31852) LOFTIS, ANNE. Witnesses to the Struggle: Imaging the 1930s California Labor Movement. Reno: University of Nevada Press, 1998, 239 pp. (DSC 98/24858) 64 LORWIN, LEWIS L. The American Federation of Labor: History, Policies and Prospects. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1933, 573 pp. (Ac.2391.(5.)) LORWIN, LEWIS L. Labor Relations Boards: The Regulation of Collective Bargaining under the National Industrial Recovery Act. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 477 pp. (Mic.A.10123) LYND, STAUGHTON, ed. 'We Are All Leaders': The Alternative Unionism of the Early 1930s. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1996, 343 pp. (DSC 97/01443) MACDONALD, LOIS, GLADYS L. PALMER and THERESA WOLFSON. Labor and the N.R.A. New York: Affiliated Schools for Workers, 1934, 51 pp. (Mic.A.12246(5)) MCFARLAND, CHARLES K. Roosevelt, Lewis and the New Deal, 1933-1940. Fort Worth: Texas Christian University Press, 1970, 132 pp. (X.519/13250) MCPHERSON, WILLIAM H. Labor Relations in the Automobile Industry. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1940, 173 pp. (Mic.A.13175) MCWILLIAMS, CAREY. Factories in the Field: The Story of Migratory Farm Labor in California. Boston: Little, Brown, 1939, 334 pp. (X.319/1933) MCWILLIAMS, CAREY. Ill Fares the Land: Migrants and Migratory Labour in the United States. London: Faber & Faber, 1945, 245 pp. (8287.de.71) MEIER, AUGUST and ELLIOTT RUDWICK. Black Detroit and the Rise of the UAW. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 289 pp. (X.529/36379) MELZER, RICHARD. Madrid Revisited: Life and Labor in a New Mexico Mining Camp in the Years of the Great Depression. Santa Fe, N.M.: Lightning Tree, 1976, 63 pp. (YA.1987.b.1079) MENEFEEE, SELDON C. Mexican Migratory Workers of South Texas. Washington, D.C.: Work Projects Administration, 1941, 67 pp. (A.S.978/48) MIKHAILOV, B. Y., N. V. MOSTOVETS and G. N. SEVOSTYANOV, eds. Recent History of the Labor Movement in the United States, 1939-1965. Moscow: Progress Pub., 1979, 533 pp. (X.809/28055) MILLIS, HARRY A. and EMILY C. BROWN. From the Wagner Act to Taft-Hartley: A Study of National Labor Policy and Labor Relations. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1950, 723 pp. (8286.f.67) MILTON, DAVID. The Politics of U.S. Labor: From the Great Depression to the New Deal. New York: Monthly Review Press, 1982, 189 pp. (DSC 83/07164) MUSTE, A. J. The Automobile Industry and Organized Labor. Baltimore, Md.: Christian Social Justice Fund, 1936, 59 pp. (Mic.A.12744(2)) 65 NATIONAL COMMITTEE FOR THE DEFENSE OF POLITICAL PRISONERS. Harlan Miners Speak: Report on Terrorism in the Kentucky Coal Fields. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1932, 348 pp. (Mic.A.18925) NELSON, BRUCE. Workers on the Waterfront: Seamen, Longshoremen and Unionism in the 1930s. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1988, 352 pp. (DSC 88/23658) NELSON, DANIEL. American Rubber Workers and Organized Labor, 1900-1941. Princeton, N.J., and London: Princeton University Press, 1988, 339 pp. (YC.1991.b.4242) NEWELL, BARBARA W. Chicago and the Labor Movement: Metropolitan Unionism in the 1930's. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1961, 288 pp. (8280.aa.28) NORTHRUP, HERBERT R. Organized Labor and the Negro. 2d ed., New York and London: Harper, 1944, 312 pp. (08286.dd.92) OBLINGER, CARL D. Divided Kingdom: Work, Community and the Mining Wars in the Central Illinois Coal Fields during the Great Depression. Springfield, Ill.: Illinois State Historical Society, 1991, 265 pp. (YA.1994.a.12499) PERRY, LOUIS B. and RICHARD S. PERRY. A History of the Los Angeles Labor Movement, 1911-1941. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1963, 622 pp. (Ac.2689.hb.(12.)) PETERSON, FLORENCE. American Labor Unions: What They Are and How They Work. 3d ed. New York and London: Harper, 1946, 338 pp. (8288.h.82) PETERSON, FLORENCE. Handbook of Labor Unions. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Public Affairs, 1944, 415 pp. (08285.d.100) PETERSON, FLORENCE. Strikes in the United States, 1880-1936. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, 1938, 183 pp. (A.S.111) PHELPS, ORME W. The Legislative Background of the Fair Labor Standards Act: A Study of the Growth of National Sentiment in Favor of Governmental Regulation of Wages, Hours and Child Labor. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 71 pp. (Ac.2691.e/5; Mic.A.10070) PRUETTE, LORINE, ed. Women Workers through the Depression: A Study of White Collar Employment. New York: Macmillan, 1934, 164 pp. (8286.e.55) REID, IRA DE A., et al. The Urban Negro Worker in the United States, 1925-1936. 2 vols. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1938. (A.S.189/3) REISLER, MARK. By the Sweat of Their Brow: Mexican Immigrant Labor in the United States, 1900-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 298 pp. (X.529/31635) 66 ROBERTS, JOHN W. Putting Foreign Policy to Work: The Role of Organized Labor in American Foreign Relations, 1932-1941. New York: Garland, 1995, 322 pp. (DSC 95/35655) ROSENFARB, JOSEPH. The National Labor Policy and How It Works. New York and London: Harper, 1940, 732 pp. (20033.h.21) RUÍZ, VICKI L. Cannery Women, Cannery Lives: Mexican Women, Unionization and the California Food Processing Industry, 1930-1950. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1987, 194 pp. (YA.1989.b.7702) SALNY, SAMUEL M. Independent Unions under the Wagner Act: A Manual for Attorneys, Labor Relations Advisors and Union Officials. Boston: E. W. Hildreth, 1944, 342 pp. (Mic.A.12379) SCHACHT, JOHN N. The Making of Telephone Unionism, 1920-1947. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1985, 282 pp. (YA.1990.b.4026) SCHARF, LOIS. To Work and to Wed: Female Employment, Feminism and the Great Depression. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1980, 240 pp. (X.529/39543) SEATON, DOUGLAS P. Catholics and Radicals: The Association of Catholic Trade Unionists and the American Labor Movement, from Depression to Cold War. Lewisburg, Pa.: Bucknell University Press, 1981, 269 pp. (DSC 81/19791) SEIDMAN, HAROLD. Labor Czars: A History of Labor Racketeering. New York: Liveright Pub., 1938, 317 pp. (08286.i.8) SELVIN, DAVID F. A Terrible Anger: The 1934 Waterfront and General Strikes in San Francisco. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1996, 272 pp. (YA.1998.a.10565) SHOEMAKER, JAMES H. Labor in the Territory of Hawaii. Washington, D.C.: U.S. House Doc., 76th Congress, 3d Session, no. 848, 1940, 244 pp. (A.S.10) SILVERBERG, LOUIS G., ed. The Wagner Act: After Ten Years. Washington, D.C.: Bureau of National Affairs, 1945, 126 pp. (X.200/1688) SPERO, STERLING D. and ABRAM L. HARRIS. The Black Worker: The Negro and the Labor Movement. New York: Columbia University Press, 1931, 509 pp. (8285.r.23) STOLBERG, BENJAMIN. The Story of the CIO. New York: Viking, 1938, 292 pp. (Mic.A.9363) SUGAR, MAURICE. Ford Hunger March. Berkeley, Calif.: Meiklejohn Civil Liberties Institute, 1980. (DSC 5536.395 v 1) 67 SUGGS, GEORGE G. Union Busting in the Tri-State: The Oklahoma, Kansas and Missouri Metal Workers' Strike of 1935. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1986, 282 pp. (DSC 86/27042) TAFT, PHILIP. The A.F. of L. from the Death of Gompers to the Merger. New York: Harper, 1959, 499 pp. (8291.ff.4) TAYLOR, PAUL S. Mexican Labor in the United States. Berkeley: University of California Publications in Economics, 1928-1934. (Ac.2689.g/19) TEAD, ORDWAY and HENRY C. METCALF. Labor Relations under the Recovery Act. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 259 pp. (20017.b.5) TROTTER, JOE W., JR. Black Milwaukee: The Making of an Industrial Proletariat, 1915-45. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1985, 302 pp. (DSC 85/12464) VARGAS, ZARAGOSA. Proletarians of the North: A History of Mexican Industrial Workers in Detroit and the Midwest, 1917-1933. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1993, 277 pp. (YC.1994.b.5414) VITTOZ, STANLEY. New Deal Labor Policy and the American Industrial Economy. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1987, 214 pp. (DSC 87/23058) VORSE, MARY H. Labor's New Millions. New York: Modern Age Books, 1938, 312 pp. (08286.g.13) WALSH, JOHN R. Labour's Battle in the U.S.A.: The Fight for Industrial Unionism. London: Allen & Unwin, 1938, 293 pp. (08286.h.7) WEBER, DEVRA. Dark Sweat, White Gold: California Farm Workers, Cotton and the New Deal. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1994, 338 pp. (YC.1995.b.2581) WEBB, JOHN N. The Migratory-Casual Worker. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 128 pp. (A.S.978/7) WEISIGER, MARSHA L. Land of Plenty: Oklahomans in the Cotton Fields of Arizona, 1933-1942. Norman and London: University of Oklahoma Press, 1995, 238 pp. (YC.1997.a.1863) WOLMAN, LEO. Ebb and Flow in Trade Unionism. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1936, 251 pp. (W.P.651/30) YELLEN, SAMUEL. American Labor Struggles. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1936, 398 pp. (8288.aaa.6) ZIEGER, ROBERT H. American Workers, American Unions, 1920-1985. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1986, 233 pp. (YC.1988.b.5707); 68 2d ed., Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1994, 244 pp. (YC.1995.a.2205) ZIEGER, ROBERT H. The CIO, 1935-1955. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1995, 491 pp. (DSC 95/15792) ZIEGER, ROBERT H., ed. Organized Labor in the Twentieth-Century South. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1991, 289 pp. (YA.1993.b.11674) ZIEGER, ROBERT H. Rebuilding the Pulp and Paper Workers' Union, 1933-1941. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1984, 242 pp. (DSC 84/22104) I. NATIONAL INDUSTRIAL RECOVERY ACT/ NATIONAL RECOVERY ADMINISTRATION BRAND, DONALD R. Corporatism and the Rule of Law: A Study of the National Recovery Administration. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1988, 340 pp. (DSC 88/25127) CONNERY, ROBERT H. The Administration of an N.R.A. Code: A Case Study of the Men's Clothing Industry. Chicago: Public Administration Service, 1938, 211 pp. (Ac.2286.b) DAUGHERTY, CARROLL R. Labor under the N.R.A. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1934, 37 pp. (Mic.A.10143) FINE, SIDNEY. The Automobile under the Blue Eagle: Labor, Management and the Automobile Manufacturing Code. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1963, 566 pp. (8280.cc.11) FRANKLIN, CHARLES L. The Negro Labor Unionist of New York: Problems and Conditions among Negroes in the Labor Unions in Manhattan, with Special Reference to the N.R.A. and post-N.R.A. Situations. New York: Columbia University Press, 1936, 417 pp. (08285.h.51); reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1968, 415 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(420.)) GALLAGHER, MICHAEL F. Government Control of Industry in America: A Study of the NRA. London: Oxford University Press, 1934, 241 pp. (20018.b.30) HIMMELBERG, ROBERT F. The Origins of the National Recovery Administration: Business, Government and the Trade Association Issue, 1921-1933. New York: Fordham University Press, 1976, 232 pp. (X.800/28652) JOHNSON, HUGH S. The Blue Eagle from Egg to Earth. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1935, 459 pp. (20018.ff.50) KREPS, THEODORE J. Business and Government under the National Recovery Administration. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 46 pp. (Ac.1915.b) 69 LORWIN, LEWIS L. Labor Relations Boards: The Regulation of Collective Bargaining under the National Industrial Recovery Act. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 477 pp. (Mic.A.10123) LYON, LEVERETT S., PAUL T. HOMAN, et al. The National Recovery Administration: An Analysis and Appraisal. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 947 pp. (8287.df.73) MACDONALD, LOIS, GLADYS L. PALMER and THERESA WOLFSON. Labor and the N.R.A. New York: Affiliated Schools for Workers, 1934, 51 pp. (Mic.A.12246(5)) MACK, RUTH P. Controlling Retailers: A Study of Cooperation and Control in the Retail Trade with Special Reference to the NRA. Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1968, 551 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(423.)) MARSHALL, LEON C. Hours and Wages Provisions in NRA Codes: A Compilation Organized by Leon C. Marshall. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1935, 115 pp. (Mic.A.10028) PEARCE, CHARLES A. NRA Trade Practice Programs. New York: Columbia University Press, 1939, 225 pp. (08230.ee.20) RICHBERG, DONALD R. The Rainbow: After the Sunshine of Prosperity, the Deluge of the Depression, the Rainbow of the NRA, What Have We Learned? Where Are We Going? Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1936, 319 pp. (8231.bb.44) SMITH, BLACKWELL. My Imprints on the Sands of Time: The Life of a New Dealer. New York: Vantage, 1993, 446 pp. (YA.1996.b.7978) TEAD, ORDWAY and HENRY C. METCALF. Labor Relations under the Recovery Act. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 259 pp. (20017.b.5) WEINSTEIN, MICHAEL M. Recovery and Redistribution under the NIRA. Amsterdam and Oxford: North-Holland, 1980, 171 pp. (X.520/23176) WILCOX, CLAIR, HERBERT F. FRASER and PATRICK M. MALIN, eds. America's Recovery Program. London: Oxford University Press, 1934, 253 pp. (08229.m.15) J. NATURAL RESOURCES, PUBLIC WORKS AND CONSERVATION 1. General Studies CHASE, STUART. Rich Land, Poor Land: A Study of Waste in the Natural Resources of America. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 361 pp. (10409.y.24) 70 CHEYNEY, EDWARD G. and THORVALD S. HANSEN. This Is Our Land: The Story of Conservation in the United States. St. Paul, Minn.: Webb Book Pub. 1940, 337 pp. (7079.b.5) CUTLER, PHOEBE. The Public Landscape of the New Deal. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1985, 182 pp. (YH.1987.b.287) GALBRAITH, JOHN K. and GOVE G. JOHNSON, JR. The Economic Effects of the Federal Public Works Expenditures, 1933-1938. Washington, D.C.: Depts. of State and Public Institutions, National Resources Planning Board, Public Works Committee, 1940, 131 pp. (A.S.938/25) GATES, WILLIAM H. Hoover Dam, Including the Story of the Turbulent Colorado River. Los Angeles, Calif.: Wetzel Pub., 1932, 88 pp. (10410.y.14) GAYER, ARTHUR D. Public Works in Prosperity and Depression. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1935, 460 pp. (W.P.651/29) GLOVER, KATHERINE. America Begins Again: The Conquest of Waste in Our Natural Resources. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1939, 382 pp. (8288.f.2) GUSTAFSON, A. F., et al. Conservation in the United States. Ithaca, N.Y.: Comstock Pub., 1939, 445 pp. (Mic.A.12375) HARDIN, CHARLES M. The Politics of Agriculture: Soil Conservation and the Struggle for Power in Rural America. Glencoe, Ill.: Free Press, 1952, 282 pp. (7082.e.3) ISAKOFF, JACK F. The Public Works Administration. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1938, 166 pp. (Ac.2692.u/14; Mic.A.9969) KLEINSORGE, PAUL L. The Boulder Canyon Project: Historical and Economic Aspects. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1941, 330 pp. (08766.d.60) NIXON, EDGAR B., ed. Franklin D. Roosevelt and Conservation, 1911-1945. 2 vols. Hyde Park, N.Y.: Franklin D. Roosevelt Library, 1957. (7009.h.25) OWEN, A. L. RIESCH. Conservation under F.D.R. New York: Praeger, 1983, 268 pp. (X.800/36566) SCHWARTZ, BONNIE F. The Civil Works Administration, 1933-1934: The Business of Emergency Employment in the New Deal. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1984, 300 pp. (X.529/71774) STEVENS, JOSEPH E. Hoover Dam: An American Adventure. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1988, 326 pp. (YC.1989.b.1739) UNITED STATES FEDERAL EMERGENCY ADMINISTRATION OF PUBLIC WORKS. America Builds: The Record of PWA. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Federal Emergency Relief Administration, 1939, 298 pp. (A.S.917/21) 71 UNITED STATES FEDERAL EMERGENCY ADMINISTRATION OF PUBLIC WORKS. Building for Recovery: The Story of PWA. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Federal Emergency Relief Administration, 1939, 16 pp. (A.S.917/18) WILBUR, RAY L. and WILLIAM A. DU PUY. Conservation in the Department of the Interior. Washington, D.C.: Government Printing Office, 1931, 252 pp. (10408.q.4) WILLIAMS, JUANITA KERWIN. Grants-in-Aid under the Public Works Administration: A Study in Federal-State-Local Relations. New York: Columbia University Press, 1939, 292 pp. (08286.ee.47); New York: AMS Press, 1968, 291 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(459.)) 2. Civilian Conservation Corps COLE, OLEN. The African-American Experience in the Civilian Conservation Corps. Gainesville: University Press of Florida, 1999, 114 pp. (DSC 99/28387) DEARBORN, NED H. Once in a Lifetime: A Guide to the CCC Camp. New York: Merrill, 1936, 302 pp. (YA.1988.a.21248) HARBY, SAMUEL F. A Study of Education in the Civilian Conservation Corps Camps of the Second Corps Area, April 1933-March 1937. Ann Arbor, Mich.: Edwards, 1938, 264 pp. (08385.c.9) HILL, EDWIN G. In the Shadow of the Mountain: The Spirit of the CCC. Pullman: Washington State University Press, 1990, 187 pp. (YA.1993.a.19587) HOLLAND, KENNETH and FRANK E. HILL. Youth in the CCC: Prepared for the American Youth Commission. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Education: 1942, 263 pp. (X.520/7365) HOYT, RAY. 'We Can Take It': A Short Story of the CCC. New York: American Book Co., 1935, 128 pp. (010410.ee.12) KYLIE, H. R., G. H. HIERONYMUS and A. G. HALL. CCC (Civilian Conservation Corps) Forestry. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Forest Service, 1937, 334 pp. (07076.dd.52) LACY, LESLIE A. The Soil Soldiers: The Civilian Conservation Corps in the Great Depression. Radnor, Pa.: Chilton, 1976, 239 pp. (X.529/34716) MERRILL, PERRY H. Roosevelt's Forest Army: A History of the Civilian Conservation Corps, 1933-1942. Montpelier, Vt.: P. H. Merrill, 1981, 208 pp. (YA.1986.a.9560) OLIVER, ALFRED C. and HAROLD M. DUDLEY, eds. This New America: The Spirit of the Civilian Conservation Corps. London: Longmans, 1937, 188 pp. (8288.aa.38) 72 SAVAGE, CHRISTINE E. New Deal Adobe: The Civilian Conservation Corps and the Reconstruction of Mission La Purisima, 1934-1942. Santa Barbara, Calif.: Fithian Press, 1991, 162 pp. (YA.1992.a.21027) SOIL CONSERVATION SERVICE AND UNITED STATES FOREST SERVICE. The CCC at Work: A Story of 2,500,000 Young Men. Washington, D.C.: Government Printing Office, 1941, 103 pp. (A.S.987/8) 3. Parks ALBRIGHT, HORACE M., RUSSELL E. DICKENSON and WILLIAM PENN MOTT, JR. National Park Service: The Story Behind the Scenery. Las Vegas, Nev.: KC Publications, 1987, 93 pp. (YA.1990.b.1750) BUTLER, GEORGE D. Municipal and County Parks in the United States, 1935. Washington, D.C.: National Park Service, 1937, 147 pp. (A.S.194/27) BUXTON, BARRY M. and STEVEN M. BEATTY, eds. Blue Ridge Parkway: Agent of Transition; Golden Anniversary Conference Papers. Boone, N.C.: Appalachian Consortium, 1986, 272 pp. (DSC 88/01704) CHITTENDEN, HIRAM M. The Yellowstone National Park. Rev. by Eleanor Chittenden Cress and Isabelle F. Story. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press; London: Oxford University Press, 1933, 286 pp. (010410.eee.16) GOOD, ALBERT H. Park and Recreation Structures. 3 vols. Washington, D.C.: National Park Service, 1938. (A.S.197/4) ISE, JOHN. Our National Park Policy: A Critical History. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins Press, 1961, 701 pp. (010160.k.32) STORY, ISABELLE F. The National Parks and Emergency Conservation. Rev. ed., Washington, D.C.: National Park Service, 1936, 37 pp. (A.S.196/15) YARD, ROBERT S. The National Parks Portfolio. Rev. by Isabelle F. Story. 6th ed., Washington, D.C.: National Park Service, 1931, 274 pp. (A.S.195/18) 4. Tennessee Valley Authority CLAPP, GORDON R. The TVA: An Approach to the Development of a Region. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1955, 206 pp. (Ac.2691.dw.(28.)) CREESE, WALTER L. TVA's Public Planning: The Vision, the Reality. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1990, 388 pp. (YA.1992.b.4424) GRANT, NANCY L. TVA and Black Americans: Planning for the Status Quo. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1990, 207 pp. (YA.1992.b.2589) 73 HARGROVE, ERWIN C. Prisoners of Myth: The Leadership of the Tennessee Valley Authority, 1933-1990. Princeton, N.J., and Chichester: Princeton University Press, 1994, 374 pp. (YC.1996.b.2011) HUBBARD, PRESTON J. Origins of the TVA: The Muscle Shoals Controversy, 19201932. Nashville, Tenn.: Vanderbilt University Press, 1961, 340 pp. (X.519/852) KYLE, JOHN H. The Building of the TVA: An Illustrated History. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1958, 162 pp. (08765.d.33) LILIENTHAL, DAVID E. TVA: Democracy on the March. New York and London: Harper, 1944, 248 pp. (8287.l.60); Harmondsworth and New York: Penguin Books, 1944, 208 pp. (12208.a.2/151); 20th anniversary ed., New York: Harper, 1953, 294 pp. (10414.e.34) MCCRAW, THOMAS K. Morgan vs. Lilienthal: The Feud within the TVA. Chicago: Loyola University Press, 1970, 153 pp. (X.800/6971) MCCRAW, THOMAS K. TVA and the Power Fight, 1933-1939. Philadelphia: Lippincott, 1971, 201 pp. (X.629/4978) MCDONALD, MICHAEL. TVA and the Dispossessed: The Resettlement of Population in the Norris Dam Area. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1982, 334 pp. (DSC 83/01051) PRITCHETT, CHARLES H. The Tennessee Valley Authority: A Study in Public Administration. New York: Russell & Russell, 1971, 333 pp. (X.520/34269) SELZNICK, PHILIP. TVA and the Grass Roots: A Study in the Sociology of Formal Organization. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Publications in Culture and Society, 1949, 274 pp. (Ac.2689.g/59; 08285.i.50) WHEELER, WILLIAM B. and MICHAEL J. MCDONALD. TVA and the Tellico Dam, 1936-1979: A Bureaucratic Crisis in Post-industrial America. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1986, 290 pp. (DSC 86/25643) K. RECONSTRUCTION FINANCE CORPORATION JONES, JESSE H. and EDWARD ARALY. Fifty Billion Dollars: My Thirteen Years with the RFC, 1932-1945. New York: Macmillan, 1951, 631 pp. (8290.h.5) OLSON, JAMES S. Herbert Hoover and the Reconstruction Finance Corporation, 19311933. Ames: Iowa State University Press, 1977, 155 pp. (X.950/30416) OLSON, JAMES S. Saving Capitalism: The Reconstruction Finance Corporation and the New Deal, 1933-1940. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1988, 155 pp. (YC.1991.a.624) L. SHARECROPPERS AND TENANT FARMERS 74 AGEE, JAMES R. and WALKER EVANS. Let Us Now Praise Famous Men. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1960, 471 pp. (10153.ff.26); London: Peter Owen, 1965, 471. (X.800/789); London: Panther Books, 1969, 428 pp. (X.808/6149) BÖGER, ASTRID. Documenting Lives: James Agee's and Walker Evans's Let Us Now Praise Famous Men. Frankfurt am Main: Lang, 1994, 173 pp. (YA.1996.a.3704) CONRAD, DAVID E. The Forgotten Farmers: The Story of Sharecroppers in the New Deal. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1965, 223 pp. (X.311/666) GRUBBS, DONALD H. Cry from the Cotton: The Southern Tenant Farmers' Union and the New Deal. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1971, 218 pp. (X.329/6075) HAGOOD, MARGARET J. Mothers of the South: Portraiture of the White Tenant Farm Woman. Reprint, New York: Greenwood, 1969, 252 pp. (YA.1990.a.21070); Charlottesville and London: University Press of Virginia, 1996, 252 pp. (YC.1997.a.2102) JOHNSON, CHARLES S., EDWIN R. EMBREE and W. W. ALEXANDER The Collapse of Cotton Tenancy: Summary of Field Studies and Statistical Surveys, 1933-35. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1935, 81 pp. (Mic.A.10108) KESTER, HOWARD. Revolt among the Sharecroppers. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1969, 98 pp. (X.950/33133) MITCHELL, H. L. Mean Things Happening in This Land: The Life and Times of H. L. Mitchell, Co-founder of the Southern Tenant Farmers Union. Montclair, N.J.: Allanheld, Osmun, 1979, 358 pp. (X.529/49151) RAPER, ARTHUR F. Preface to Peasantry: A Tale of Two Black Belt Counties. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1936, 423 pp. (Mic.A.17012) RAPER, ARTHUR F. and IRA DE A. REID. Sharecroppers All. Reissue, New York: Russell & Russell, 1971, 281 pp. (X.809/60316) STIMPSON, EDDIE. My Remembers: A Black Sharecropper's Recollections of the Depression. Denton: University of North Texas Press, 1996, 167 pp. (YA.1997.b.1745) M. TAXATION BEITO, DAVID T. Taxpayers in Revolt: Tax Resistance during the Great Depression. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1989, 216 pp. (YC.1989.b.6068) BLAKEY, ROY G. and GLADYS M. C. BLAKEY. The Federal Income Tax. New York: Longmans, 1940, 640 pp. (06617.ee.31) 75 LEFF, MARK H. The Limits of Symbolic Reform: The New Deal and Taxation, 19331939. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1984, 308 pp. (YC.1988.b.3709) LENT, GEORGE E. The Impact of the Undistributed Profits Tax, 1936-1937. New York: Columbia University Press, 1948, 203 pp. (Ac.2688/2) SHOUP, CARL S. Facing the Tax Problem: A Survey of Taxation in the United States and a Program for the Future. New York: Twentieth Century Fund, 1940, 606 pp. (8231.d.72) SHOUP, CARL S. The Sales Tax in the American States. New York: Columbia University Press, 1934, 833 pp. (08229.p.7) N. TRANSPORTATION AND TRAVEL 1. General Studies FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. The Intracoastal Waterway: Norfolk to Key West. Washington, D.C.: Government Printing Office, 1937, 143 pp. (10413.n.11) HULTGREN, THOR. American Transportation in Prosperity and Depression. New York: National Bureau of Economic Research, 1948, 397 pp. (Mic.A.8516) KETTERING, CHARLES F. and ALLEN ORTH. The New Necessity: The Culmination of a Century of Progress in Transportation. Baltimore, Md.: Williams & Wilkins, 1932, 124 pp. (Mic.A.12772) MOULTON, HAROLD G., et al. The American Transportation Problem. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1933, 915 pp. (Mic.A.10111) ROBBINS, TRINA and CASEY ROBBINS, eds. Travel and Vacation Advertising Cuts from the Twenties and Thirties. New York: Dover, 1994, 94 pp. (YK.1995.b.7589) VAN METRE, T. W. Transportation in the United States. Chicago: Foundation Press, 1939, 403 pp. (Mic.A.12755) WILLEY, MALCOLM M. and STUART A. RICE. Communication Agencies and Social Life. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 229 pp. (X.800/1629.(1.)) 2. Air Transportation ARCHBOLD, RICK. Hindenburg: An Illustrated History. London: Weidenfeld & Nicolson, 1994, 229 pp. (LB.37.b.598) ARNOLD, HENRY H. and IRA C. EAKER. This Flying Game. New York and London: Funk & Wagnalls, 1936, 275 pp. (08770.c.44); 2d ed., New York and London: Funk & Wagnalls, 1938, 307 pp. (08771.cc.15) 76 BERG, A. SCOTT. Lindbergh. London: Macmillan, 1998, 628 pp. (YC.1998.b.5731) CORN, JOSEPH J. The Winged Gospel: America's Romance with Aviation, 1900-1950. New York: Oxford University Press, 1983, 177 pp. (X.622/19118) DALEY, ROBERT. American Saga: Juan Trippe and His Pan Am Empire. New York: Random House, 1980, 529 pp. (DSC 80/18577) DAVID, PAUL T. The Economics of Air Mail Transportation. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1934, 235 pp. (Ac.2391/3) DICK, HAROLD G. The Golden Age of the Great Passenger Airships, Graf Zeppelin and Hindenburg. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1985, 226 pp. (YK.1994.b.5646) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Who's Who in Aviation: A Directory of Living Men and Women Who Have Contributed to the Growth of Aviation in the United States, 1942-43. Chicago: Ziff-Davis, 1942. (Mic.B.920) GOERNER, FRED. The Search for Amelia Earhart. London: Bodley Head, 1966, 286 pp. (X.809/2894) HOEHLING, ADOLPH A. Who Destroyed the Hindenburg? London: Hale, 1962, 191 pp. (8237.aa.17) JOSEPHSON, MATTHEW. Empire of the Air: Juan Trippe and the Struggle for World Airways. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1944, 236 pp. (8236.e.15) KELSEY, BENJAMIN S. The Dragon's Teeth? The Creation of United States Air Power for World War II. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1982, 148 pp. (X.800/43223) KNOWLTON, HUGH. Air Transportation in the United States: Its Growth as a Business. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 72 pp. (8287.cc.65) KOMONS, NICK A. Bonfires to Beacons: Federal Civil Aviation Policy under the Air Commerce Act, 1926-1938. Washington, D.C.: Federal Aviation Administration, 1978, 454 pp. (AS.1059/144); Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1990, 454 pp. (YC.1991.b.360) LEWIS, W. DAVID and WILLIAM F. TRIMBLE. The Airway to Everywhere: A History of All American Aviation, 1937-1953. Pittsburgh, Pa.: University of Pittsburgh Press, 1988, 230 pp. (YA.1992.b.4094) MAURER, MAURER. Aviation in the U.S. Army, 1919-1939. Washington, D.C.: Office of Air Force History, U.S. Air Force, 1987, 626 pp. (DSC OP-US/6443) 77 NEWTON, WESLEY P. The Perilous Sky: U.S. Aviation Diplomacy and Latin America, 1919-1931. Coral Gables, Fla.: University of Miami Press, 1978, 457 pp. (X.629/21066) OAKES, CLAUDIA M. United States Women in Aviation, 1930-1939. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1991, 70 pp. (DSC 99/29330) PUTNAM, GEORGE P. Soaring Wings: A Biography of Amelia Earhart. London: Harrap, 1940, 270 pp. (10888.e.22) RAE, JOHN B. Climb to Greatness: The American Aircraft Industry, 1920-1960. Cambridge, Mass., and London: MIT. Press, 1968, 280 pp. (X.510/2337) SMITH, HENRY L. Airways: The History of Commercial Aviation in the United States. New York: A. A. Knopf, 1942, 430 pp. (8236.g.7) UNDERWOOD, JEFFERY S. The Wings of Democracy: The Influence of Air Power on the Roosevelt Administration, 1933-1941. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1991, 234 pp. (YA.1993.b.6174) 3. Automobiles ASCH, NATHAN. The Road: In Search of America. New York: Norton, 1937, 271 pp. (Mic.A.12107) BELASCO, WARREN J. Americans on the Road: From Autocamp to Motel, 19101945. Cambridge, Mass., and London: MIT Press, 1979, 212 pp. (X.800/29010) BLISS, CAREY S. Autos Across America: A Bibliography of Transcontinental Automobile Travel: 1903-1940. Los Angeles, Calif.: Dawson's Book Shop, 1972, 60 pp. (X.809/22809) BURNESS, TAD. Cars of the Early Thirties. Philadelphia and London: Chilton, 1970, 275 pp. (X.622/1161) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. The Ocean Highway: New Brunswick, New Jersey, to Jacksonville, Florida. New York: Modern Age Books, 1938, 224 pp. (10413.m.16) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. U.S. One: Maine to Florida. New York: Modern Age Books, 1938, 344 pp. (010410.d.2) GEDDES, NORMAN BEL. Magic Motorways. New York: Random House, 1940, 297 pp. (Mic.A.11738) RUETER, JOHN C. American Road Racing: The Automobile Racing Club of America in the 1930's. New York: Barnes; London: Thomas Yoseloff, 1963, 139 pp. (7925.h.30) 78 VANDERVEEN, BART H., ed. American Trucks of the Early Thirties. London and New York: Warne, 1974, 64 pp. (Cup.1262.gg.12) VANDERVEEN, BART H., ed. American Trucks of the Late Thirties, 1935-1939. London: Warne, 1975, 64 pp. (Cup.1281/14) 4. Railroads LATHAM, EARL. The Politics of Railroad Coordination, 1933-1936. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1959, 338 pp. (8247.1.29) LAUT, AGNES C. The Romance of the Rails: The Story of the American Railroads. New York: Tudor Pub., 1936, 590 pp. (X.622/8305) MAIKEN, PETER T. Night Trains: The Pullman System in the Golden Years of American Rail Travel. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1992, 415 pp. (YK.1994.b.2018) REYNOLDS, ROGER. Famous American Trains and Their Stories. New York: Grosset & Dunlap, 1934, 94 pp. (20018.dd.5) O. UTILITIES AND ENERGY ANDERSON, IRVINE H. Aramco, the United States and Saudi Arabia: A Study of the Dynamics of Foreign Oil Policy, 1933-1950. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1981, 259 pp. (X.529/43326; T44152 OIOC) BAKER, RALPH H. The National Bituminous Coal Commission: Administration of the Bituminous Coal Act, 1937-1941. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Studies in Historical and Political Science, 1941, 356 pp. (Ac.2689) BEAUDREAU, BERNARD C. Mass Production, the Stock Market Crash and the Great Depression: The Macroeconomics of Electrification. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1996, 182 pp. (YC.1997.b.1384) BONBRIGHT, JAMES C. Public Utilities and the National Power Policies. New York: Columbia University Press, 1940, 82 pp. (08286.ee.62) BROWN, D. CLAYTON. Electricity for Rural America: The Fight for the REA. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1980, 178 pp. (X.629/14957) CLARK, JOHN G. Energy and the Federal Government: Fossil Fuel Policies, 1900-1946. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1987, 511 pp. (DSC 87/04478) COLEMAN, MCALISTER. Men and Coal. New York and Toronto: Farrar & Rinehart, 1943, 350 pp. (8286.b.84) COYLE, DAVID C., ed. Electric Power on the Farm: The Story of Electricity, Its Usefulness on Farms and the Movement to Electrify Rural America. Washington, D.C.: Rural Electrification Administration, 1936, 170 pp. (A.S.973/5) 79 FUNIGIELLO, PHILIP J. Toward a National Power Policy: The New Deal and the Electric Utility Industry, 1933-1941. Pittsburgh, Pa.,: University of Pittsburgh Press, 1973, 296 pp. (X.620/7947) JOHNSON, JAMES P. The Politics of Soft Coal: The Bituminous Industry from World War I through the New Deal. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1979, 258 pp. (X.622/8692) MEYER, LORENZO. Mexico and the United States in the Oil Controversy, 1917-1942. Austin and London: University of Texas Press, 1977, 367 pp. (X.320/11064) MOSHER, WILLIAM E. and FINLA G. CRAWFORD. Public Utility Regulation. New York and London: Harper, 1933, 612 pp. (8224.t.24) MULLER, FREDERICK W. Public Rural Electrification. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Public Affairs, 1944, 183 pp. (8759.d.33) PARKER, GLEN L. The Coal Industry: A Study in Social Control. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Public Affairs, 1940. (Mic.A.19488) RAMSAY, MARION L. Pyramids of Power: The Story of Roosevelt, Insull and the Utility Wars. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill, 1937, 342 pp. (8288.aaa.28) RANDALL, STEPHEN J. United States Foreign Oil Policy, 1919-1948: For Profits and Security. Kingston and Montreal: McGill-Queen's University Press, 1985, 328 pp. (DSC 85/17019) SHUMAN, RONALD B. The Petroleum Industry: An Economic Survey. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1940, 297 pp. (8232.bb.61) TOBEY, RONALD C. Technology as Freedom: The New Deal and the Electrical Modernization of the American Home. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1996, 316 pp. (YC.1997.b.4964) WATKINS, MYRON W. Oil: Stabilization or Conservation? A Case Study in the Organization of Industrial Control. New York and London: Harper, 1937, 269 pp. (8234.cc.26) V. SOCIAL HISTORY A. GENERAL STUDIES BOLINO, AUGUST C. From Depression to War: American Society in Transition--1939. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1998, 296 pp. (YC.1998.b.4800) 80 BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. Social Work and the Courts: Select Statutes and Judicial Decisions. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934, 610 pp. (Ac.2691.d/29.(6.)) COHN, DAVID L. The Good Old Days: A History of American Morals and Manners as Seen through the Sears, Roebuck Catalogs, 1905 to the Present. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1940, 597 pp. (10413.p.12) CRESSEY, PAUL G. The Taxi-Dance Hall: A Sociological Study in Commercialized Recreation and City Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 300 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(14.)) ENZLER, CLARENCE J. Some Social Aspects of the Depression, 1930-1935. Washington, D.C.: Catholic University of America Press, 1939, 187 pp. (8290.ff.30) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. Women and Minorities during the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 349 pp. (YC.1991.b.546) FERGUSON, CHARLES W. Fifty Million Brothers: A Panorama of American Lodges and Clubs. New York and Toronto: Farrar & Rinehart, 1937, 389 pp. (20032.k.8) FISCHER, CLAUDE S. America Calling: A Social History of the Telephone to 1940. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1992, 424 pp. (YC.1993.b.3858); Berkeley: University of California Press, 1992, 424 pp. (YA.1993.b.4931) FURNAS, JOSEPH C. Stormy Weather: Crosslights on the Nineteen Thirties; an Infernal Social History of the United States 1929-1941. New York: Putnam's, 1977, 669 pp. (X.520/20613) GREEN, HARVEY. The Uncertainty of Everyday Life, 1915-1945. New York: HarperCollins, 1992, 262 pp. (YA.1993.a.12492) GREENAN, JOHN T., ed. American Civilization Today: A Summary of Recent Social Trends. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1934, 152 pp. (W.P.10252/5) HALLGREN, MAURITZ A. Seeds of Revolt: A Study of American Life and the Temper of the American People during the Depression. New York: Knopf, 1933, 369 pp. (010409.eee.65) OGBURN, WILLIAM F., ed. Social Change and the New Deal. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934, 120 pp. (8286.c.10) PEELER, DAVID P. Hope Among Us Yet: Social Criticism and Social Solace in Depression America. Athens: University of Georgia Press, 1987, 340 pp. (YH.1988.b.366) 81 PRESIDENT'S RESEARCH COMMITTEE ON SOCIAL TRENDS. Recent Social Trends in the United States. 2 vols. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933. (8282.v.27) RUNDQUIST, EDWARD A. and RAYMOND F. SLETTO. Personality in the Depression: A Study in the Measurement of Attitudes. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Institute of Child Welfare, 1936, 398 pp. (Ac.2692.ky) VAILE, ROLAND S. Research Memorandum on Social Aspects of Consumption in the Depression. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1972, 86 pp. (X.529/62782) WILLEY, MALCOLM M. and STUART A. RICE. Communication Agencies and Social Life. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 229 pp. (X.800/1629.(1.)) B. CHILDREN AND YOUTH ALLEN, BETTY and MITCHELL P. BRIGGS. Behave Yourself! Etiquette for American Youth. Chicago: Lippincott, 1937, 163 pp. (8408.h.58) CLAUSEN, JOHN A. American Lives: Looking Back at the Children of the Great Depression. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1995, 592 pp. (YC.1995.a.4261) DAVIS, ALLISON and JOHN DOLLARD. Children of Bondage: The Personality Development of Negro Youth in the Urban South. New York: Harper and Row, 1964, 299 pp. (X.808/189) ELDER, GLEN H., JR. Children of the Great Depression: Social Change in Life Experience. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1977, 400 pp. (X.519/27272) FORMAN, HENRY J. Our Movie Made Children. New York: Macmillan, 1933, 288 pp. (11796.bbb.1) FRAZIER, EDWARD F. Negro Youth at the Crossroads: Their Personality Development in the Middle States. Washington, D.C.: American Youth Commission, 1940, 301 pp. (8288.g.68) HOLLAND, KENNETH and FRANK E. HILL. Youth in the CCC: Prepared for the American Youth Commission. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Education: 1942, 263 pp. (X.520/7365) JOHNSON, CHARLES S. Growing Up in the Black Belt: Negro Youth in the Rural South. Washington, D.C.: American Youth Commission, 1941, 360 pp. (08385.b.84) JOHNSON, PALMER O. and OSWALD L. HARVEY. The National Youth Administration. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Commission on Education, 1938, 117 pp. (A.S.988) 82 LINDLEY, BETTY and ERNEST K. LINDLEY. A New Deal for Youth: The Story of the National Youth Administration. New York: Viking, 1939, 315 pp. (08385.a.32) LORWIN, LEWIS L. Youth Work Programs: Problems and Policies. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1974, 195 pp. (X.520/34294) MELVIN, BRUCE L. Rural Youth on Relief. Research Monograph no. 11. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 112 pp. (A.S.978/7) MELVIN, BRUCE L. and ELNA N. SMITH. Rural Youth: Their Situation and Prospects. Research Monograph no. 15. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 167 pp. (A.S.978/7) MELVIN, BRUCE L. and ELNA N. SMITH. Youth in Agricultural Villages. Research Monograph no. 21. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1940, 143 pp. (A.S.978/7) MINEHAN, THOMAS. Boy and Girl Tramps of America. Reprint, Seattle and London: University of Washington Press, 1976, 267 pp. (X.529/31736) PHELPS, ORME W. The Legislative Background of the Fair Labor Standards Act: A Study of the Growth of National Sentiment in Favor of Governmental Regulation of Wages, Hours and Child Labor. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 71 pp. (Ac.2691.e/5; Mic.A.10070) PUTTEE, DOROTHY F. and MARY R. COLBY. The Illegitimate Child in Illinois. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1937, 250 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(38.)) REIMAN, RICHARD A. The New Deal and American Youth: Ideas and Ideals in a Depression Decade. Athens: University of Georgia Press, 1992, 253 pp. (YA.1993.b.2967) THRASHER, FREDERIC M. The Gang: A Study of 1,313 Gangs in Chicago. 2d rev. ed., Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1936, 605 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(17.)) WEISENBERGER, CAROL A. Dollars and Dreams: The National Youth Administration in Texas. New York: Lang, 1994, 198 pp. (DSC 7303.9990 vol 6) WILLIAMS, JAMES M. Human Aspects of Unemployment and Relief, with Special Reference to the Effects of the Depression on Children. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina, 1933, 235 pp. (Ac.2685.kc.(56.)) C. CLOTHING BAILEY, MARGARET J. Those Glorious Glamour Years: Classic Hollywood Costume Design of the 1930's. London: Columbus, 1988, 384 pp. (YV.1989.b.1584) 83 BLUM, STELLA, ed. Everyday Fashions of the Thirties, as Pictured in Sears Catalogs. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1986, 133 pp. (YV.1988.b.2337) CONNERY, ROBERT H. The Administration of an N.R.A. Code: A Case Study of the Men's Clothing Industry. Chicago: Public Administration Service, 1938, 211 pp. (Ac.2286.b) GRAFTON, CAROL B., ed. Fashions of the Thirties: 476 Authentic Copyright-Free Illustrations. New York: Dover, 1993, 62 pp. (YK.1995.b.5088) GOLDMAN, E. S., ed. The New York Story: A History Of The New York Clothing Industry, 1924-1949. New York: New York Clothing Manufacturers' Exchange, 1949, 88 pp. (Mic.A.16778) TIERNEY, TOM. Thirty from the 30's. Englewood Cliffs, N.J., and London: Prentice-Hall, 1974, 70 pp. (L.45/2390) D. CRIME [See also III.G; H. Government and Politics: Judicial and Legal System; Federal Bureau of Investigation] 1. Miscellaneous Studies ASBURY, HERBERT. The Underworld of Chicago: An Informal History. London: Hale, 1941, 364 pp. (6059.b.2) BLOCK, ALAN A. East Side-West Side: Organizing Crime in New York, 1930-1950. Cardiff: University College Cardiff Press, 1980, 265 pp. (X.529/48372) BLUMER, HERBERT and PHILIP M. HAUSER. Movies, Delinquency and Crime. New York: Macmillan, 1933, 233 pp. (X.329/7538.(5.)) DOWELL, ELRIDGE F. A History of Criminal Syndicalism Legislation in the United States. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Studies in Historical and Political Science, 1939, 176 pp. (Ac.2689) FEDER, SID and JOACHIM F. JOESTEN. The Luciano Story. New York: David McKay, 1954, 327 pp. (6059.h.46) HOFFMAN, DENNIS E. Scarface Al and the Crime Crusaders: Chicago's Private War against Capone. Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press, 1993, 192 pp. (YA.1996.b.706) KIRCHNER, L. R. Triple Cross Fire! J. Edgar Hoover and the Kansas City Union Station Massacre. Kansas City, Mo.: Janlar Books, 1993, 176 pp. (YA.1997.a.13158) LANGMAN, LARRY and DANIEL FINN. A Guide to American Crime Films of the Thirties. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1995, 347 pp. (YC.1995.b.3213) 84 LEVINE, GARY. Anatomy of a Gangster: Jack 'Legs' Diamond. South Brunswick, N.J.: Barnes; London: Thomas Yoseloff, 1979, 200 pp. (X.200/38023) LYSING, HENRY. Men Against Crime. New York: D. Kemp, 1938, 265 pp. (6057.t.2) MILNER, E. R. The Life and Times of Bonnie and Clyde. Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press, 1996, 187 pp. (DSC 97/02816) MILLSPAUGH, ARTHUR C. Crime Control by the National Government. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1937, 306 pp. (Mic.A.8750) MURCHISON, KENNETH M. Federal Criminal Law Doctrines: The Forgotten Influence of National Prohibition. Durham, N.C.: Duke University Press, 1994, 279 pp. (YC.1995.b.7447) POWELL, HICKMAN. Ninety Times Guilty. London: Hale, 1939, 287 pp. (6057.r.25) RECKLESS, WALTER C. Vice in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1933, 314 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(15.)) REYNOLDS, QUENTIN. I, Willie Sutton. London: Cassell, 1954, 273 pp. (10884.l.11) SCADUTO, ANTHONY. Lucky Luciano: The Man Who Modernized the Mafia. London: Sphere, 1976, 208 pp. (X.108/16622) STOLBERG, MARY M. Fighting Organized Crime: Politics, Justice and the Legacy of Thomas E. Dewey. Boston: Northeastern University Press, 1995, 315 pp. (DSC 95/35704) TOLAND, JOHN. The Dillinger Days. London: Arthur Barker, 1963, 371 pp. (6957.h.45); London: Mayflower Books, 1978, 286 pp. (X.208/923) THRASHER, FREDERIC M. The Gang: A Study of 1,313 Gangs in Chicago. 2d rev. ed., Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1936, 605 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(17.)) TREHERNE, JOHN. The Strange History of Bonnie and Clyde. London: Cape, 1984, 245 pp. (X.200/44481); London: Triad Grafton, 1985, 245 pp. (H.86/649) VAN CISE, PHILIP S. Fighting the Underworld. London: Eyre & Spottiswoode, 1936, 369 pp. (6055.r.5) WALLIS, MICHAEL. Pretty Boy: The Life and Times of Charles Arthur Floyd. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1992, 375 pp. (YA.1993.b.9771) 2. Lindbergh Kidnapping 85 BEHN, NOEL. Lindbergh: The Crime. New York: Atlantic Monthly, 1994, 464 pp. (YA.1995.b.4174) BERG, A. SCOTT. Lindbergh. London: Macmillan, 1998, 628 pp. (YC.1998.b.5731) FISHER, JIM. The Lindbergh Case. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1987, 480 pp. (YA.1990.b.1934) WHIPPLE, SIDNEY B. The Lindbergh Crime. New York: Blue Ribbon Books, 1935, 341 pp. (X.200/8153); London: Methuen, 1935, 294 pp. (6055.p.27) E. FAMILY ANGELL, ROBERT C. The Family Encounters the Depression. Gloucester, Mass.: Peter Smith, 1965, 309 pp. (X.809/4609) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. The Family and the State: Selected Documents. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934, 565 pp. (Ac.2691.d/29.(5.)) CAVAN, RUTH S. and KATHERINE H. RANCK. The Family and the Depression: A Study of One Hundred Chicago Families. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1938, 208 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36.(36.)) COLE, WILLIAM E. Rural Rehabilitation Services in Knox County, Tennessee 1935: Economic and Social Effects of the Depression upon Relief Families in Knoxville, Tennessee. Knoxville: University of Tennessee, 1936, 32 pp. (8286.f.54) KOMAROVSKY, MIRRA. The Unemployed Man and His Family--The Effect of Unemployment upon the Status of the Man in Fifty-nine Families. New York: Dryden Press, 1940, 163 pp. (8287.ee.63) KYRK, HAZEL. Economic Problems of the Family. New York and London: Harper, 1933, 500 pp. (8277.r.25) KYRK, HAZEL, et al. Family Expenditures for Housing and Household Operation: Five Regions. Washington, D.C.: Bureau of Home Economics, U.S. Dept. of Agriculture, 1941. (A.S.802/5) KYRK, HAZEL, et al. Family Housing and Facilities: Five Regions. Washington, D.C.: Bureau of Home Economics, U.S. Dept. of Agriculture, 1940, 223 pp. (A.S.802/5) MORGAN, WINONA L. The Family Meets the Depression: A Study of a Group of Highly Selected Families. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Institute of Child Welfare, 1939, 126 pp. (Ac.2692.ky) MOWRER, ERNEST R. Family Disorganization. 2d ed., Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 356 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(21.)) 86 MOWRER, ERNEST R. The Family: Its Organization and Disorganization. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 364 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(11.)) NIMKOFF, MEYER F. The Family. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1934, 526 pp. (8286.b.36) STOUFFER, SAMUEL A. and PAUL F. LAZARSFELD. Research Memorandum on the Family in the Depression. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1972, 221 pp. (X.529/62790) WANDERSEE, WINIFRED D. Women's Work and Family Values, 1920-1940. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1981, 165 pp. (X.520/25163) F. FOOD CUMMINGS, RICHARD O. The American and His Food: A History of Food Habits in the United States. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1940, 267 pp. (7945.r.6); 2d ed., Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 291 pp. (7946.e.12). GAIGE, CROSBY. New York World's Fair Cook Book: The American Kitchen. New York: Doubleday, Doran, 1939, 309 pp. (7944.t.37) JACKSON, CHARLES O. Food and Drug Legislation in the New Deal. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1970, 249 pp. (X.200/3805) LEVENSTEIN, HARVEY A. Paradox of Plenty: A Social History of Eating in Modern America. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1993, 337 pp. (YC.1993.b.3100; YC.1995.a.1783) POPPENDIECK, JANET. Breadlines Knee-deep in Wheat: Food Assistance in the Great Depression. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1986, 306 pp. (DSC 86/09585) G. HOUSING ABBOTT, EDITH. The Tenements of Chicago, 1908-1935. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1936, 505 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2; Mic.A.16974) ARONOVICI, CAROL, ed. America Can't Have Housing? New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1934, 78 pp. (Mic.A.16738) ARONOVICI, CAROL. Housing the Masses. New York: Wiley, 1939, 291 pp. (8287.f.26) BENT, SILAS. Slaves by the Billion: The Story of Mechanical Progress in the Home. New York and Toronto: Longmans, 1938, 244 pp. (8288.e.11) 87 COLEAN, MILES L. American Housing: Problems and Prospects. New York: Twentieth Century Fund, 1944, 466 pp. (08286.k.61; 8287.e.70) FISHER, ROBERT M. 20 Years of Public Housing: Economic Aspects of the Federal Program. New York: Harper, 1959, 303 pp. (8297.aa.16) FORD, JAMES. Slums and Housing, with Special Reference to New York City: History, Conditions, Policy. 2 vols. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1936, 1033 pp. (8287.d.11) MASON, JOSEPH B. History of Housing in the U.S., 1930-1960. Houston: Gulf, 1982, 187 pp. (X.805/7387) POST, LANGDON W. The Challenge of Housing. New York: Farrar & Rinehart, 1938, 309 pp. (Mic.A.12428) RADFORD, GAIL. Modern Housing for America: Policy Struggles in the New Deal Era. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1996, 273 pp. (DSC 97/08208) SCHNAPPER, MORRIS B., comp. Public Housing in America. New York: H. W. Wilson, 1940, 369 pp. (8287.aa.65) SHULMAN, HARRY M. Slums of New York. New York: Albert & Charles Boni, 1938, 394 pp. (8288.f.31) STAP, PEYTON. Urban Housing: A Summary of Real Property Inventories Conducted as Work Projects, 1934-1936. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 326 pp. (A.S.978/49.(4.)) STRAUS, MICHAEL W. and TALBOT WEGG. Housing Comes of Age. New York: Oxford University Press, 1938, 259 pp. (08286.i.19) STRAUS, NATHAN. The Seven Myths of Housing. New York: Knopf, 1944, 314 pp. (8288.f.54) TOBEY, RONALD C. Technology as Freedom: The New Deal and the Electrical Modernization of the American Home. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1996, 316 pp. (YC.1997.b.4964) TROLANDER, JUDITH A. Settlement Houses and the Great Depression. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1975, 216 pp. (X.800/28437) VANCE, RUPERT B. and GORDON W. BLACKWELL New Farm Homes for Old: A Study of Rural Public Housing in the South. University: University of Alabama Press, 1946, 245 pp. (Mic.A.17705) VEILLER, LAWRENCE. The Housing Problem in the United States. New York: National Housing Association, 1930, 31 pp. (YA.1998.b.4025) 88 WATSON, FRANK D. Housing Problems and Possibilities in the United States. New York and London: Harper, 1935, 100 pp. (8287.bb.3) WENTWORTH, CYNTHIA and CARL FEISS. New York World's Fair, 1939: Guide to Housing Exhibits. Washington, D.C.: U. S. Housing Authority, 1939, 16 p. (A.S.997/4) WILSON, MAUD. Housing Requirements of Farm Families in the United States. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of Agriculture, 1939, 40 pp. (A.S.802/5) WOOD, EDITH E. Recent Trends in American Housing. New York: Macmillan Co., 1931, 317 pp. (8285.w.8) WOOD, EDITH E. Slums and Blighted Areas in the United States. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Federal Emergency Administration of Public Works, 1935, 126 pp. (A.S.917/10) H. PHILANTHROPY HOLLIS, ERNEST V. Philanthropic Foundations and Higher Education. New York: Columbia University Press, 1938, 365 pp. (08385.f.113) RADFORD, NEIL A. The Carnegie Corporation and the Development of American College Libraries, 1928-1941. Chicago: American Library Association, 1984, 257 pp. (2719.x.5617) SEALANDER, JUDITH. Private Wealth and Public Life: Foundation Philanthropy and the Reshaping of American Social Policy from the Progressive Era to the New Deal. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1997, 349 pp. (SPIS 361.7097309041) I. POPULATION AND INTERNAL MIGRATION BROWN, MALCOLM J. and ORIN CASSMORE. Migratory Cotton Pickers in Arizona. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1939, 23 pp. (A.S.978/43) COLLINS, HENRY H. America's Own Refugees: Our 4,000,000 Homeless Migrants. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1941, 323 pp. (10413.p.23) CROSS, WILLIAM T. Newcomers and Nomads in California. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1937, 149 pp. (08286.a.90) CROUSE, JOAN M. The Homeless Transient in the Great Depression: New York State, 1929-1941. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1986, 319 pp. (YC.1987.b.4429) GOODRICH, CARTER, et al. Migration and Economic Opportunity: The Report of the Study of Population Redistribution. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1936, 763 pp. (8287.d.45) 89 GOODRICH, CARTER L., et al. Migration and Planes of Living, 1920-1934. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1935, 111 pp. (Ac.2692.pi) GREGORY, JAMES N. American Exodus: The Dust Bowl Migration and Okie Culture in California. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1989, 338 pp. (YC.1990.b.6324) LIVELY, C. E. and CONRAD TAEUBER. Rural Migration in the United States. Research Monograph no. 19. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1939, 192 pp. (A.S.978/7) MCDONALD, MICHAEL. TVA and the Dispossessed: The Resettlement of Population in the Norris Dam Area. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1982, 334 pp. (DSC 83/01051) MCWILLIAMS, CAREY. Factories in the Field: The Story of Migratory Farm Labor in California. Boston: Little, Brown, 1939, 334 pp. (X.319/1933) MCWILLIAMS, CAREY. Ill Fares the Land: Migrants and Migratory Labour in the United States. London: Faber & Faber, 1945, 245 pp. (8287.de.71) MENEFEEE, SELDON C. Mexican Migratory Workers of South Texas. Washington, D.C.: Work Projects Administration, 1941, 67 pp. (A.S.978/48) SHINDO, CHARLES J. Dust Bowl Migrants in the American Imagination. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1997, 252 pp. (YC.1997.b.4928) STEIN, WALTER J. California and the Dust Bowl Migration. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1973, 302 pp. (X.329/7027) THOMPSON, WARREN S. The Growth of Metropolitan Districts in the United States: 1900-1940. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Bureau of the Census, 1947, 61 pp. (A.S.67/38) THOMPSON, WARREN S. and PASCAL K. WHELPTON. Population Trends in the United States. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 415 pp. (X.800/1629.(8.)); reprint, New York: Gordon & Breach, 1969, 415 pp. (X.809/7264) VANCE, RUPERT B. Research Memorandum on Population Distribution within the United States. New York: Social Science Research Council, 1938, 134 pp. (Mic.A.13591(5)) WEBB, JOHN N. and MALCOLM BROWN. Migrant Families. Research Monograph no. 18. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 192 pp. (A.S.978/7) 90 WEBB, JOHN N. The Migratory-Casual Worker. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 128 pp. (A.S.978/7) WEISIGER, MARSHA L. Land of Plenty: Oklahomans in the Cotton Fields of Arizona, 1933-1942. Norman and London: University of Oklahoma Press, 1995, 238 pp. (YC.1997.a.1863) J. PROHIBITION ASBURY, HERBERT. The Great Illusion: An Informal History of Prohibition. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, 1950, 344 pp. (8436.d.30) BEHR, EDWARD. Prohibition: The 13 Years that Changed America. London: BBC Books, 1997, 262 pp. (YC.1997.b.3089) CLARK, NORMAN H. The Dry Years: Prohibition and Social Change in Washington. Seattle: University of Washington Press, 1965, 304 pp. (X.809/3621) COFFEY, THOMAS M. The Long Thirst: Prohibition in America, 1920-1933. New York: Norton, 1975, 346 pp. (X.809/45343); London: Hamilton, 1976, 346 pp. (X.809/40614) HARRISON, LEONARD V. After Repeal: A Study of Liquor Control Administration. New York and London: Harper, 1936, 296 pp. (8436.d.15) KOBLER, JOHN. Ardent Spirits: The Rise and Fall of Prohibition. New York: Putnam's, 1973, 386 pp. (X.520/9005); London: Michael Joseph, 1974, 386 pp. (X.529/18016) KYVIG, DAVID E., ed. Law, Alcohol and Order: Perspectives on National Prohibition. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1985, 218 pp. (YC.1986.b.5406) KYVIG, DAVID E. Repealing National Prohibition. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1979, 274 pp. (X.520/21181) MURCHISON, KENNETH M. Federal Criminal Law Doctrines: The Forgotten Influence of National Prohibition. Durham, N.C.: Duke University Press, 1994, 279 pp. (YC.1995.b.7447) ROSE, KENNETH D. American Women and the Repeal of Prohibition. New York: New York University Press, 1996, 215 pp. (DSC 0857.430 33) RUMBARGER, JOHN J. Profits, Power and Prohibition: Alcohol Reform and the Industrializing of America, 1800-1930. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1989, 272 pp. (DSC 89/27310) WHIPPLE, SIDNEY B. Noble Experiment: A Portrait of America under Prohibition. London: Methuen, 1934, 184 pp. (8436.eee.61) 91 K. RACIAL AND ETHNIC GROUPS 1. General Studies ALLSWANG, JOHN M. The Political Behavior of Chicago's Ethnic Groups, 1918-1932. New York: Arno, 1980, 313 pp. (X.800/42013) BAYOR, RONALD H. Neighbors in Conflict: The Irish, Germans, Jews and Italians of New York City, 1929-1941. 2d ed., Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1988, 232 pp. (DSC 88/11202) CHENG, LUCIE and EDNA BONACICH, eds. Labor Immigration under Capitalism: Asian Workers in the United States before World War II. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1984, 634pp. (X.800/41614) DU PUY, WILLIAM A. Hawaii and Its Race Problem. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1932, 130 pp. (A.S.190/23) FELDMAN, HERMAN. Racial Factors in American Industry. New York and London: Harper, 1931, 318 pp. (8285.w.31) KRENN, MICHAEL L., ed. Race and U.S. Foreign Policy from 1900 through World War II. New York and London: Garland, 1998, 354 pp. (YC.1999.b.652) KWONG, PETER. Chinatown, New York: Labor and Politics, 1930-1950. New York and London: Monthly Review Press, 1979, 178 pp. (X.809/45531) MARCUSON, LEWIS R. The Stage Immigrant: The Irish, Italians and Jews in American Drama, 1920-1960. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 309 pp. (YC.1991.a.2819) MODELL, JOHN. The Economics and Politics of Racial Accommodation: The Japanese of Los Angeles, 1900-1942. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1977, 201 pp. (X.520/12488) POLENBERG, RICHARD. One Nation Divisible: Class, Race, and Ethnicity in the United States Since 1938. Harmondsworth: Penguin Books, 1980, 363 pp. (X.808/33809) SHAPIRO, HARRY L. Migration and Environment: A Study of the Physical Characteristics of the Japanese Immigrants to Hawaii and the Effects of Environment on Their Descendants. London: Oxford University Press, 1939, 594 pp. (10008.ppp.23) STACK, JOHN F. International Conflict in an American City: Boston's Irish, Italians and Jews, 1935-1944. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1979, 181 pp. (X.809/45962) SULLIVAN, PATRICIA. Days of Hope: Race and Democracy in the New Deal Era. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1996, 335 pp. (DSC 96/15728) 92 WAKUKAWA, ERNEST K. A History of the Japanese People in Hawaii. Honolulu: Toyo Shoin, 1938, 439 pp. (YA.1987.a.9620) WINOKUR, MARK. American Laughter: Immigrants, Ethnicity and 1930s Hollywood Film Comedy. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1995, 310 pp. (YC.1996.a.2667) WOOFTER, THOMAS J. Races and Ethnic Groups in American Life. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 247 pp. (X.800/1629.(11.)) 2. African Americans a. General Studies AMES, JESSIE D. The Changing Character of Lynching: Review of Lynching, 1931-1941, with a Discussion of Recent Developments in This Field. Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1973, 70 pp. (YA.1991.a.16268) BAKER, PAUL E. Negro-White Adjustment: An Investigation and Analysis of Methods in the Interracial Movement in the United States. New York: Association Press, 1934, 267 pp. (20018.h.39) BAKER, T. LINDSAY and JULIE P. BAKER, eds. The WPA Oklahoma Slave Narratives. Norman and London: University of Oklahoma Press, 1996, 543 pp. (DSC 96/14748) BOND, HORACE M. Negro Education in Alabama: A Study in Cotton and Steel. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1939, 358 pp. (08385.f.119); Tuscaloosa and London: University of Alabama Press, 1994, 383 pp. (YC.1995.a.2454) BUNCHE, RALPH J. The Political Status of the Negro in the Age of FDR. Edited by Dewey W. Grantham. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1973, 682 pp. (X.800/8791) CARTER, DAN T. Scottsboro: A Tragedy of the American South. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1969, 431 pp. (X.200/4237); London: Oxford University Press, 1971, 431 pp. (X.708/7996); rev. ed., Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1979, 479 pp. (X.709/51413; YC.1998.a.5029) CHADBOURN, JAMES H. Lynching and the Law. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina, 1933, 221 pp. (Ac.2685.kc.(60.)) COLE, OLEN. The African-American Experience in the Civilian Conservation Corps. Gainesville: University Press of Florida, 1999, 114 pp. (DSC 99/28387) COMMISSION ON INTERRACIAL COOPERATION. The Mob Still Rides: A Review of the Lynching Record, 1931-1935. Atlanta, Ga.: Commission on Interracial Cooperation, 1936, 24 pp. (Mic.A.17693) 93 CRAWFORD, S. C. Quantified Memory: A Study of the WPA and Fisk University Slave Narrative Collection. Chicago: University of Chicago, 1980. (DSC MFR-4358) DAVIS, ALLISON and JOHN DOLLARD. Children of Bondage: The Personality Development of Negro Youth in the Urban South. New York: Harper and Row, 1964, 299 pp. (X.808/189) DINER, HASIA R. In the Almost Promised Land: American Jews and Blacks, 19151935. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1977, 271 pp. (X.809/42826) DOYLE, BERTRAM W. The Etiquette of Race Relations in the South: A Study in Social Control. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1937, 249 pp. (10413.k.31) DU BOIS, W. E. B. Dusk of Dawn: An Essay toward an Autobiography of a Race Concept. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1940, 334. (10889.bb.7) ELLISON, JOHN M. Negro Organizations and Leadership in Relation to Rural Life in Virginia. Blacksburg, Va.: Virginia Agricultural Experiment Station, 1933, 88 pp. (A.S.v.50/2) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT. WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Drums and Shadows: Survival Stories among the Georgia Coastal Negroes. Athens: University of Georgia Press, 1940, 274 pp. (010007.h.70) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT. WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. The Negro in Virginia. New York: Hastings House, 1940, 380 pp. (010410.dd.21) FRANKLIN, JOHN HOPE and ALFRED A. MOSS, JR. From Slavery to Freedom: A History of African Americans. 7th ed., New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1994, 680 pp. (YC.1994.b.3982) FRAZIER, EDWARD F. The Negro Family in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 294 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(12.)); Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 686 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(22.)) FRAZIER, EDWARD F. Negro Youth at the Crossroads: Their Personality Development in the Middle States. Washington, D.C.: American Youth Commission, 1940, 301 pp. (8288.g.68) FORD, NICK A. The Contemporary Negro Novel: A Study in Race Relations. Boston: Meador Pub.,1936, 108 pp. (11860.aa.13) GLEASON, ELIZA A. The Southern Negro and the Public Library: A Study of the Government and Administration of Public Library Service to Negroes in the South. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 218 pp. (Ac.2691.dia/2.(23.)) GOINGS, KENNETH W. The NAACP Comes of Age: The Defeat of Judge John J. Parker. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1990, 125 pp. (YA.1993.a.15000) 94 GOSNELL, HAROLD F. Negro Politicians: The Rise of Negro Politics in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1935, 404 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36(33.)); Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1967, 396 pp. (X.709/5487) GRANT, NANCY L. TVA and Black Americans: Planning for the Status Quo. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1990, 207 pp. (YA.1992.b.2589) GRAY, BRENDA C. Black Female Domestics during the Depression in New York City, 1930-1940. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 200 pp. (YC.1993.b.6369) GREENBERG, CHERYL L. Or Does It Explode? Black Harlem in the Great Depression. New York: Oxford University Press, 1991, 317 pp. (YC.1992.b.4986) HALL, CHARLES E. Progress of the Negro in Texas. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Bureau of the Census, 1936, 7 pp. (A.S.67/14) HALL, JACQUELYN D. Revolt against Chivalry: Jessie Daniel Ames and the Women's Campaign against Lynching. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1979, 373 pp. (X.520/14444; X.529/74043) JACKSON, WALTER A. Gunnar Myrdal and America's Conscience: Social Engineering and Racial Liberalism, 1938-1987. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1990, 447 pp. (YA.1993.b.652; YA.1993b.5052) JOHNSON, CHARLES S. Growing Up in the Black Belt: Negro Youth in the Rural South. Washington, D.C.: American Youth Commission, 1941, 360 pp. (08385.b.84) JOHNSON, CHARLES S. The Negro College Graduate. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1938, 399 pp. (08385.b.11) JOHNSON, CHARLES S. The Shadow of the Plantation. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934; 1966, 214 pp. (010410.eee.26; W.P.3307/214) JONES, JAMES H. Bad Blood: The Tuskegee Syphilis Experiment. New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan, 1981, 272 pp. (YC.1994.b.2234); New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan International, 1993, 297 pp. (YC.1994.b.2234) KELLEY, BRENT. The Early All-Stars: Conversations with Standout Baseball Players of the 1930s and 1940s. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1997, 199 pp. (YK.1997.a.2997) KELLEY, BRENT. Voices from the Negro Leagues: Conversations with 52 Baseball Standouts of the Period 1924-1960. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1998, 334 pp. (YC.1998.b.647) KNEEBONE, JOHN T. Southern Liberal Journalists and the Issue of Race, 1920-1944. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1985, 312 pp. (DSC 86/06485) 95 KINSHASA, KWANDO M. The Man from Scottsboro: Clarence Norris and the Infamous 1931 Alabama Rape Trial, in His Own Words. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1997, 231 pp. (YC.1997.b.5310) KIRBY, JOHN B. Black Americans in the Roosevelt Era: Liberalism and Race. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1980, 254 pp. (X.809/52585) LISIO, DONALD J. Hoover, Blacks and Lily-Whites: A Study of Southern Strategies. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1985, 373 pp. (DSC 85/29520) MCADAM, DOUG. Political Process and the Development of Black Insurgency, 19301970. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1982, 304 pp. (X.520/30314) MCDONOGH, GARY W., ed. The Florida Negro: A Federal Writers' Project Legacy. Jackson and London: University Press of Mississippi, 1993, 177 pp. (YC.1993.b.5942) MCGOVERN, JAMES R. Anatomy of a Lynching: The Killing of Claude Neal. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1982, 170 pp. (X.520/35695; YC.1993.a.773) MCKAY, CLAUDE. Harlem: Negro Metropolis. New York: Dutton, 1940, 262 pp. (010410.f.56) MANGUM, CHARLES S. The Legal Status of the Negro. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1940, 436 pp. (6618.bb.1) NATANSON, NICHOLAS. The Black Image in the New Deal: The Politics of FSA Photography. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1992, 305 pp. (YA.1994.b.5958) NORDIN, DENNIS S. The New Deal's Black Congressman: A Life of Arthur Wergs Mitchell. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1997, 320 pp. (YC.1998.b.362) OTTLEY, ROI. 'New World A-Coming': Inside Black America. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1943, 364 pp. (8287.l.28) RAPER, ARTHUR F. The Tragedy of Lynching. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1933, 499 pp. (Ac.2685.kc.(59.)) REID, IRA DE A. The Negro Immigrant: His Background, Characteristics and Social Adjustment, 1899-1937. New York: Columbia University Press, 1939, 261 pp. (08286.ee.41); New York: AMS Press, 1970, 261 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(449)) SITKOFF, HARVARD. A New Deal for Blacks: The Emergence of Civil Rights as a National Issue. Vol. 1, The Depression Decade. New York: Oxford University Press, 1978. (X.0529/527(1)) 96 STERNSHER, BERNARD, ed. The Negro in Depression and War: Prelude to Revolution, 1930-1945. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1964, 535 pp. (X.510/1167); Chicago: Quadrangle, 1969, 338 pp. (X.700/7306) STIMPSON, EDDIE. My Remembers: A Black Sharecropper's Recollections of the Depression. Denton: University of North Texas Press, 1996, 167 pp. (YA.1997.b.1745) TATUM, ELBERT L. The Changed Political Thought of the Negro, 1915-1940. Reprint, Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1974, 205 pp. (X.809/21906) THOMAS, RICHARD W. Life for Us Is What We Make It: Building Black Community in Detroit, 1915-1945. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1992, 365 pp. (DSC 92/20288) TROTTER, JOE W. and EARL LEWIS, eds. African Americans in the Industrial Age: A Documentary History, 1915-1945. Boston, Mass.: Northeastern University Press, 1996, 316 pp. (DSC 96/32981) TROTTER, JOE W. Coal, Class and Color: Blacks in Southern West Virginia, 191532. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1990, 290 pp. (YA.1993.a.17633) TUSHNET, MARK V. Making Civil Rights Law: Thurgood Marshall and the Supreme Court, 1936-1961. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1994, 339 pp. (YC.1994.b.4106) TUSHNET, MARK V. The NAACP's Legal Strategy Against Segregated Education, 1925-1950. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1987, 222 pp. (YC.1991.b.4992) WARNER, W. LLOYD, BUFORD H. JUNKER and WALTER A. ADAMS. Color and Human Nature: Negro Personality Development in a Northern City. Washington, D.C.: American Youth Commission, 1941, 301 pp. (10413.t.28) WATTS, JILL. God, Harlem U.S.A.: The Father Divine Story. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1992, 249 pp. (YC.1992.b.5653; YC.1995.a.2958) WEATHERFORD, WILLIS D. and CHARLES S. JOHNSON. Race Relations: Adjustment of Whites and Negroes in the United States. Boston: Heath, 1934, 590 pp. (X.520/8204.(5.)) WEISBROT, ROBERT. Father Divine and the Struggle for Racial Equality. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1983, 241 pp. (DSC 83/17080) WEISS, NANCY J. Farewell to the Party of Lincoln: Black Politics in the Age of FDR. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1983, 333 pp. (X.800/39339) 97 WEISS, NANCY J. The National Urban League, 1910-1940. New York: Oxford University Press, 1974, 402 pp. (X.809/1904) WOODSON, CARTER G. The Rural Negro. Washington, D.C.: Association for the Study of Negro Life and History, 1930, 265 pp. (Ac.8444/4) WOODSON, CARTER G. The Negro Professional Man and the Community, With Special Emphasis on the Physician and Lawyer. Washington, D.C.: Association for the Study of Negro Life and History, 1934, 365 pp. (08285.h.19) YOUNG, JAMES O. Black Writers of the Thirties. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1973, 257 pp. (X.981/11428) ZANGRANDO, ROBERT L. The NAACP Crusade Against Lynching, 1909-1950. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1980, 309 pp. (X.800/42285) b. Communism CRENSHAW, FILES and KENNETH A. MILLER. Scottsboro, the Firebrand of Communism. Montgomery, Ala.: Brown Printing Co., 1936, 336 pp. (06617.df.18) FONER, PHILIP S. and HERBERT SHAPIRO, EDS. American Communism and Black Americans: A Documentary History, 1930-1934. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1991, 381 pp. (YA.1992.b.5483) NAISON, MARK. Communists in Harlem during the Depression. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1983, 355 pp. (X.800/40619) RECORD, WILSON. The Negro and the Communist Party. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1951, 340 pp. (8177.n.7) RECORD, WILSON. Race and Radicalism: The NAACP and the Communist Party in Conflict. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1964, 237 pp. (Ac.2692.g/14.(25.)); Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1966, 237 pp. (X.708/3671) c. Drama, Theatre and Music ABRAMSON, DORIS E. Negro Playwrights in the American Theatre, 1925-1959. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1969, 335 pp. (X.909/18000; X.090/17989) BARLOW, WILLIAM and CHERYL FINLEY. From Swing to Soul: An Illustrated History of African American Popular Music from 1930 to 1960. Washington, D.C.: Elliott & Clark, 1994, 132 pp. (LB.31.b.10728) BOND, FREDERICK W. The Negro and the Drama: The Direct and Indirect Contribution which the American Negro Has Made to Drama and the Legitimate Stage, with the Underlying Conditions Responsible. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1940, 213 pp. (11863.b.38) 98 CRAIG, E. QUITA. Black Drama of the Federal Theatre Era: Beyond the Formal Horizons. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press, 1980, 239 pp. (DSC 80/22501) CUNEY-HARE, MAUD. Negro Musicians and Their Music. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1936, 439 pp. (07899.df.71) DRIGGS, FRANK and HARRIS LEWINE. Black Beauty, White Heat: A Pictorial History of Classic Jazz, 1920-1950. New York: Da Capo, 1995, 360 pp. (YA.1998.b.6572) FRADEN, RENA. Blueprints for a Black Federal Theatre, 1935-1939. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994, 243 pp. (YC.1994.b.4371) GILL, GLENDA E. White Grease Paint on Black Performers: A Study of the Federal Theatre of 1935-1939. New York: Lang, 1988, 220 pp. (YA.1992.a.4152) RIJN, GUIDO VAN. Roosevelt's Blues: African-American Blues and Gospel Songs on FDR. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1997, 292 pp. (YC.1999.b.1651) d. Foreign and Military Affairs DALFIUME, RICHARD M. Desegregation of the U.S. Armed Forces: Fighting on Two Fronts, 1939-1953. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1969, 252 pp. (X.809/10878) HARRIS, JOSEPH E. African-American Reactions to War in Ethiopia, 1936-1941. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1994, 185 pp. (YC.1996.b.46) JAKEMAN, ROBERT J. The Divided Skies: Establishing Segregated Flight Training at Tuskegee, Alabama, 1934-1942. Tuscaloosa and London: University of Alabama Press, 1992, 416 pp. (YC.1997.a.977) PATTON, GERALD W. War and Race: The Black Officer in the American Military, 1915-1941. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1981, 214 pp. (X.529/47051) PLUMMER, BRENDA G. Rising Wind: Black Americans and U.S. Foreign Affairs, 1935-1960. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1996, 423 pp. (DSC 96/19793) SCOTT, WILLIAM R. The Sons of Sheba's Race: African Americans and the ItaloEthiopian War, 1935-1941. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1993, 288 pp. (ORW.1993.a.2504 OIOC) e. Labor 99 BRAZEAL, B. R. The Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters: Its Origin and Development. New York and London: Harper, 1946, 258 pp. (8236.e.27; 8288.f.68) CAYTON, HORACE R. and GEORGE S. MITCHELL. Black Workers and the New Unions. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1939, 473 pp. (8289.dd.7) CHATEAUVERT, MELINDA. Marching Together: Women of the Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1998, 267 pp. (DSC 98/11466) FONER, PHILIP S. and RONALD L. LEWIS, eds. The Black Worker: A Documentary History from Colonial Times to the Present. Vol. 6, The Era of Post-war Prosperity and the Great Depression, 1920-1936. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1981. (X.0800/1579); Vol. 7, The Black Worker from the Founding of the CIO to the AFL-CIO. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1983. (X.0800/1579) FRANKLIN, CHARLES L. The Negro Labor Unionist of New York: Problems and Conditions among Negroes in the Labor Unions in Manhattan, with Special Reference to the N.R.A. and post-N.R.A. Situations. New York: Columbia University Press, 1936, 417 pp. (08285.h.51); reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1968, 415 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(420.)) FUJITA, KUNIKO. Black Worker's Struggles in Detroit's Auto Industry, 1935-1975. Saratoga, Calif.: Century Twenty One, 1980, 130 pp. (X.525/8724) GREENE, LORENZO J. and CARTER G. WOODSON. The Negro Wage Earner. Washington, D.C.: Association for the Study of Negro Life and History, 1930, 388 pp. (Ac.8444/5) GRIFFLER, KEITH P. What Price Alliance?: Black Radicals Confront White Labor, 1918-1938. New York: Garland, 1995, 266 pp. (YC.1995.b.3836) HARRIS, WILLIAM H. Keeping the Faith: A. Philip Randolph, Milton P. Webster and the Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters, 1925-37. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1977, 252 pp. (X.520/12431) MEIER, AUGUST and ELLIOTT RUDWICK. Black Detroit and the Rise of the UAW. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 289 pp. (X.529/36379) NORTHRUP, HERBERT R. Organized Labor and the Negro. 2d ed., New York and London: Harper, 1944, 312 pp. (08286.dd.92) REID, IRA DE A., et al. The Urban Negro Worker in the United States, 1925-1936. 2 vols. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1938. (A.S.189/3) SPERO, STERLING D. and ABRAM L. HARRIS. The Black Worker: The Negro and the Labor Movement. New York: Columbia University Press, 1931, 509 pp. (8285.r.23) 100 TROTTER, JOE W., JR. Black Milwaukee: The Making of an Industrial Proletariat, 1915-45. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1985, 302 pp. (DSC 85/12464) 3. Hispanics BALDERRAMA, FRANCISCO E. In Defense of La Raza: The Los Angeles Mexican Consulate and the Mexican Community, 1929 to 1936. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1982, 137 pp. (YA.1989.a.16903) BALDERRAMA, FRANCISCO E. and RAYMOND RODRÍGUEZ. Decade of Betrayal: Mexican Repatriation in the 1930s. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1995, 283 pp. (DSC 95/30384) FORREST, SUZANNE. The Preservation of the Village: New Mexico's Hispanics and the New Deal. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1989, 253 pp. (DSC 89/19019) GARCIA, MARIO T. Mexican Americans: Leadership, Ideology and Identity, 19301960. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1989, 364 pp. (Ac.2692.m.a./32(36)) GARCIA, RICHARD A. Rise of the Mexican American Middle Class: San Antonio, 1929-1941. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1991, 398 pp. (YA.1992.b.4125) HOFFMAN, ABRAHAM. Unwanted Mexican Americans in the Great Depression: Repatriation Pressures, 1929-1939. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1976, 207 pp. (X.700/25335) KOFAS, JON V. The Struggle for Legitimacy: Latin American Labor and the United States, 1930-1960. Tempe: Center for Latin American Studies, Arizona State University, 1992, 425 pp. (YA.1992.b.2973; YA.1993.a.2203) MENEFEEE, SELDON C. Mexican Migratory Workers of South Texas. Washington, D.C.: Work Projects Administration, 1941, 67 pp. (A.S.978/48) REISLER, MARK. By the Sweat of Their Brow: Mexican Immigrant Labor in the United States, 1900-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 298 pp. (X.529/31635) RUÍZ, VICKI L. Cannery Women, Cannery Lives: Mexican Women, Unionization and the California Food Processing Industry, 1930-1950. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1987, 194 pp. (YA.1989.b.7702) SÁNCHEZ KORROL, VIRGINIA E. From Colonia to Community: The History of Puerto Ricans in New York City, 1917-1948. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1983, 242 pp. (X.809/67188); Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1994, 275 pp. (YC.1995.a.791) 101 TAYLOR, PAUL S. Mexican Labor in the United States. Berkeley: University of California Publications in Economics, 1928-1934. (Ac.2689.g/19) VARGAS, ZARAGOSA. Proletarians of the North: A History of Mexican Industrial Workers in Detroit and the Midwest, 1917-1933. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1993, 277 pp. (YC.1994.b.5414) WINTERS, JET C. A Report on the Health and Nutrition of Mexicans Living in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1931, 99 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) 4. Jews [See also IX.E. Foreign Relations: Immigration, Refugees, Jews and the Holocaust] ATHANS, MARY C. The Coughlin-Fahey Connection: Father Charles E. Coughlin, Father Denis Fahey, C.S.Sp., and Religious Anti-Semitism in the United States, 1938-1954. New York: Lang, 1991, 265 pp. (YA.1993.b.1393) BAUER, YEHUDA. American Jewry and the Holocaust: The American Jewish Joint Distribution Committee, 1939-1945. Jerusalem: Institute of Contemporary Jewry, Hebrew University, 1981, 522 pp. (DSC 81/18775) BAUER, YEHUDA. My Brother's Keeper: A History of the American Jewish Joint Distribution Committee, 1929-1939. Philadelphia: Jewish Publication Society of America, 1974, 350 pp. (X.809/43744) BAYOR, RONALD H. Neighbors in Conflict: The Irish, Germans, Jews and Italians of New York City, 1929-1941. 2d ed., Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1988, 232 pp. (DSC 88/11202) BERMAN, AARON. Nazism, the Jews and American Zionism, 1933-1948. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1990, 283 pp. (YA.1992.b.2475) DINER, HASIA R. In the Almost Promised Land: American Jews and Blacks, 19151935. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1977, 271 pp. (X.809/42826) GUROCK, JEFFREY S., ed. America, American Jews and the Holocaust. New York and London: Routledge, 1998, 486 pp. (YC.1999.b.2665) KANAWADA, LEO V. Franklin D. Roosevelt's Diplomacy and American Catholics, Italians and Jews. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research; Epping: Bowker, 1982, 184 pp. (X.800/35588) KAUFMAN, MENAHEM. An Ambiguous Partnership: Non-Zionists and Zionists in America, 1939-1948. Jerusalem: Magnes Press, Hebrew University, 1991, 418 pp. (YA.1993.b.8665) KLIGER, HANNAH, ed. Jewish Hometown Associations and Family Circles in New York: The WPA Jewish Writers' Group Study. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1992, 164 pp. (DSC 99/12690) 102 LOOKSTEIN, HASKEL. Were We Our Brothers' Keepers? The Public Response of American Jews to the Holocaust, 1938-1944. New York: Hartmore House, 1985, 287 pp. (DSC 86/10994) MARCUSON, LEWIS R. The Stage Immigrant: The Irish, Italians and Jews in American Drama, 1920-1960. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 309 pp. (YC.1991.a.2819) STACK, JOHN F. International Conflict in an American City: Boston's Irish, Italians and Jews, 1935-1944. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1979, 181 pp. (X.809/45962) UNITED JEWISH APPEAL. Report to American Jews on Overseas Relief, Palestine and Refugees in the United States. New York and London: Harper, 1942, 92 pp. (X.808/35095) WENGER, BETH S. New York Jews and the Great Depression: Uncertain Promise. New Haven, Conn., London: Yale University Press, 1996, 269 pp. (YC.1997.b.844) 5. Native Americans BLAUCH, LLOYD E. and WILLIAM L. IVERSEN. Education of Children on Federal Reservations. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 17, 1939, 145 pp. (A.S.988) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. Educational Service for Indians. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 18, 1939, 137 pp. (A.S.988) HALL, EDWARD T. West of the Thirties: Discoveries among the Navajo and Hopi. New York: Doubleday, 1994, 187 pp. (YA.1996.a.2145) HAUPTMAN, LAURENCE M. The Iroquois and the New Deal. Syracuse, N.Y.: Syracuse University Press, 1981, 256 pp. (YH.1986.b.500) KELLY, LAWRENCE C. The Assault on Assimilation: John Collier and the Origins of Indian Policy Reform. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1983, 445 pp. (YA.1987.b.1610) KELLY, LAWRENCE C. The Navajo Indians and Federal Indian Policy, 1900-1935. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1970, 221 pp. (X.800/5985) KERSEY, HARRY A. The Florida Seminoles and the New Deal, 1933-1942. Boca Raton: Florida Atlantic University Press, 1989, 214 pp. (DSC 92/00078) PARMAN, DONALD L. The Navajos and the New Deal. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1976, 316 pp. (Ac.2692.ma/32[27]) 103 PHILP, KENNETH R. John Collier's Crusade for Indian Reform, 1920-1954. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1977, 304 pp. (YA.1986.a.7466) SCHRADER, ROBERT F. The Indian Arts and Crafts Board: An Aspect of New Deal Indian Policy. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1983, 364 pp. (YV.1989.b.2512) TAYLOR, GRAHAM D. The New Deal and American Indian Tribalism: The Administration of the Indian Reorganization Act, 1934-45. Lincoln and London: University of Nebraska Press, 1980, 203 pp. (X.520/21901) L. RURAL LIFE BROWN, D. CLAYTON. Electricity for Rural America: The Fight for the REA. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1980, 178 pp. (X.629/14957) BROWN, JOSEPHINE CHAPIN. The Rural Community and Social Case Work. New York: Family Welfare Association of America, 1934, 165 pp. (Mic.A.19697) BRUNNER, EDMUND DE S. and IRVING LORGE. Rural Trends in Depression Years: A Survey of Village-Centered Agricultural Communities, 1930-1936. New York: Columbia University Press, 1937, 387 pp. (08286.bb.74) BRUNNER, EDMUND DE S. and JAMES H. KOLB. Rural Social Trends. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 386 pp. (X.800/1629.(3.)) COLE, WILLIAM E. Rural Rehabilitation Services in Knox County, Tennessee 1935: Economic and Social Effects of the Depression upon Relief Families in Knoxville, Tennessee. Knoxville: University of Tennessee, 1936, 32 pp. (8286.f.54) COYLE, DAVID C., ed. Electric Power on the Farm: The Story of Electricity, Its Usefulness on Farms and the Movement to Electrify Rural America. Washington, D.C.: Rural Electrification Administration, 1936, 170 pp. (A.S.973/5) ELLISON, JOHN M. Negro Organizations and Leadership in Relation to Rural Life in Virginia. Blacksburg, Va.: Virginia Agricultural Experiment Station, 1933, 88 pp. (A.S.v.50/2) FARNHAM, REBECCA T. and IRENE LINK. Effects of the Works Program on Rural Relief: A Survey of Rural Relief Cases Closed in Seven States, July through November 1935. Research Monograph no. 13. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 115 pp. (A.S.978/7) GAER, JOSEPH. Toward Farm Security: The Problem of Rural Poverty and the Work of the Farm Security Administration. Washington, D.C.: Farm Security Administration, 1941, 246 pp. (A.S.895/3) 104 GREY, MICHAEL R. New Deal Medicine: The Rural Health Programs of the Farm Security Administration. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1999, 238 pp. (DSC 99/19733) HARDIN, CHARLES M. The Politics of Agriculture: Soil Conservation and the Struggle for Power in Rural America. Glencoe, Ill.: Free Press, 1952, 282 pp. (7082.e.3) KIRBY, JACK TEMPLE. Rural Worlds Lost: The American South, 1920-1960. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University, 1987, 390 pp. (DSC 87/14987) KOLB, JOHN H. and EDMUND DE S. BRUNNER. A Study of Rural Society: Its Organization and Changes. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1935, 642 pp. (8286.h.7); rev. ed., Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1940, 694 pp. (8288.f.16) LIVELY, C. E. and CONRAD TAEUBER. Rural Migration in the United States. Research Monograph no. 19. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1939, 192 pp. (A.S.978/7) MANGUS, A. R. Changing Aspects of Rural Relief. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 238 pp. (A.S.978/7) MANGUS, A. R. Rural Regions of the United States. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1940, 230 pp. (A.S.978/49.(7.)) MELVIN, BRUCE L. Rural Youth on Relief. Research Monograph no. 11. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 112 pp. (A.S.978/7) MELVIN, BRUCE L. and ELNA N. SMITH. Rural Youth: Their Situation and Prospects. Research Monograph no. 15. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 167 pp. (A.S.978/7) MERTZ, PAUL E. New Deal Policy and Southern Rural Poverty. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1978, 279 pp. (X.520/13552) MULLER, FREDERICK W. Public Rural Electrification. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Public Affairs, 1944, 183 pp. (8759.d.33) MUSTARD, HARRY S. Rural Health Insurance. New York: Commonwealth Fund, 1936, 601 pp. (7391.r.10) SANDERSON, DWIGHT. Research Memorandum on Rural Life in the Depression. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1972, 169 pp. (X.529/62783) VANCE, RUPERT B. Rural Relief and Recovery. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1939, 32 pp. (A.S.978/22) VANCE, RUPERT B. and GORDON W. BLACKWELL New Farm Homes for Old: A Study of Rural Public Housing in the South. University: University of Alabama Press, 1946, 245 pp. (Mic.A.17705) 105 WILLEFORD, MARY BRISTOW. Income and Health in Remote Rural Areas: A Study of 400 Families in Leslie County, Kentucky. New York: Columbia University, 1932, 88 pp. (08285.h.27) WOODSON, CARTER G. The Rural Negro. Washington, D.C.: Association for the Study of Negro Life and History, 1930, 265 pp. (Ac.8444/4) WORKS, GEORGE ALAN and SIMON O. LESSER. Rural America Today: Its Schools and Community Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1942, 450 pp. (08385.b.83) WYNNE, WALLER. Five Years of Rural Relief. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 160 pp. (A.S.978/49.(1.)) ZIMMERMAN, CARLE C. and NATHAN L. WHETTEN. Rural Families on Relief. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 161 pp. (A.S.978/7) M. TOWNS AND CITIES ARNOLD, JOSEPH L. The New Deal in the Suburbs: A History of the Greenbelt Town Program, 1935-1954. Columbus: Ohio State University Press, 1971, 272 pp. (X.529/15928) BLUMENTHAL, ALBERT. Small-Town Stuff: A Total Picture of the Intimate Aspects of Village Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 416 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(13.)) CONKIN, PAUL K. Tomorrow a New World: The New Deal Community Program. Ithaca, N.Y.: published for the American Historical Association by Cornell University Press, 1959, 350 pp. (08052.1.30) GELFAND, MARK I. A Nation of Cities: The Federal Government and Urban America, 1933-1965. New York: Oxford University Press, 1975, 476 pp. (X.809/22119) KLAUS, SUSAN L., comp. Links in the Chain: Greenbelt, Maryland and the New Town Movement in America: An Annotated Bibliography. Washington, D.C.: Centre of Washington Area Studies, George Washington University, 1987, 62 pp. (DSC 4233.15 13) LYND, ROBERT S. and HELEN MERRELL LYND. Middletown in Transition: A Study in Cultural Conflicts. London: Constable, 1937, 604 pp. (010410.b.4) MCKENZIE, RODERICK D. The Metropolitan Community. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 352 pp. (X.800/1629.(6.)) MEIKLE, JEFFREY L. The City of Tomorrow, Model 1937. London: Pentgram Design, 1984, 35 pp. (YK.1992.a.5412) 106 MUMFORD, LEWIS. The Culture of Cities. London: Secker & Warburg, 1938, 586 pp. (08286.k.9) OGBURN, WILLIAM F. Social Characteristics of Cities. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1974, 70 pp. (YA.1994.b.4220) UNITED STATES RESETTLEMENT ADMINISTRATION. Greenbelt Towns: A Demonstration in Suburban Planning. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Resettlement Administration, 1936. (A.S.977/8) N. WELFARE, RELIEF AND SOCIAL SECURITY ABBOTT, GRACE. From Relief to Social Security: The Development of the New Public Welfare Services and Their Administration. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 388 pp. (8286.b.72) ACHENBAUM, W. ANDREW. Social Security: Visions and Revisions. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1986, 300 pp. (YC.1986.b.3553) ADAMS, GRACE K. Workers on Relief. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1939, 344 pp. (8285.w.41; 8289.c.17) ARMSTRONG, LOUISE V. We Too Are the People. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1972, 474 pp. (YA.1990.a.22610) ALTMEYER, ARTHUR J. The Formative Years of Social Security. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press, 1966, 314 pp. (X.519/4577; X.529/6767) BAIRD, ENID, in collaboration with HUGH P. BRINTON. Average General Relief Benefits, 1933-1938. Washington, D.C.: Work Projects Administration, 1940, 89 pp. (A.S.978/51; AS1144/842) BLUMELL, BRUCE D. The Development of Public Assistance in the State of Washington during the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1984, 490 pp. (X.520/38827) BOAN, FERN. A History of Poor Relief Legislation and Administration in Missouri. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 243 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(53.)) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. The Illinois Poor Law and Its Administration. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 541 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(44.)) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. Public Welfare Administration in the United States: Select Documents. 2d ed., Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1938, 1229 pp. (Ac.2691.d/29.(13.)) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. Social Work and the Courts: Select Statutes and Judicial Decisions. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934, 610 pp. (Ac.2691.d/29.(6.)) 107 BREMER, WILLIAM W. Depression Winters: New York Social Workers and the New Deal. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1984, 231 pp. (YA.1989.a.18254) BROCK, WILLIAM R. Welfare, Democracy and the New Deal. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1988, 376 pp. (YH.1988.b.1086) BROWN, JOSEPHINE CHAPIN. The Rural Community and Social Case Work. New York: Family Welfare Association of America, 1934, 165 pp. (Mic.A.19697) BURNS, ARTHUR E. and EDWARD A. WILLIAMS. Federal Work, Security and Relief Programs. Washington, D.C.: Works Projects Administration, 1941, 159 pp. (A.S.978/7) CAROTHERS, DORIS. Chronology of the Federal Emergency Relief Administration, May 12, 1933, to December 31, 1935. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 163 pp. (A.S.978/7) CHAMBERS, CLARKE A. Seedtime of Reform: American Social Service and Social Action, 1918-1933. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1963, 326 pp. (X.520/46) COLCORD, JOANNA C. Cash Relief. New York: Russell Sage Foundation, 1936, 263 pp. (Mic.A.10138) COLCORD, JOANNA C. Emergency Work Relief: As Carried out in Twenty-six American Communities, 1930-1931, with Suggestions for Setting up a Program. New York: Russell Sage Foundation, 1932, 286 pp. (Mic.A.10144) CONKIN, PAUL K. FDR and the Origins of the Welfare State. New York: Crowell, 1967, 118 pp. (X.529/11337) CROUSE, JOAN M. The Homeless Transient in the Great Depression: New York State, 1929-1941. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1986, 319 pp. (YC.1987.b.4429) DOUGLAS, PAUL H. Social Security in the United States: An Analysis and Appraisal of the Federal Social Security Act. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1936, 384 pp (8287.cc.27); 2d ed., New York and London: Whittlesey House, 1939, 493 pp. (8287.de.52) DOUGLAS, PAUL H. Standards of Unemployment Insurance. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1933, 251 pp. (Ac.2691.dg2.(19.)) DOUGLAS, PAUL H. and AARON DIRECTOR. The Problem of Unemployment. New York: Macmillan, 1931, 505 pp. (8285.w.3) EPSTEIN, ABRAHAM. Insecurity: A Challenge to America: A Study of Social Insurance in the United States and Abroad. 2d rev. ed., New York: Random House, 1938, 939 pp. (8288.f.34) 108 FALK, I. S. Security Against Sickness: A Study of Health Insurance. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1936, 423 pp. (8234.cc.10) FARNHAM, REBECCA T. and IRENE LINK. Effects of the Works Program on Rural Relief: A Survey of Rural Relief Cases Closed in Seven States, July through November 1935. Research Monograph no. 13. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 115 pp. (A.S.978/7) FISHER, JACOB. The Response of Social Work to the Depression. Boston: G. K. Hall, 1980, 266 pp. (DSC 80/34643) GAYER, ARTHUR D. Public Works and Unemployment Relief in the United States. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 44 pp. (Ac.1915.b) GEDDES, ANNE E. Trends in Relief Expenditures, 1910-1935. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1937, 117 pp. (A.S.978/7) GILBOY, ELIZABETH W. Applicants for Work Relief: A Study of Massachusetts Families Under the FERA and WPA. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1940, 273 pp. (08286.dd.93) GLICK, FRANK Z. The Illinois Emergency Relief Commission: A Study of Administrative and Financial Aspects of Emergency Relief. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1940, 247 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(48.)) HIRSHFIELD, DANIEL S. The Lost Reform: The Campaign for Compulsory Health Insurance in the United States from 1932 to 1943. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1970, 221 pp. (X.320/2612) HOPKINS, HARRY L. Spending to Save: The Complete Story of Relief. Seattle and London: University of Washington Press, 1972, 197 pp. (X.529/15526) HOWARD, DONALD S. The WPA and Federal Relief Policy. New York: Russell Sage Foundation, 1943, 879 pp. (08286.k.69) KELLOGG, RUTH M. The United State [sic] Employment Service. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1933, 192 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36.(29.)) KRUEGER, THOMAS A. And Promises to Keep: The Southern Conference for Human Welfare, 1938-1948. Nashville: Vanderbilt University Press, 1967, 218 pp. (X.800/3881) LANE, MARIE D. and FRANCIS STEEGMULLER. America on Relief. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1938, 180 pp. (Mic.A.12429) LUBOVE, ROY. The Struggle for Social Security, 1900-1935. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1968, 276 pp. (X.519/5449) 109 MCKINLEY, CHARLES and ROBERT W. FRASE. Launching Social Security: A Capture-and-Record Account, 1935-1937. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press, 1970, 519 pp. (X.520/7503) MERIAM, LEWIS. Relief and Social Security. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1946, 912 pp. (8287.g.57) MANGUS, A. R. Changing Aspects of Rural Relief. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 238 pp. (A.S.978/7) MINK, GWENDOLYN. The Wages of Motherhood: Inequality in the Welfare State, 1917-42. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1995, 198 pp. (YC.1996.a.1772) NASH, GERALD D., NOEL H. PUGACH and RICHARD F. TOMASSON, eds. Social Security: The First Half-Century. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1988, 344 pp. (YA.1990.b.4173) NELSON, DANIEL M. Unemployment Insurance: The American Experience, 19151935. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press, 1969, 305 pp. (X.510/2499) PATTERSON, JAMES T. America's Struggle Against Poverty, 1900-1994. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1994, 309 pp. (YC.1996.b.1850) PATTERSON, JAMES T. The Welfare State in America, 1930-1980. Durham: British Association for American Studies, 1981, 43 pp. (X.529/45993) POPPENDIECK, JANET. Breadlines Knee-deep in Wheat: Food Assistance in the Great Depression. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1986, 306 pp. (DSC 86/09585) RADOMSKI, ALEXANDER L. Work Relief in New York State, 1931-1935. Morningside Heights, N.Y.: King's Crown Press, 1947, 332 pp. (Mic.A.12367) ROSE, NANCY E. Put to Work: Relief Programs in the Great Depression. New York: Monthly Review Press, 1994, 144 pp. (DSC 94/16531) SCHNEIDER, DAVID M. and ALBERT DEUTSCH. The History of Public Welfare in New York State, 1867-1940. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 410 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(51.)) VANCE, RUPERT B. Rural Relief and Recovery. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1939, 32 pp. (A.S.978/22) WHITE, R. CLYDE and MARY K. WHITE. Research Memorandum on Social Aspects of Relief Policies in the Depression. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1972, 173 pp. (X.529/62769) 110 WHITING, THEODORE E. and T. J. WOOFTER, JR. Summary Relief and Federal Work Program Statistics, 1933-1940. Washington, D.C.: Works Projects Administration, 1941, 64 pp. (A.S.978/47) WILCOX, JEROME K. Unemployment Relief Documents: Guide to the Official Publications and Releases of F.E.R.A. and the 48 State Relief Agencies. New York: H. W. Wilson, 1936, 95 pp. (8287.e.54) WILLIAMS, EDWARD A. Federal Aid for Relief. New York: Columbia University Press, 1939. (08286.h.23); reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1968, 269 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(452.)) WITTE, EDWIN E. The Development of the Social Security Act. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press, 1962, 220 pp. (08052.de.36) WOODRUFF, NAN E. As Rare as Rain: Federal Relief in the Great Southern Drought of 1930-31. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1985, 203 pp. (DSC 86/09035) WYNNE, WALLER. Five Years of Rural Relief. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 160 pp. (A.S.978/49.(1.)) ZIMMERMAN, CARLE C. and NATHAN L. WHETTEN. Rural Families on Relief. Washington, D.C.: Works Progress Administration, 1938, 161 pp. (A.S.978/7) O. WOMEN ANDERSEN, KRISTI. After Suffrage: Women in Partisan and Electoral Politics before the New Deal. Chicago and London: University of Chicago, 1996, 191 pp. (DSC 96/26553) BECKER, SUSAN D. The Origins of the Equal Rights Amendment: American Feminism Between the Wars. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1981, 300 pp. (X.529/51552) BLACKWELDER, JULIA K. Women of the Depression: Caste and Culture in San Antonio, 1929-1939. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1984, 279 pp. (YA.1989.b.5948) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. Women in the Twentieth Century: A Study of Their Political, Social and Economic Activities. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 364 pp. (X.800/1629.(10.)) CHAFE, WILLIAM E. The American Woman: Her Changing Social, Economic and Political Roles, 1920-1970. New York: Oxford University Press, 1972, 351 pp. (X.529/15758); London: Oxford University Press, 1974, 351 pp. (X.519/16367) 111 CHATEAUVERT, MELINDA. Marching Together: Women of the Brotherhood of Sleeping Car Porters. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1998, 267 pp. (DSC 98/11466) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. Women and Minorities during the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 349 pp. (YC.1991.b.546) FAULKNER, HOWARD J. and VIRGINIA D. PRUITT, eds. Dear Dr. Menninger: Women's Voices from the Thirties. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1997, 258 pp. (DSC 97/13831) GABIN, NANCY F. Feminism in the Labor Movement: Women and the United Auto Workers, 1935-1975. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1990, 257 pp. (YA.1993.b.9139) GOERNER, FRED. The Search for Amelia Earhart. London: Bodley Head, 1966, 286 pp. (X.809/2894) GORDON, FELICE D. After Winning: The Legacy of the New Jersey Suffragists, 19201947. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1986, 262 pp. (DSC 86/15225) GRAY, BRENDA C. Black Female Domestics during the Depression in New York City, 1930-1940. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 200 pp. (YC.1993.b.6369 HAGOOD, MARGARET J. Mothers of the South: Portraiture of the White Tenant Farm Woman. Reprint, New York: Greenwood, 1969, 252 pp. (YA.1990.a.21070); Charlottesville and London: University Press of Virginia, 1996, 252 pp. (YC.1997.a.2102) HALL, JACQUELYN D. Revolt against Chivalry: Jessie Daniel Ames and the Women's Campaign against Lynching. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1979, 373 pp. (X.520/14444; X.529/74043) HAPKE, LAURA. Daughters of the Great Depression: Woman, Work and Fiction in the American 1930s. Athens and London: University of Georgia Press, 1995, 286 pp. (YC.1996.b.2784) HILLIS, MARJORIE. New York, Fair or No Fair: A Guide for the Woman Vacationist. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill, 1939, 206 pp. (010410.g.56) METTLER, SUZANNE. Dividing Citizens: Gender and Federalism in New Deal Public Policy. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1998, 239 pp. (DSC 98/22624) MINK, GWENDOLYN. The Wages of Motherhood: Inequality in the Welfare State, 1917-42. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1995, 198 pp. (YC.1996.a.1772) 112 OAKES, CLAUDIA M. United States Women in Aviation, 1930-1939. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1991, 70 pp. (DSC 99/29330) PRUETTE, LORINE, ed. Women Workers through the Depression: A Study of White Collar Employment. New York: Macmillan, 1934, 164 pp. (8286.e.55) PUTNAM, GEORGE P. Soaring Wings: A Biography of Amelia Earhart. London: Harrap, 1940, 270 pp. (10888.e.22) RABINOWITZ, PAULA. Labor and Desire: Women's Revolutionary Fiction in Depression America. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1991, 222 pp. (DSC 92/02972) RAUB, PATRICIA. Yesterday's Stories: Popular Women's Novels of the Twenties and Thirties. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1994, 131 pp. (YC.1995.b.2537) ROSE, KENNETH D. American Women and the Repeal of Prohibition. New York: New York University Press, 1996, 215 pp. (DSC 0857.430 33) RUÍZ, VICKI L. Cannery Women, Cannery Lives: Mexican Women, Unionization and the California Food Processing Industry, 1930-1950. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1987, 194 pp. (YA.1989.b.7702) RUPP, LEILA J. Mobilizing Women for War: German and American Propaganda, 19391945. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1978, 243 pp. (X.809/43415) SCHARF, LOIS. To Work and to Wed: Female Employment, Feminism and the Great Depression. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1980, 240 pp. (X.529/39543) SCHARF, LOIS and JOAN M. JENSEN, eds. Decades of Discontent: The Women's Movement, 1920-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1983, 315 pp. (X.520/32353) SWAIN, MARTHA H. Ellen S. Woodward: New Deal Advocate for Women. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1995, 275 pp. (YC.1996.b.6704) WANDERSEE, WINIFRED D. Women's Work and Family Values, 1920-1940. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1981, 165 pp. (X.520/25163) WARE, SUSAN. Beyond Suffrage: Women in the New Deal. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1981, 204 pp. (X.800/31656) WARE, SUSAN. Holding Their Own: American Women in the 1930s. Boston: Twayne, 1982, 223 pp. (DSC 83/26148) 113 WARE, SUSAN. Partner and I: Molly Dewson, Feminism and New Deal Politics. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1987, 327 pp. (YC.1988.b.1220) WEIGLE, MARTA, ed. Women of New Mexico: Depression Era Images. Santa Fe, N.M.: Ancient City Press, 1993, 129 pp. (YA.1995.b.4972) VI. CULTURAL AND INTELLECTUAL HISTORY A. BIBLIOGRAPHIES AND GUIDES KALFATOVIC, MARTIN R. The New Deal Fine Arts Projects: A Bibliography, 19331992. Metuchen, N.J., and London: Scarecrow, 1994, 504 pp. (2725.e.2664) ROSENZWEIG, ROY, ed. Government and the Arts in Thirties America: A Guide to Oral Histories and Other Research Materials. Fairfax, Va.: George Mason University Press, 1986, 329 pp. (DSC 88/14938) WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Archives of the Work Projects Administration and Predecessors, 1933-1943. Brighton: Harvestor Microfilm, 1987, 34 pp. (2708.e.1069; 2719.e.1410) B. MISCELLANEOUS STUDIES ADAM, T. R. The Museum and Popular Culture. New York: American Association for Adult Education, 1939, 177 pp. (08385.aa.10) ALEXANDER, CHARLES C. Nationalism in American Thought, 1930-1945. Chicago: Rand McNally, 1971. (X.709/12827) AMERICAN ARTISTS' CONGRESS. Graphic Works of the American Thirties: A Book of 100 Prints. Reprint, New York: Da Capo, 1977, 114 pp. (X.415/5970) AMERICAN UNION OF DECORATIVE ARTISTS AND CRAFTSMEN. Annual of American Design 1931. New York: Ives Washburn, 1930, 176 pp. (P.P.1711.ka) BACH, RICHARD F. Silver: An Exhibition of Contemporary American Design by Manufacturers, Designers and Craftsmen. New York: Metropolitan Museum of Art, 1937, 14 pp. (07805.ee.98) BAIGELL, MATTHEW and JULIA WILLIAMS, eds. Artists Against War and Fascism: Papers of the First American Artists' Congress. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1985, 310 pp. (DSC 89/09287) BATTERSBY, MARTIN. The Decorative Thirties. New York: Walker, 1971, 208 pp. (X.423/1881) 114 BECKER, JANE S. Selling Tradition: Appalachia and the Construction of an American Folk, 1930-1940. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1998, 331 pp. (YC.1999.b.522) BECKHAM, SUE B. Depression Post Office Murals and Southern Culture: A Gentle Reconstruction. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1989, 338 pp. (DSC 89/20879) BENTON, THOMAS HART. An Artist in America. New York: R. M. McBride, 1937, 276 pp. (010410.1.26) BEST, GARY D. The Nickel and Dime Decade: American Popular Culture during the 1930's. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1993, 168 pp. (YC.1993.b.7988) BRIDWELL, E. NELSON. Superman: From the Thirties to the Seventies. London: Spring Books, 1979, 386 pp. (X.410/10397) BROWDER, LAURA. Rousing the Nation: Radical Culture in Depression America. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press, 1998, 217 pp. (YC.1999.b.2056) BRUCE, EDWARD and FORBES WATSON. Art in Federal Buildings. Vol. 1, Mural Designs, 1934-1936. Washington, D.C.: Art in Federal Buildings Inc., 1936, 309 pp. (W.P.12825) CHAMBERS, DAVID L. Indiana: A Hoosier History Based on the Mural Paintings of Thomas Hart Benton. Indianapolis, Ind.: Bobbs-Merrill, 1933, 47 pp. (10411.I.36) CHENEY, MARTHA C. Modern Art in America. New York and London: McGrawHill, 1939, 190 pp. (07812.pp.1) CLARK, ROBERT J., et al. Design in America: The Cranbrook Vision, 1925-1950. New York: Abrams, 1983, 352 pp. (DSC 84/18182) CONTRERAS, BELISARIO R. Tradition and Innovation in New Deal Art. Lewisburg, Pa.: Bucknell University Press; London: Associated University Presses, 1983, 253 pp. (YV.1988.b.478) COONEY, TERRY A. Balancing Acts: American Thought and Culture in the 1930's. New York: Twayne; London: Prentice-Hall, 1995, 263 pp. (YC.1995.b.2762) COSTIGLIOLA, FRANK. Awkward Dominion: American Political, Economic and Cultural Relations with Europe, 1919-1933. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1984, 381 pp. (DSC 85/08141) CRUNDEN, ROBERT M. From Self to Society, 1919-1941. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall, 1972, 212 pp. (X.700/9394) DAVIDSON, DONALD G. The Attack on Leviathan: Regionalism and Nationalism in the United States. Reprint, Gloucester, Mass.: Peter Smith, 1962, 368 pp. (X.809/2161) 115 DENNIS, JAMES M. Grant Wood: A Study in American Art and Culture. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1986, 256 pp. (LB.31.b.457) DENNIS, JAMES M. Renegade Regionalists: The Modern Independence of Grant Wood, Thomas Hart Benton and John Steuart Curry. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press, 1998, 279 pp. (YC.1998.a.1751) DENOON, CHRISTOPHER. Posters of the WPA. Los Angeles, Calif.: Wheatley Press, 1987, 175 pp. (DSC 87/29763) DE SAISSET ART GALLERY AND MUSEUM. New Deal Art: California. Santa Clara, Calif.: De Saisset Art Galley and Museum, 1976, 172 pp. (X.419/4345) DORMAN, ROBERT L. Revolt of the Provinces: The Regionalist Movement in America, 1920-1945. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1993, 366 pp. (DSC 93/11652) DUNCAN, ALASTAIR. American Art Deco. London: Thames and Hudson, 1986, 288 pp. (LB.31.c.1825) EKIRCH, ARTHUR A. Ideologies and Utopias: The Impact of the New Deal on American Thought. Chicago: Quadrangle, 1969, 307 pp. (X.809/11707) FAGETTE, PAUL. Digging for Dollars: American Archaeology and the New Deal. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico, 1996, 228 pp. (DSC 97/01614) FERMI, LAURA. Illustrious Immigrants: The Intellectual Migration from Europe, 193041. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1968, 440 pp. (X.800/3238) FLEMING, DONALD and BERNARD BAILYN, eds. The Intellectual Migration, Europe and America, 1930-1960. Cambridge, Mass.: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1969, 748 pp. (X.800/3982) FORD, HUGH D. Published in Paris: American and British Writers, Painters and Publishers in Paris, 1920-1939. New York: Macmillan, 1975, 453 pp. (X.981/10131) FRANCI, GIOVANNA, ROSELLA MANGARONI and ESTHER ZASO. A Journey through American Art Deco: Architecture, Design and Cinema in the Twenties and Thirties. Seattle: University of Washington Press, 1997, 119 pp. (DSC 98/05008) GEHBARD, DAVID. The National Trust Guide to Art Deco in America. New York and Chichester: Wiley, 1996, 278 pp. (YC.1996.b.8818) GOODYEAR, A. CONGER. The Museum of Modern Art: The First Ten Years. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1943, 144 pp. (07812.v.7) 116 GREIF, MARTIN. Depression Modern: The Thirties Style in America. New York: Universe Books, 1975, 192 pp. (X.423/2316) GRIMES, MARY K. and GEORGIANN GERSELL. The Impact of Art Deco, 19251940: An Exhibition Held April 20 through May 23, 1976. Indianapolis, Ind.: Indianapolis Museum of Art, 1976, 31 pp. (X.415/3144) ROSENTHAL, BERNARD M. The Gentle Invasion: Continental Emigré Booksellers of the Thirties and Forties and Their Impact on the Antiquarian Booktrade in the United States: A Lecture Given 15 December 1986. New York: Book Arts Press, School of Library Service, Columbia University, 1987, 17 pp. (ORW.1986.a.3519 OIOC) HARRIS, JONATHAN. Federal Art and National Culture: The Politics of Identity in New Deal America. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1995, 236 pp. (YC.1996.b.641) HARWELL, RICHARD, ed. Gone with the Wind as Book and Film. Columbia: University of South Carolina Press, 1983, 274 pp. (YH.1988.b.1053; YA.1989.b.6011) HEILBUT, ANTHONY. Exiled in Paradise: German Refugee Artists and Intellectuals in America, from the 1930s to the Present. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1997, 524 pp. (YC.1998.a.67) HELLER, STEVEN and LOUISE FILI. Streamline: American Art Deco Graphic Design. San Francisco, Calif.: Chronicle Books, 1995, 132 pp. (YC.1996.b.964) HUGHES, H. STUART. The Sea Change: The Migration of Social Thought, 19301965. New York and London: Harper and Row, 1975, 283 pp. (X.809/45874) ILLINOIS STATE MUSEUM. After the Great Crash: New Deal Art in Illinois: An Exhibition of Art from the Period 1934-1943, Produced by Artists on the Various Federal Art Projects in Illinois. Springfield, Ill.: Illinois State Museum Society, 1983, 32 pp. (A.S.I50/996) JOHNSON, PHILIP. Machine Art. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1934. (Mic.A.9578(5) 7959.g.32); New York: Museum of Modern Art, 60th anniversary ed., 1994. (YC.1996.b.4244) JONES, ALFRED H. Roosevelt's Image Brokers: Poets, Playwrights and the Use of the Lincoln Symbol. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: National University Publications, Kennikat Press, 1974, 134 pp. (X.809/20378) KENT, DONALD P. The Refugee Intellectual: The Americanization of the Immigrants of 1933-1941. New York: Columbia University Press, 1953, 317 pp. (10414.cc.15) KEPPEL, FREDERICK P. and ROBERT L. DUFFUS. The Arts in American Life. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 227 pp. (X.800/1629.(2.)) 117 LAWSON, RICHARD A. The Failure of Independent Liberalism, 1930-1941. New York: Putnam's, 1971, 322 pp. (X.809/16890) LE CORBUSIER. When the Cathedrals Were White: A Journey to the Country of Timid People. Translated by Francis E. Hyslop, Jr. London: Routledge, 1947, 217 pp. (07822.b.28) LONG, FRANK W. Confessions of a Depression Muralist. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1997, 179 pp. (DSC 97/12501) MCDONALD, WILLIAM F. Federal Relief Administration and the Arts: The Origins and Administrative History of the Arts Projects of the Works Progress Administration. Columbus: Ohio State University Press, 1969, 869 pp. (X.421/5827) MCKINZIE, RICHARD D. The New Deal for Artists. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1973, 203 pp. (LR.414.h.14); Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1975, 203 pp. (Cup.1264.a.9) MARLING, KARAL A. Wall-to-Wall America: A Cultural History of Post-Office Murals in the Great Depression. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1982, 348 pp. (DSC 83/00444) MELOSH, BARBARA. Engendering Culture: Manhood and Womanhood in New Deal Public Art and Theater. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1991, 297 pp. (YK.1992.b.8794) MELTZER, MILTON. Violins and Shovels: The WPA Arts Projects. New York: Delacorte, 1976, 160 pp. (X.429/10596) MILES, ORVELL. The Real Thing: Imitation and Authenticity in American Culture, 1880-1940. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1989, 382 pp. (YC.1989.b.7657) MULLEN, BILL and SHERRY LEE LINKON, eds. Radical Revisions: Rereading 1930s Culture. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1996, 291 pp. (YA.1997.b.6120) MUSEUM OF MODERN ART. New Horizons in American Art. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1936, 171 pp. (7810.t.23) MURESIANU, JOHN M. American Intellectuals and the World Crisis, 1938-1945. New York and London: Garland, 1988, 483 pp. (YC.1991.b.4869) NEPHEW, SARA. Quilt Designs from the Thirties. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1994, 64 pp. (X.0625/174) NINKOVICH, FRANK A. The Diplomacy of Ideas: U.S. Foreign Policy and Cultural Relations, 1938-1950. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1981, 253pp. (X.800/30372) 118 OSTRANDER, GILMAN M. American Civilization in the First Machine Age, 18901940. New York and London: Harper and Row, 1972, 414 pp. (X.700/11999) OVERMYER, GRACE. Government and the Arts. New York: Norton, 1939, 338 pp. (07804.b.29) PARK, MARLENE and GERALD E. MARKOWITZ. Democratic Vistas: Post Offices and Public Art in the New Deal. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1984, 247 pp. (DSC 85/11087) PELLS, RICHARD H. Radical Visions and American Dreams: Culture and Social Thought in the Depression Years. New York: Harper and Row, 1974, 424 pp. (X.808/40346) PETRUCK, PENINAH R. Y. American Art Criticism, 1910-1940. New York and London: Garland, 1981, 310 pp. (X.421/25589) POWERS, RICHARD G. G-men: Hoover's FBI in American Popular Culture. Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press, 1983, 356 pp. (YA.1987.b.1604) PILDAS, AVE. Art Deco: Los Angeles: Photographs. New York and London: Harper and Row, 1977, 64 pp. (X.419/34590) RICKER, JEWETT, ed. Sculpture at a Century of Progress, Chicago, 1933, 1934. Chicago: [1934], 31 pp. (07108.bb.21) SAYLER, OLIVER M. Revolt in the Arts: A Survey of the Creation, Distribution and Appreciation of Art in America. New York: Brentano's, 1930, 351 pp. (07805.c.35) SCHRADER, ROBERT F. The Indian Arts and Crafts Board: An Aspect of New Deal Indian Policy. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1983, 364 pp. (YV.1989.b.2512) SCHWARTZ, LAWRENCE H. Marxism and Culture: The CPUSA and Aesthetics in the 1930s. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1980, 151 pp. (X.809/46019) STAUB, MICHAEL E. Voices of Persuasion: Politics of Representation in 1930s America. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994, 174 pp. (YC.1994.b.6262) SUGGS, JON C., ed. American Proletarian Culture: The Twenties and the Thirties. Detroit, Mich., and London: Gale Research, 1993. (HLR 809) TUGWELL, REXFORD G. The Industrial Discipline and the Governmental Arts. New York: Columbia University Press, 1933, 241 pp. (20017.c.4) UNIVERSITY OF MICHIGAN MUSEUM OF ART. The Federal Art Project: American Prints from the 1930s in the Collection of the University of Michigan Museum of Art. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Museum of Art, 1985, 220 pp. (DSC 86/05861) 119 WHITE, JOHN F., ed. Art in Action: American Art Centers and the New Deal. Metuchen, N.J., and London: Scarecrow, 1987, 187 pp. (YC.1988.a.1317) WIRZ, HANS and RICHARD STRINER. Washington Deco: Art Deco Design in the Nation's Capital. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1984, 128 pp. (DSC 85/29175) C. ADVERTISING BURT, FRANK A. American Advertising Agencies: An Inquiry into their Origin, Growth, Functions and Future. New York and London: Harper, 1940, 282 pp. (08230.h.47) MARCHAND, ROLAND. Advertising the American Dream: Making Way for Modernity, 1920-1940. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1985, 448 pp. (DSC 95/30803) PEASE, OTIS A. The Responsibilities of American Advertising: Private Control and Public Influence, 1920-1940. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1958, 323 pp. (08234.t.10) ROBBINS, TRINA and CASEY ROBBINS, eds. Travel and Vacation Advertising Cuts from the Twenties and Thirties. New York: Dover, 1994, 94 pp. (YK.1995.b.7589) D. ARCHITECTURE AND INDUSTRIAL DESIGN BALFOUR, ALAN. Rockefeller Center: Architecture as Theater. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1978, 248 pp. (X.421/10730) BARR, ALFRED H., JR., HENRY-RUSSELL HITCHCOCK, JR., PHILIP JOHNSON and LEWIS MUMFORD. Modern Architects. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1932, 199 pp. (Mic.A.9852(1)) BROWNELL, BAKER and FRANK LLOYD WRIGHT. Architecture and Modern Life. New York and London: Harper, 1937, 339 pp. (07815.bb.29) BUSH, DONALD J. The Streamlined Decade. New York: Braziller, 1975, 214 pp. (X.622/18500) CARTER, ROBERT. Fallingwater: Frank Lloyd Wright. London: Phaidon, 1994, 60 pp. (LB.31.b.11507) CERWINSKE, LAURA. Tropical Deco: The Architecture and Design of Old Miami Beach. New York: Rizzoli, 1981, 95 pp. (LB.31.a.809) CHENEY, SHELDON W. and MARTHA C. CHENEY. Art and the Machine: An Account of Industrial Design in 20th-Century America. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1936, 307 pp. (7809.pp.24) 120 CROWE, MICHAEL F. Deco by the Bay: Art Deco Architecture in the San Francisco Bay Area. New York: Viking Studio Books; London: Penguin, 1995, 122 pp. (YC.1996.b.456) DE LONG, DAVID G., ed. Frank Lloyd Wright: Designs for an American Landscape, 1922-1932. London: Thames and Hudson, 1996, 207 pp. (LB.31.b.13261) HINE, LEWIS W. The Empire State Building. New York and London: Prestel, 1998, 103 pp. (LB.31.c.9612) HITCHCOCK, HENRY-RUSSELL and PHILIP JOHNSON. The International Style: Architecture since 1922. New York: Norton, 1932, 240 pp. (Mic.A.8998) JOHNSON, DONALD L. Frank Lloyd Wright versus America: The 1930s. Cambridge, Mass., and London: MIT Press, 1990, 436 pp. (LB.31.a.3117) KARP, WALTER. The Center: A History and Guide to Rockefeller Center. New York: American Heritage, 1982, 128 pp. (X.805/4755) LIPMAN, JONATHAN. Frank Lloyd Wright and the Johnson Wax Buildings. London: Architectural Press, 1986, 192 pp. (YV.1987.b.1630) MEIKLE, JEFFREY L. Twentieth Century Limited: Industrial Design in America, 19251939. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1979, 249 pp. (X.421/23630) MESSLER, NORBERT. The Art Deco Skyscraper in New York. Frankfurt am Main: Lang, 1983, 232 pp. (X.429/16572) MOCK, ELIZABETH. Built in USA--Since 1932. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1945, 128 pp. (7822.e.3.) PULOS, ARTHUR J. American Design Ethic: A History of Industrial Design to 1940. Cambridge, Mass., and London: MIT Press, 1983, 441 pp. (X.805/4594) SHORT, C. W. and R. STANLEY-BROWN. Public Buildings: A Survey of Architecture of Projects Constructed by Federal and Other Governmental Bodies between the Years 1933 and 1939 with the assistance of the Public Works Administration. Washington, D.C.: Federal Emergency Administration of Public Works, 1939, 697 pp. (A.S.917/43) STERN, ROBERT A. M., GREGORY F. GILMARTIN and THOMAS MELLINS. New York 1930: Architecture and Urbanism between the Two Wars. New York: Rizzoli, 1987, 847 pp. (DSC 87/12958) TAURANAC, JOHN. The Empire State Building: The Making of a Landmark. New York: St. Martin's Griffin, 1997, 383 pp. (YA.1997.b.6808) 121 WILSON, RICHARD G., DIANNE H. PILGRIM and DICKRAN TASHJIAN. The Machine Age in America, 1918-1941. New York: Brooklyn Museum in association with Harry N. Abrams,1986, 376 pp. (YA.1994.b.4382) E. CARTOONS: POLITICAL DARLING, JAY N. As Ding Saw Herbert Hoover. Ames: Iowa State University Press, 1996, 144 pp. (YA.1998.a.12272) SCHWARTZ, BRUNO. The Story of Japan in China, As Told in American Cartoons. New York: Trans-Pacific News Service, 1938, 30 pp. (20032.h.10) SCOTT, QUINCY. Best of Quincy Scott: A Picture Panorama of the Turbulent Depression and World War II Years. Portland, Ore.: Oregon Historical Society, 1980, 196 pp. (DSC 81/21880) F. DANCE ARMITAGE, MERLE, ed. Martha Graham. Los Angeles, Calif.: Merle Armitage, 1937, 132 pp. (YM.1988.a.167) CONNER, LYNNE. Spreading the Gospel of the Modern Dance: Newspaper Dance Criticism in the United States, 1850-1934. Pittsburgh, Pa.: University of Pittsburgh Press, 1997, 177 pp. (YC.1998.a.4265) CRESSEY, PAUL G. The Taxi-Dance Hall: A Sociological Study in Commercialized Recreation and City Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 300 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(14.)) HOWARD, RUTH E. The Story of American Ballet. New York: Ihra Pub. Co., 1936, 39 pp. (Mic.A.158062) MARTIN, CAROL. Dance Marathons: Performing American Culture of the 1920s and 1930s. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1994, 182 pp. (YC.1995.b.1718) MARTIN, JOHN. America Dancing: The Background and Personalities of the Modern Dance. New York: Dodge Pub. Co., 1936, 320 pp. (07908.h.39) MUELLER, JOHN. Astaire Dancing: The Musical Films. London: Hamish Hamilton, 1986, 440 pp. (LB.31.b.2674) PREVOTS, NAIMA. Dancing in the Sun: Hollywood Choreographers, 1915-1937. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research Press, 1987, 281 pp. (DSC 8814.3065 no 44) SHAW, ARNOLD. Let's Dance: Popular Music in the 1930s. Edited by Bill Willard. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1998, 241 pp. (HUS.789.300973) G. DRAMA AND THEATRE 122 ABRAMSON, DORIS E. Negro Playwrights in the American Theatre, 1925-1959. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1969, 335 pp. (X.909/18000; X.090/17989) BENTLEY, JOANNE. Hallie Flanagan: A Life in the American Theatre. New York: Knopf, 1988, 436 pp. (DSC 88/22242) BOND, FREDERICK W. The Negro and the Drama: The Direct and Indirect Contribution which the American Negro Has Made to Drama and the Legitimate Stage, with the Underlying Conditions Responsible. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1940, 213 pp. (11863.b.38) BUTTITTA, TONY and BARRY WITHAM. Uncle Sam Presents: A Memoir of the Federal Theatre, 1935-1939. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1982, 249 pp. (DSC 82/19838) CLURMAN, HAROLD. The Fervent Years: The Story of the Group Theatre and the Thirties. London: Dennis Dobson, 1946, 298 pp. (W.P.12353/2); New York: Hill & Wang, 1957, 302 pp. (W.P.14964.a/8) CRAIG, E. QUITA. Black Drama of the Federal Theatre Era: Beyond the Formal Horizons. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press, 1980, 239 pp. (DSC 80/22501) DE ROHAN, PIERRE, ed. Federal Theatre Plays. New York: Random House, 1938, 282 pp. (2303.f.13) DUFFY, SUSAN. American Labor on Stage: Dramatic Interpretations of the Steel and Textile Industries in the 1930s. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1996, 156 pp. (YC.1997.b.598) DUFFY, SUSAN. The Political Left in the American Theatre of the 1930's: A Bibliographic Sourcebook. Metuchen, N.J., and London: Scarecrow, 1992, 213 pp. (2725.e.1922) EUSTIS, MORTON. B'way, Inc.! The Theatre as a Business. New York: Dodd, Mead, 1934, 356 pp. (11797.e.16) FEARNOW, MARK. The American Stage and the Great Depression: A Cultural History of the Grotesque. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1997, 214 pp. (YC.1997.b.4105) FLANAGAN, HALLIE. Arena: The History of the Federal Theatre. New York: B. Blom, 1965, 475 pp. (X.900/3282) FLEXNER, ELEANOR. American Playwrights, 1918-1938: The Theatre Retreats from Reality. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1938, 331 pp. (11862.d.36) FRADEN, RENA. Blueprints for a Black Federal Theatre, 1935-1939. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994, 243 pp. (YC.1994.b.4371) 123 GILL, GLENDA E. White Grease Paint on Black Performers: A Study of the Federal Theatre of 1935-1939. New York: Lang, 1988, 220 pp. (YA.1992.a.4152) GOLDSTEIN, MALCOLM. The Political Stage: American Drama and Theater of the Great Depression. New York: Oxford University Press, 1974, 482 pp. (X.981/5026) HIMELSTEIN, MORGAN Y. Drama Was a Weapon: The Left-Wing Theatre in New York, 1929-1941. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1963, 300 pp. (X.909/8350) HOUGHTON, NORRIS. Advance from Broadway: 19,000 Miles of American Theatre. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1941, 416 pp. (11796.c.14) MANTLE, BURNS. Contemporary American Playwrights. New York: Dodd, Mead, 1940, 357 pp. (11862.d.34) MARCUSON, LEWIS R. The Stage Immigrant: The Irish, Italians and Jews in American Drama, 1920-1960. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 309 pp. (YC.1991.a.2819) MATHEWS, JANE DE HART. The Federal Theatre, 1935-1939: Plays, Relief and Politics. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1967, 342 pp. (X.909/11822) O'CONNOR, JOHN and LORRAINE BROWN, eds. The Federal Theatre Project: 'Free, Adult, Uncensored'. London: Eyre Methuen, 1980, 228 pp. (L.49/681) O'HARA, FRANK H. Today in American Drama. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 277 pp. (11865.aa.1) REYNOLDS, R. C. Stage Left: The Development of the American Social Drama in the Thirties. Troy, N.Y.: Whitson Pub. Co., 1986, 175 pp. (YL.1990.b.323) SMITH, WENDY. Real-life Drama: The Group Theatre and America, 1931-1940. New York: Knopf, 1990, 482 pp. (DSC 91/03386) WALDAU, ROY S. Vintage Years of the Theatre Guild, 1928-1939. Cleveland, Ohio, and London: Press of Case Western Reserve, 1972, 519 pp. (X.981/3610) WELLES, ORSON. Orson Welles on Shakespeare: The W.P.A. and Mercury Theatre Playscripts. Edited by Richard France. New York and London: Greenwood, 1990, 297 pp. (YC.1991.b.4860) WHITMAN, WILLSON. Bread and Circuses: A Study of Federal Theatre. New York: Oxford University Press, 1937, 191 pp. (11796.bb.18); London: Oxford University Press, 1938, 191 pp. (11796.bb.22) WITTLER, CLARENCE J. Some Social Trends in WPA Drama. Washington, D.C.: Catholic University of America Press, 1939, 125 pp. (11872.bb.8) 124 H. EDUCATION AMERICAN ASSOCIATION OF UNIVERSITY PROFESSORS. Depression, Recovery and Higher Education. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1937, 543 pp. (08385.ee.25) BEALE, HOWARD K. Are American Teachers Free? An Analysis of Restraints upon the Freedom of Teaching in American Schools. New York: Scribner's, 1936, 855 pp. (Ac.8504.aa) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. Educational Service for Indians. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 18, 1939, 137 pp. (A.S.988) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. Public Education in the Territories and Outlying Posssessions. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 16, 1939, 243 pp. (A.S.988) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. and WILLIAM L. IVERSEN. Education of Children on Federal Reservations. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 17, 1939, 145 pp. (A.S.988) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. and J. ORIN POWERS. Public Education in the District of Columbia. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 15, 1938, 99 pp. (A.S. 988) BOND, HORACE M. Negro Education in Alabama: A Study in Cotton and Steel. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1939, 358 pp. (08385.f.119); Tuscaloosa and London: University of Alabama Press, 1994, 383 pp. (YC.1995.a.2454) BRAX, RALPH S. The First Student Movement: Student Activism in the United States during the 1930s. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1981, 121 pp. (X.809/47885) BRUNNER, EDMUND DE S. Community Organization and Adult Education: A Five-Year Experiment. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1942, 121 pp. (08385.g.17) CAMPBELL, D. S., FREDERICK H. BAIR and OSWALD L. HARVEY. Educational Activities of the Works Progress Administration. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 14, 1939, 185 pp. (A.S.988) COHEN, ROBERT. When the Old Left Was Young: Student Radicals and America's First Mass Student Movement, 1929-1941. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1993, 432 pp. (YC.1993.b.7319) COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in Alaska. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Office of Education Bulletin no. 12, 1937, 56 pp. (A.S.202) 125 COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in the Panama Canal Zone. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Office of Education Bulletin no. 8, 1939, 63 pp. (A.S.202) COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in the Philippine Islands. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Office of Education Bulletin no. 9, 1935, 53 pp. (A.S.202) COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in Puerto Rico. Washington, D.C.: U.S Office of Education Bulletin no. 5, 1934, 52 pp. (A.S. 202) EAGAN, EILEEN. Class, Culture and the Classroom: The Student Peace Movement of the 1930s. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1981, 319 pp. (X.529/64703) FRENCH, WILL. Education and Social Dividends. New York: Macmillan, 1935, 119 pp. (08311.c.68) GEIGER, ROGER L. To Advance Knowledge: The Growth of American Research Universities, 1900-1940. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1986, 325 pp. (YH.1987.b.529) HARBY, SAMUEL F. A Study of Education in the Civilian Conservation Corps Camps of the Second Corps Area, April 1933-March 1937. Ann Arbor, Mich.: Edwards, 1938, 264 pp. (08385.c.9) HOLLIS, ERNEST V. Philanthropic Foundations and Higher Education. New York: Columbia University Press, 1938, 365 pp. (08385.f.113) JOHNSON, CHARLES S. The Negro College Graduate. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1938, 399 pp. (08385.b.11) JUDD, CHARLES H. Problems of Education in the United States. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 214 pp. (X.800/1629.(5.)) KRUG, EDWARD A. The Shaping of the American High School. 2 vols. New York: Harper and Row, 1964, 72 pp. (W.P.4065/52) LANGFORD, HOWARD D. Education and the Social Conflict. New York: Macmillan, 1936, 210 pp. (08311.a.49) LEVINE, DAVID O. The American College and the Culture of Aspiration, 1915-1940. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1986, 281 pp. (DSC 86/22535) MOREO, DOMINIC W. Schools in the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1996, 203 pp. (YC.1996.a.2124) NASH, JAY B., ed. Character Education through Physical Education. New York: Barnes, 1932, 315 pp. (08308.a.56) PATTERSON, SAMUEL H., ERNEST A. CHOATE and EDMUND DE S. BRUNNER. The School in American Society. Scranton, Pa.: International Textbook Co., 1936, 570 pp. (8314.bb.1/1) 126 REEVES, FLOYD W., JOHN DALE RUSSELL, H. C. GREGG, A. J. BRUMBAUGH and L. E. BLAUCH. The Liberal Arts College; Based upon Surveys of Thirty-five Colleges Related to the Methodist Episcopal Church. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 715 pp. (8385.d.40) REID, CHARLES F. Education in the Territories and Outlying Possessions of the United States. New York: Teachers College, Columbia University, 1941, 593 pp. (08385.e.128) TUSHNET, MARK V. The NAACP's Legal Strategy Against Segregated Education, 1925-1950. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1987, 222 pp. (YC.1991.b.4992) TYACK, DAVID, ROBERT LOWE and ELISABETH HANSOT. Public Schools in Hard Times: The Great Depression and Recent Years. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1984, 267 pp. (X.520/36158) TYSON, LEVERING and JOSEPHINE MACLATCHY, eds. Education on the Air, and Radio and Education, 1935: Proceedings of the Sixth Annual Institute for Education by Radio, combined with the Fifth Annual Assembly of the National Advisory Council on Radio in Education. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1935, 316 pp. (Ac.2685.gbc) WALLACE, JAMES M. Liberal Journalism and American Education, 1914-1941. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1991, 237 pp. (DSC 91/20678) WORKS, GEORGE ALAN and SIMON O. LESSER. Rural America Today: Its Schools and Community Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1942, 450 pp. (08385.b.83) I. EXPOSITIONS AND WORLD FAIRS 1. General Study RYDELL, ROBERT W. World of Fairs: The Century-of-Progress Expositions. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1993, 269 pp. (YC.1994.a.2907) 2. Chicago Century of Progress International Exposition, 1933-1934 BEARD, CHARLES A., ed. A Century of Progress. Chicago and New York: Harper, in cooperation with A Century of Progress Exposition, 1932, 452 pp. (20016.d.20) CENTURY OF PROGRESS INTERNATIONAL EXPOSITION. The Official Pictures of a Century of Progress Exposition, Chicago, 1933. Chicago: Reuben H. Donnelley Corp., 1933. (7960.k.6) 127 KETTERING, CHARLES F. and ALLEN ORTH. The New Necessity: The Culmination of a Century of Progress in Transportation. Baltimore, Md.: Williams & Wilkins, 1932, 124 pp. (Mic.A.12772) RALEY, DOROTHY, ed. A Century of Progress: Homes and Furnishings. Chicago, Ill.: M. A. Ring Co., 1934, 127 pp. (Mic.A.13010) RICKER, JEWETT, ed. Sculpture at a Century of Progress, Chicago, 1933, 1934. Chicago, [1934], 31 pp. (07108.bb.21) 3. Golden Gate International Exposition, 1939 INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION. Contemporary Art of 79 Countries: The International Business Machines Corporation Collection Exhibited in its Gallery of Science and Art in the Palace of Electricity and Communication at the Golden Gate International Exposition, San Francisco, California. San Francisco, Calif.: International Business Machines Corp., 1939. (7869.f.22) NEUHAUS, EUGEN. The Art of Treasure Island: First-hand Impressions of the Architecture, Sculpture, Landscape Design, Color Effects, Mural Decorations, Illuminations and Other Artistic Aspects of the Golden Gate International Exposition of 1939. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1939, 185 pp. (7959.h.57) 4. New York World's Fair, 1939 BLETTER, ROSEMARIE H., et al. Remembering the Future: The New York World's Fair from 1939-1964. New York: Rizzoli, 1989, 208 pp. (DSC q90/00622) GAIGE, CROSBY. New York World's Fair Cook Book: The American Kitchen. New York: Doubleday, Doran, 1939, 309 pp. (7944.t.37) GELERNTER, DAVID. 1939: The Lost World of the Fair. New York and London: Free Press, 1995, 418 pp. (YK.1996.a.23972) HARRISON, HELEN A. and JOSEPH P. CUSKER. Dawn of a New Day: The New York World's Fair, 1939/40. New York: Queens Museum; New York and London: New York University Press, 1980, 123 pp. (X.421/23214; X.421/23215) METROPOLITAN MUSEUM OF ART. Life in America: A Special Loan Exhibition of Paintings Held during the Period of the New York World's Fair. New York: Metropolitan Museum of Art, 1939, 230 pp. (7866.ppp.9) MONAGHAN, FRANK, ed. New York: The World's Fair City. Garden City, N.Y.: Garden City Pub. Co., 1937, [90] pp. (10410.y.27) NEW YORK WORLD'S FAIR. American Art Today: New York World's Fair. New York: National Art Society, 1939, 342 pp. (7801.dd.2) 128 UNITED STATES NEW YORK WORLD'S FAIR COMMISSION. Report to the Congress of the United States. Washington, D.C.: Government Printing Office, 1941, 299 pp. (A.S.187/2); Supplement, 1941. (A.S.187/2) UNITED STATES NEW YORK WORLD'S FAIR COMMISSION. United States Government Building, New York World's Fair, 1940. Washington, D.C.: U.S. New York World's Fair Commission, 1940, 23 pp. (A.S.187/11) WENTWORTH, CYNTHIA and CARL FEISS. New York World's Fair, 1939: Guide to Housing Exhibits. Washington, D.C.: U. S. Housing Authority, 1939, 16 p. (A.S.997/4) WESTINGHOUSE ELECTRIC & MANUFACTURING COMPANY. The Book of Record of the Time Capsule of Cupaloy Deemed Capable of Resisting the Effects of Time for Five Thousand Years, Preserving an Account of Universal Achievements, Embedded in the Grounds of the New York World's Fair, 1939. New York: Westinghouse Electric & Manufacturing Co., 1938, 51 pp. (20033.d.15) WURTS, RICHARD, et al. The New York World's Fair, 1939-1940. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1977, 152 pp. (X.700/25662) J. FEDERAL WRITERS PROJECT [See also VII. U.S. States, Regions and Territories] BREWER, JEUTONNE. The Federal Writers' Project: A Bibliography. Metuchen, N.J., and London: Scarecrow, 1994, 160 pp. (2725.e.2768) HOBSON, ARCHIE, ed. Remembering America: A Sampler of the WPA American Guide Series. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1985, 391 pp. (YC.1989.b.2684) MAGIONE, JERRE G. The Dream and the Deal: The Federal Writers' Project, 19351943. Boston and Toronto: Little, Brown, 1972, 416 pp. (X.981/9271) NOGGLE, BURL. Working with History: The Historical Records Survey in Louisiana and the Nation, 1936-1942. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1981, 139 pp. (X.800/41198) PENKOWER, MONTY N. The Federal Writers' Project: A Study in Government Patronage of the Arts. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1977, 266 pp. (X.981/21105) K. FILM ALEXANDER, WILLIAM L. Film on the Left: American Documentary Film from 1931 to 1942. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1981, 355 pp. (X.950/5125) 129 BAILEY, MARGARET J. Those Glorious Glamour Years: Classic Hollywood Costume Design of the 1930's. London: Columbus, 1988, 384 pp. (YV.1989.b.1584) BALIO, TINO. Grand Design: Hollywood as a Modern Business Enterprise, 1930-1939. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1995, 483 pp. (YC.1994.b.6723) BARRIER, J. MICHAEL. Hollywood Cartoons: American Animation in Its Golden Age. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1999, 648 pp. (YC.1999.b.4424) BAXTER, JOHN. Hollywood in the Thirties. London: Zwemmer; New York: Barnes, 1968, 160 pp. (X.907/9622) BERGMAN, ANDREW L. We're In the Money: Depression America and Its Films. New York: New York University Press, 1971, 200 pp. (X.981/4225); New York: Harper and Row, 1972, 200 pp. (X.908/25122) BILLINGSLEY, LLOYD. Hollywood Party: How Communism Seduced the American Film Industry in the 1930s and 1940s. Rocklin, Calif.: Forum, 1998. (DSC 99/17289) BLUMER, HERBERT and PHILIP M. HAUSER. Movies, Delinquency and Crime. New York: Macmillan, 1933, 233 pp. (X.329/7538.(5.) CAMPBELL, RUSSELL. Cinema Strikes Back: Radical Film Making in the United States, 1930-1942. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research Press, 1982, 387 pp. (X.950/18507) CEPLAIR, LARRY and STEVEN ENGLUND. The Inquisition in Hollywood: Politics in the Film Community, 1930-1960. Garden City, N.Y.: Anchor Press/Doubleday, 1980, 536 pp. (X.800/32389); Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1983, 546 pp. (YC.1988.a.4436) CORMACK, MICHAEL J. Ideology and Cinematographic Style in Hollywood, 19301939. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1994, 170 pp. (YC.1994.a.429) DOHERTY, THOMAS P. Pre-Code Hollywood: Sex, Immorality and Insurrection in American Cinema, 1930-1934. New York: Columbia University Press, 1999, 430 pp. (DSC 99/33455) DOOLEY, ROGER. From Scarface to Scarlett: American Films in the 1930s. New York: Harcourt Brace Jovanovich, 1981, 648 pp. (X.955/2272) EYLES, ALLEN. That Was Hollywood: The 1930's. London: Batsford, 1987, 160 pp. (YC.1988.b.5048) FAGEN, HERB. White Hats and Silver Spurs: Interviews with 24 Stars of Film and Television: Westerns of the Thirties through the Sixties. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1996, 245 pp. (YK.1997.b.3579) 130 FORMAN, HENRY J. Our Movie Made Children. New York: Macmillan, 1933, 288 pp. (11796.bbb.1) JACOBS, LEA. The Wages of Sin: Censorship and the Fallen Woman Film, 1928-1942. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1997, 202 pp. (YC.1997.a.3668) JACOBS, LEWIS. The Rise of the American Film: A Critical History. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1939, 585 pp. (11797.g.21) KELLEY, BEVERLY M., with JOHN J. PITNEY, CRAIG R. SMITH and HERBERT E. GOOCH III. Reelpolitik: Political Ideologies in '30s and '40s Films. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1998, 194 pp. (YC.1999.b.1138) KOBAL, JOHN. Art of the Great Hollywood Portrait Photographers, 1925-1940. London: Allen and Lane, 1980, 291 pp. (DSC F81/0469) LANGMAN, LARRY and DANIEL FINN. A Guide to American Crime Films of the Thirties. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1995, 347 pp. (YC.1995.b.3213) LOUDON, HUGH. My Hollywood: A Nostalgic Look at Films of the Thirties and Forties. Upton-upon-Severn: Self Publishing Association, 1991, 236 pp. (YK.1992.b.1685) MUELLER, JOHN. Astaire Dancing: The Musical Films. London: Hamish Hamilton, 1986, 440 pp. (LB.31.b.2674) MUSCIO, GIULIANA. Hollywood's New Deal. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1996, 259 pp. (YC.1998.a.4848) PAINE, JEFFERY M. The Simplification of American Life: Hollywood Films of the 1930's. New York: Arno, 1977, 305 pp. (X.950/8745) PREVOTS, NAIMA. Dancing in the Sun: Hollywood Choreographers, 1915-1937. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research Press, 1987, 281 pp. (DSC 8814.3065) RAMSAYE, TERRY, ed. International Motion Picture Almanac, 1938-39. New York: Quigley Pub. Co., 1938, 1250 pp. (PP.2523.lp); International Motion Picture Almanac, 1939-40. New York: Quigley Pub. Co., 1939, 1192 pp. (PP.2523.lp) RODDICK, NICK. A New Deal in Entertainment: Warner Brothers in the 1930s. London: British Film Institute, 1983, 332 pp. (X.429/15081) ROFFMAN, PETER and JIM PURDY. The Hollywood Social Problem Film: Madness, Despair and Politics from the Depression to the Fifties. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1981, 364 pp. (X.950/27408) ROSTEN, LEO. Hollywood: The Movie Colony, the Movie Makers. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1941, 436 pp. (Mic.A.15574) 131 SCHWARTZ, NANCY L. The Hollywood Writers' Wars. New York: Knopf, 1982, 333 pp. (X.622/20553) SELDES, GILBERT V. Movies for the Millions: An Account of Motion Pictures, Principally in America. London: Batsford, 1937, 120 pp. (11796.bb.15) SEVASTAKIS, MICHAEL. Songs of Love and Death: The Classical American Horror Film of the 1930s. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1993, 208 pp. (YC.1994.b.2066) SHINDLER, COLIN. Hollywood in Crisis: Cinema and American Society, 1929-1939. London: Routledge, 1996, 258 pp. (YC.1996.b.5424) SNYDER, ROBERT L. Pare Lorentz and the Documentary Film. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1968, 232 pp. (X.981/1979) SOMMER, ROBIN L. Hollywood: The Glamour Years (1919-1941). London: Bison Books, 1987, 192 pp. (YC.1988.b.5158) TAYLOR, JOHN R. Strangers in Paradise: The Hollywood Emigrés, 1930-1950. London: Faber, 1983, 256 pp. (DSC 83/14422) THORP, MARGARET F. America at the Movies. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1939, 313 pp. (11797.b.13); London: Faber & Faber, 1946, 184 pp. (11797.g.30) TIERNEY, TOM. Thirty from the 30's. Englewood Cliffs, N.J., and London: Prentice-Hall, 1974, 70 pp. (L.45/2390) VASEY, RUTH. The World According to Hollywood, 1918-1939. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press, 1997, 299 pp. (DSC 98/10954) VERMILYE, JERRY. The Films of the Thirties. Secaucus, N.J.: Citadel Press, 1982, 256 pp. (DSC 83/09335) WEALES, GERALD. Canned Goods as Caviar: American Film Comedy of the 1930's. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1985, 386 pp. (YC.1986.b.1835) WINOKUR, MARK. American Laughter: Immigrants, Ethnicity and 1930s: Hollywood Film Comedy. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1995, 310 pp. (YC.1996.a.2667) L. JOURNALISM AND MASS MEDIA 1. Miscellaneous Studies ASHLEY, PERRY J., ed. American Newspaper Journalists, 1926-1950. Detroit, Mich.: Gale Research Co., 1984, 410 pp. (HLR 809) 132 BAUMAN, JOHN F. and THOMAS H. COODE. In the Eye of the Great Depression: New Deal Reporters and the Agony of the American People. De Kalb: Northern Illinois University Press, 1988, 230 pp. (DSC 89/10084) BENT, SILAS. Newspaper Crusaders: A Neglected Story. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1939, 313 pp. (11865.c.11) BEST, GARY D. The Critical Press and the New Deal: The Press versus Presidential Power, 1933-1938. Westport, Conn.: Praeger, 1993, 198 pp. (DSC 93/10729) BUHITE, RUSSELL D. and DAVID W. LEVY, eds. FDR's Fireside Chats. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1992, 326 pp. (YC.1993.b.6057) CORTNER, RICHARD C. The Kingfish and the Constitution: Huey Long, the First Amendment and the Emergence of Modern Press Freedom in America. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1996, 196 pp. (YC.1996.b.3578) DESMOND, ROBERT W. Crisis and Conflict: World News Reporting between Two Wars, 1920-1940. Iowa City: University of Iowa Press, 1982, 518 pp. (2708.e.1416) EDWARDS, JEROME E. The Foreign Policy of Colonel McCormick's Tribune, 19291941. Reno: University of Nevada Press, 1971, 232 pp. (X.981/4748) FIELDING, RAYMOND. The March of Time, 1935-1951. New York: Oxford University Press, 1978, 359 pp. (X.800/27469) GERALD, JAMES E. The Press and the Constitution, 1931-1947. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1948, 173 pp. (11868.h.19) HEALD, MORREL. Transatlantic Vistas: American Journalists in Europe, 1900-1940. Kent, Ohio, and London: Kent State University Press, 1988, 281 pp. (YH.1989.b.592) HICKOK, LORENA. One Third of a Nation: Lorena Hickok Reports on the Great Depression. Edited by Richard Lowitt and Maurine Beasley. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1981, 378 pp. (X.520/25678) JACKAWAY, GWENYTH L. Media at War: Radio's Challenge to the Newspapers, 1924-1939. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1995, 168 pp. (YC.1996.b.3959) KNEEBONE, JOHN T. Southern Liberal Journalists and the Issue of Race, 1920-1944. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1985, 312 pp. (DSC 86/06485) LEAB, DANIEL J. A Union of Individuals: The Formation of the American Newspaper Guild, 1933-1956. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1970, 362 pp. (X.520/3752) 133 LEE, ALFRED M. The Daily Newspaper in America: The Evolution of a Social Instrument. New York: Macmillan, 1937, 797 pp. (11840.g.38) LIEBOVICH, LOUIS. Bylines in Despair: Herbert Hoover, the Great Depression and the U.S. News Media. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1994, 223 pp. (YC.1994.b.6954) LIPPMANN, WALTER. Interpretations, 1931-1932. Edited by Allan Nevins. London: Allen & Unwin, 1932, 361 pp. (W.P.11744); Interpretations, 1933-1935. Edited by Allan Nevins. New York: Macmillan, 1936, 399 pp. (W.P.11744) LIPSTADT, DEBORAH E. Beyond Belief: The American Press and the Coming of the Holocaust, 1933-1945. New York: Free Press, 1986, 370 pp. (DSC 85/35303) PYLE, ERNIE. Ernie's America: The Best of Ernie Pyle's 1930's Travel Dispatches. Edited by David Nichols. New York: Random House, 1989, 423 pp. (YA.1994.b.8343) ROOSEVELT, ELEANOR. The White House Press Conferences of Eleanor Roosevelt. Edited by Maurine Beasley. New York and London: Garland, 1983, 354 pp. (X.809/59952) ROSS, ROBERT W. So It Was True: The American Protestant Press and the Nazi Persecution of the Jews. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1980, 374 pp. (X.800/33555) SELDES, GEORGE. Freedom of the Press. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: BobbsMerrill, 1935, 380 pp. (11856.f.69) SELDES, GEORGE. Lords of the Press. New York: Julian Messner, 1938, 408 pp. (11859.ff.12) SMITH, ROBERT N. The Colonel: The Life and Legend of Robert R. McCormick, 1880-1955. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1977, 597 pp. (DSC 98/20916) STEELE, RICHARD W. Propaganda in an Open Society: The Roosevelt Administration and the Media, 1933-1941. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1985, 231 pp. (YC.1988.a.3654) WALLACE, JAMES M. Liberal Journalism and American Education, 1914-1941. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1991, 237 pp. (DSC 91/20678) WHITE, GRAHAM. FDR and the Press. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1979, 186 pp. (X.809/44494) WILLEY, MALCOLM M. and STUART A. RICE. Communication Agencies and Social Life. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 229 pp. (X.800/1629.(1.)) 134 WINFIELD, BETTY H. FDR and the News Media. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1990, 276 pp. (YA.1993.b.6235); New York and Chichester: Columbia University Press, 1994, 276 pp. (YC.1995.a.4833) 2. Radio [See also III.I.4. Government and Politics: Opposition Parties and Protest Movements: Coughlin, Charles E.] AITKEN, HUGH G. J. The Continuous Wave: Technology and American Radio, 19001932. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1985, 588 pp. (YK.1989.b.1422) ARCHER, GLEASON L. Big Business and Radio. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1971, 503 pp. (1551/346) BROWN, ROBERT J. Manipulating the Ether: The Power of Broadcast Radio in Thirties America. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1988, 310 pp. (DSC 98/14510) BUXTON, FRANK and BILL OWEN. The Big Broadcast, 1920-1950. Rev. ed., New York: Viking, 1972, 301 pp. (X.629/20010); 2d ed., Lanham, Md., and London: Scarecrow, 1997, 294 pp. (YK.1997.b.1946) CANTRIL, A. HADLEY and GORDON W. ALLPORT. The Psychology of Radio. New York and London: Harper, 1935, 276 pp. (08756.cc.40) CANTRIL, HADLEY. The Invasion from Mars: A Study in the Psychology of Panic, with the Complete Script of the Famous Orson Welles Broadcast. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1940, 228 pp. (20034.bb.8; X.529/53389); New York: Harper and Row, 1966, 224 pp. (X.529/7715) CULBERT, DAVID H. News for Everyman: Radio and Foreign Affairs in Thirties America. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 238 pp. (X.809/42065) DELONG, THOMAS A. Radio Stars: An Illustrated Biographical Dictionary of 953 Performers, 1920 through 1960. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1996, 306 pp. (YK.1997.b.1089) DUNNING, JOHN. Tune In Yesterday: The Ultimate Encyclopedia of Old-time Radio, 1925-1976. Englewood Cliffs, N.J.: Prentice-Hall, 1976, 703 pp. (X.950/3557) GURMAN, JOSEPH B. and MYRON SLAGER Radio Round-ups: Intimate Glimpses of the Radio Stars. Boston: Lothrop, Lee & Shepard, 1932, 109 pp. (Mic.A.18975) HOSLEY, DAVID H. As Good as Any: Foreign Correspondence on American Radio, 1930-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1984, 165pp. (X.809/65044) MACDONALD, J. FRED. Don't Touch That Dial! Radio Programming in American Life, 1920-1960. Chicago: Nelson-Hall, 1980, 412 pp. (X.529/43813) 135 ROSEN, PHILIP T. The Modern Stentors: Radio Broadcasters and the Federal Government, 1920-1934. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1980, 267 pp. (X.529/41645) SCHWOCH, JAMES. The American Radio Industry and Its Latin American Activities, 1900-1939. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1990, 184 pp. (YA.1993.b.4521) SMULYAN, SUSAN. Selling Radio: The Commercialization of American Broadcasting, 1920-1934. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1994, 223 pp. (YC.1994.b.4760) TYSON, LEVERING and JOSEPHINE MACLATCHY, eds. Education on the Air, and Radio and Education, 1935: Proceedings of the Sixth Annual Institute for Education by Radio, combined with the Fifth Annual Assembly of the National Advisory Council on Radio in Education. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1935, 316 pp. (Ac.2685.gbc) M. LEISURE, RECREATION AND SPORTS 1. Miscellaneous Studies BAUMER, WILLIAM H. Sports as Taught and Played at West Point. Harrisburg, Pa.: Military Service Pub. Co., 1941, 351 pp. (X.620/8461) BUTLER, GEORGE D. Introduction to Community Recreation. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1940, 547 pp. (8289.dd.1) CRESSEY, PAUL G. The Taxi-Dance Hall: A Sociological Study in Commercialized Recreation and City Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 300 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(14.)) HAMBRIDGE, GOVE. Time to Live: Adventures in the Use of Leisure. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 144 pp. (08408.eee.62) KELLEY, BRENT. The Early All-Stars: Conversations with Standout Baseball Players of the 1930s and 1940s. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1997, 199 pp. (YK.1997.a.2997) KELLEY, BRENT. Voices from the Negro Leagues: Conversations with 52 Baseball Standouts of the Period 1924-1960. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1998, 334 pp. (YC.1998.b.647) LUNDBERG, GEORGE A., MIRRA KOMAROVSKY and MARY A. MCINERNY. Leisure: A Suburban Study. New York: Columbia University Press, 1934, 396 pp. (08285.i.20) NEUMEYER, MARTIN H. and ESTHER S. NEUMEYER. Leisure and Recreation: A Study of Leisure and Recreation in their Sociological Aspects. New York: Barnes, 1936, 405 pp. (8287.b.35) 136 STEINER, JESSE F. Americans at Play: Recent Trends in Recreation and Leisure Time Activities. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 201 pp. (X.800/1629.(7.)) WEAVER, ROBERT B. Amusements and Sports in American Life. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 195 pp. (7913.tt.12) 2. Olympics BAKER, WILLIAM J. Jesse Owens: An American Life. New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan, 1986, 289 pp. (YK.1987.b.2061) GUTTMANN, ALLEN. The Games Must Go On: Avery Brundage and the Olympic Movement. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1984, 317 pp. (X.622/20491) HART-DAVIS, DUFF. Hitler's Games: The 1936 Olympics. London: Century, 1986, 256 pp. (YC.1986.a.1658); Sevenoaks: Coronet, 1988, 256 pp. (YC.1988.a.9545) MANDELL, RICHARD D. The Nazi Olympics. London: Souvenir Press, 1972, 316 pp. (X.629/4437) ORGANIZING COMMITTEE, GAMES OF THE XTH OLYMPIAD. Olympic Games: Official Pictorial Souvenir. Los Angeles, Calif.: Organizing Committee, Xth Olympiad, 1932, 64 pp. (7912.k.34) OLYMPIC GAMES. Olympic Games 1936: Official Organ of the XI. Olympic Games Berlin 1936, no. 15, 88 pp. (Cup.1264.hh.33) PIEROTH, DORIS H. Their Day in the Sun: Women of the 1932 Olympics. Seattle and London: University of Washington Press, 1996, 186 pp. (DSC 97/03288) RUBIEN, FREDERICK W., ed. Report of the American Olympic Committee: Games of the XIth Olympiad, Berlin, Germany, August 1 to 16, 1936; IVth Olympic Winter Games, Garmisch-Partenkirchen, Germany, February 6 to 16, 1936. New York: American Olympic Committee, 1937, 491 pp. (7913.w.9) N. LIBRARIES CASE, HARRY L. Municipal Libraries in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1937, 89 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) GLEASON, ELIZA A. The Southern Negro and the Public Library: A Study of the Government and Administration of Public Library Service to Negroes in the South. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 218 pp. (Ac.2691.dia/2.(23.)) RADFORD, NEIL A. The Carnegie Corporation and the Development of American College Libraries, 1928-1941. Chicago: American Library Association, 1984, 257 pp. (2719.x.5617) 137 RING, DANIEL F., ed. Studies in Creative Partnership: Federal Aid to Public Libraries during the New Deal. Metuchen, N.J.: Scarecrow, 1980, 145 pp. (2719.x.3155) STANFORD, EDWARD B. Library Extension under the WPA: An Appraisal of an Experiment in Federal Aid. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1944, 284 pp. (YA.1996.b.4586) WAPLES, DOUGLAS and LEON CARNOVSKY. Libraries and Readers in the State of New York: The State's Administration of Public and School Libraries with Reference to the Educational Values of Library Services. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 160 pp. (Ac.2691.dia/2.(13.)) WAPLES, DOUGLAS. People and Print: Social Aspects of Reading in the Depression. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1937, 228 pp. (Ac.2691.dia/2.(7.); 2719.x.12348); Research Memorandum on Social Aspects of Reading in the Depression. New York: Social Science Research Council, 1937, 228 pp. (Mic.A.8935) O. LITERARY CRITICISM, COLLECTIONS AND MEMOIRS ADAMIC, LOUIS. My America: 1928-1938. London: Hamish Hamilton, 1939, 669 pp. (010410.l.30) BEACH, JOSEPH W. American Fiction, 1920-1940. New York: Macmillan, 1942, 371 pp. (11865.ff.15) BOGARDUS, RALPH F. and FRED HOBSON, eds. Literature at the Barricades: The American Writer in the 1930's. University: University of Alabama Press, 1982, 235 pp. (DSC 82/23572) CONKIN, PAUL K. The Southern Agrarians. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1988, 196 pp. (YA.1990.a.16233) COWAN, LOUISE. The Fugitive Group: A Literary History. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1959, 277 pp. (X.900/635) COWLEY, MALCOLM. The Dream of the Golden Mountains: Remembering the 1930s. New York: Viking, 1980, 328 pp. (X.529/46479) COWLEY, MALCOLM. Think Back on Us: A Contemporary Chronicle of the 1930's. Carbondale and Edwardsville: Southern Illinois University Press; London and Amsterdam: Feffer & Simons, 1967, 400 pp. (X.809/10592) DEANE, PATRICK, ed. History in Our Hands: A Critical Anthology of Writings on Literature, Culture and Politics from the 1930s. London: Leicester University Press, 1998, 406 pp. (YC.1998.b.4858) FILLER, LOUIS, ed. The Anxious Years: America in the Nineteen Thirties: A Collection of Contemporary Writings. New York: Putnam's, 1963, 375 pp. (X.809/2174) 138 FOLEY, BARBARA. Radical Representations: Politics and Form in U.S. Proletarian Fiction, 1929-1941. Durham and London: Duke University Press, 1993, 459 pp. (YC.1994.a.2371) FORD, NICK A. The Contemporary Negro Novel: A Study in Race Relations. Boston: Meador Pub. Co., 1936, 108 pp. (11860.aa.13) GINZBERG, ELI. New Deal Days, 1933-1934. New Brunswick, N.J., and London: Transaction Pub., 1997, 109 pp. (DSC 97/24179) GURKO, LEO. The Angry Decade: An Account of American Literature in the Light of Social Conditions, 1930-40. New York: Dodd, Mead, 1947, 306 pp. (11868.f.27) HAPKE, LAURA. Daughters of the Great Depression: Woman, Work and Fiction in the American 1930s. Athens and London: University of Georgia Press, 1995, 286 pp. (YC.1996.b.2784) JOSEPHSON, MATTHEW. Infidel in the Temple: A Memoir of the Nineteen-thirties. New York: Knopf, 1967, 513 pp. (X.800/5695) KAZIN, ALFRED. On Native Grounds: An Interpretation of Modern American Prose Literature. New York: Reynal & Hitchcock, 1942, 541 pp. (11865.g.19; X989/77273) KAZIN, ALFRED. Starting Out in the Thirties. London: Secker & Warburg, 1966, 166 pp. (X.809/2207) KAZIN, ALFRED. A Walker in the City. London: Gollancz, 1952, 159 pp. (10890.aaa.43) LEITCH, VINCENT B. American Literary Criticism from the Thirties to the Eighties. New York: Columbia University Press, 1988, 458 pp. (DSC 88/06002) LUCCOCK, HALFORD E. American Mirror: Social, Ethical and Religious Aspects of American Literature, 1930-1940. New York: Macmillan, 1940, 300 pp. (11865.b.24) MADDEN, DAVID, ed. Proletarian Writers of the Thirties. Carbondale and Edwardsville: Southern Illinois University Press, 1968, 278 pp. (11880.b.4/78) MADDEN, DAVID, ed. Tough Guy Writers of the Thirties. Carbondale and Edwardsville: Southern Illinois University Press, 1977, 247 pp. (X.950/11244) RABINOWITZ, PAULA. Labor and Desire: Women's Revolutionary Fiction in Depression America. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1991, 222 pp. (DSC 92/02972) RAUB, PATRICIA. Yesterday's Stories: Popular Women's Novels of the Twenties and Thirties. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1994, 131 pp. (YC.1995.b.2537) 139 REYNOLDS, MICHAEL S. Hemingway: The 1930s. New York and London: Norton, 1997, 360 pp. (DSC 98/06575) SLIDE, ANTHONY, ed. They Also Wrote for the Fan Magazines: Film Articles by Literary Giants from E. E. Cummings to Eleanor Roosevelt, 1920-1939. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1992, 149 pp. (YC.1993.a.725) STEWART, JOHN L. The Burden of Time: The Fugitives and Agrarians: The Nashville Groups of the 1920's and 1930's and the Writing of John Crowe Ransom, Allen Tate and Robert Penn Warren. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1965, 551 pp. (X.900/1198) TASHJIAN, DICKRAN. William Carlos Williams and the American Scene, 1920-1940; Whitney Museum of Art, December 12, 1978-February 4, 1979. Berkeley and London: University of California Press for the Whitney Museum of American Art, 1978, 168 pp. (X.423/10932) WELLS, WALTER. Tycoons and Locusts: A Regional Look at Hollywood Fiction of the 1930s. Carbondale and Edwardsville: Southern Illinois University Press; London and Amsterdam: Feffer & Simons, 1973, 139 pp. (X.989/25222) WILSON, EDMUND. The American Earthquake: A Documentary of the Twenties and Thirties. London: W. H. Allen, 1958, 576 pp. (010409.ff.58) WILSON, EDMUND. The Shores of Light: A Literary Chronicle of the Twenties and Thirties. London: W. H. Allen, 1952, 814 pp. (11869.aa.21) WILSON, EDMUND. The Thirties: From Notebooks and Diaries of the Period. Edited by Leon Edel. London: Macmillan, 1980, 753 pp. (X.808/33396) YOUNG, JAMES O. Black Writers of the Thirties. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1973, 257 pp. (X.981/11428) P. MEDICINE AND HEALTH BACHE, LOUISE F. Health Education in an American City: An Account of a Five-year Program in Syracuse, New York. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1934, 116 pp. (7383.e.20) BEST, HARRY. Blindness and the Blind in the United States. New York: Macmillan, 1934, 714 pp. (20017.d.28) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. Vocational Rehabilitation of the Physically Disabled. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 9, 1938, 101 pp. (A.S.988) BROMBERG, WALTER. Psychiatry between the Wars, 1918-1945: A Recollection. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1982, 184 pp. (X.329/17030) 140 COLLINS, SELWYN D. and CLARK TIBBITS. Research Memorandum on Social Aspects of Health in the Depression. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1972, 192 pp. (X.529/62779) COMMITTEE ON THE COSTS OF MEDICAL CARE. Medical Care for the American People: The Final Report of the Committee on the Costs of Medical Care, Adopted October 31, 1932. Chicago: Committee on the Costs of Medical Care, 1932, 213 pp. (7383.p.1/28) FALK, I. S. Security Against Sickness: A Study of Health Insurance. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1936, 423 pp. (8234.cc.10) FALK, I. S., C. RUFUS ROREM and MARTHA D. KING. The Costs of Medical Care: A Summary of Investigations on the Economic Aspects of the Prevention and Care of Illness. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1933, 623 pp. (7383.1/27) GREY, MICHAEL R. New Deal Medicine: The Rural Health Programs of the Farm Security Administration. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1999, 238 pp. (DSC 99/19733) GROB, GERALD N. Mental Illness and American Society, 1875-1940. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1983, 428 pp. (X.322/13125) HARDEN, VICTORIA A. Inventing the NIH: Federal Biomedical Research Policy, 1887-1937. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1986, 274 pp. (YK.1987.b.4404) HARVEY, A. MCGEHEE. Science at the Bedside: Clinical Research in American Medicine, 1905-1945. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1981, 554 pp. (X.322/10489) HIRSHFIELD, DANIEL S. The Lost Reform: The Campaign for Compulsory Health Insurance in the United States from 1932 to 1943. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1970, 221 pp. (X.320/2612) JACKSON, CHARLES O. Food and Drug Legislation in the New Deal. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1970, 249 pp. (X.200/3805) JONES, JAMES H. Bad Blood: The Tuskegee Syphilis Experiment. New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan, 1981, 272 pp. (YC.1994.b.2234); New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan International, 1993, 297 pp. (YC.1994.b.2234) KINGSBURY, JOHN A. Health in Handcuffs. New York: Modern Age Books, 1939, 210 pp. (7382.p.33) LEVEN, MAURICE. The Incomes of Physicians: An Economic and Statistical Analysis. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 135 pp. (7383.p.1/24) 141 MUSTARD, HARRY S. Rural Health Insurance. New York: Commonwealth Fund, 1936, 601 pp. (7391.r.10) REED, LOUIS S. The Ability to Pay for Medical Care. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1933, 107 pp. (7383.p.1/25) RORTY, JAMES. American Medicine Mobilizes. New York: Norton, 1939, 358 pp. (Mic.A.12235) SYDENSTRICKER, EDGAR. Health and Environment. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 217 pp. (X.800/1629.(9.)) WEISKOTTEN, HERMAN G., et al. Medical Education in the United States, 19341939. Chicago: American Medical Association, 1940, 259 pp. (7680.dd.27) WILLEFORD, MARY BRISTOW. Income and Health in Remote Rural Areas: A Study of 400 Families in Leslie County, Kentucky. New York: Columbia University, 1932, 88 pp. (08285.h.27) WINTERS, JET C. A Report on the Health and Nutrition of Mexicans Living in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1931, 99 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) Q. MUSIC ARMSTRONG, LOUIS. Swing That Music. London: Longmans, Green, 1937, 144 pp. (7900.d.27) BARLOW, WILLIAM and CHERYL FINLEY. From Swing to Soul: An Illustrated History of African American Popular Music from 1930 to 1960. Washington, D.C.: Elliott & Clark, 1994, 132 pp. (LB.31.b.10728) BINDAS, KENNETH J. All of This Music Belongs to the Nation: The WPA's Federal Music Project and American Society. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1995, 164 pp. (YA.1997.b.2549) BOURGEOIS, ANNA S. Blueswomen: Profiles of 37 Early Performers, with an Anthology of Lyrics, 1920-1945. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1996, 176 pp. (YC.1996.a.4060) CASSIDY, DONNA. Painting the Musical City: Jazz and Cultural Identity in American Art, 1910-1940. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1997, 200 pp. (YC.1997.b.5971) COPLAND, AARON. Our New Music: Leading Composers in Europe and America. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1941, 305 pp. (7891.bb.5); New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1947, 305 pp. (7900.b.3) CROWTHER, BRUCE and MIKE PINFOLD. The Big Band Years. Newton Abbot: David & Charles, 1988, 208 pp. (YM.1988.b.562) 142 CUNEY-HARE, MAUD. Negro Musicians and Their Music. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1936, 439 pp. (07899.df.71) DENISOFF, R. SERGE. Great Day Coming: Folk Music and the American Left. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1971, 219 pp. (X.431/1240) DEVEAUX, SCOTT. The Birth of Bebop: A Social and Musical History. Berkeley, Calif., and London: University of California Press, 1997, 572 pp. (YC.1998.b.179) DRIGGS, FRANK and HARRIS LEWINE. Black Beauty, White Heat: A Pictorial History of Classic Jazz, 1920-1950. New York: Da Capo, 1995, 360 pp. (YA.1998.b.6572) ERENBERG, LEWIS A. Swingin' the Dream: Big Band Jazz and the Rebirth of American Culture. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1998, 320 pp. (YC.1998.b.2831) FORTE, ALLEN. The American Popular Ballad of the Golden Era, 1924-1950. Princeton, N.J., and Chichester: Princeton University Press, 1995, 366 pp. (YC.1996.b.6335) LIEBERMAN, ROBBIE. My Song Is My Weapon: People's Songs, American Communism and the Politics of Culture, 1930-1950. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1989, 201 pp. (YA.1994.b.3000) LYTTELTON, HUMPHREY. Enter the Giants. London: Robson, 1981, 239 pp. (X.439/11668); London: Urwin, 1984, 239 pp. (X.439/13095) MANCUSO, CHUCK. Popular Music and the Underground: Foundations of Jazz, Blues, Country and Rock, 1900-1950. Dubuque: Kendall/Hunt Pub. Co., 1996, 626 pp. (YA.1997.b.6158) MASON, DANIEL G. Tune In, America: A Study of Our Coming Musical Independence. New York: Knopf, 1931, 205 pp. (7899.ppp.21) RIJN, GUIDO VAN. Roosevelt's Blues: African-American Blues and Gospel Songs on FDR. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1997, 292 pp. (YC.1999.b.1651) SCANLAN, TOM. The Joy of Jazz: Swing Era, 1935-1947. Golden, Colo.: Fulcrum Pub., 1996, 148 pp. (YA.1997.a.15769) SCHULLER, GUNTHER. The Swing Era: The Development of Jazz, 1930-1945. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1989, 919 pp. (YC.1993.b.1788; YM.1990.b.107) SCHWARTZ, CHARLES. Cole Porter: A Biography. London: W. H. Allen, 1978, 365 pp. (X.431/10493) 143 SCHWARTZ, CHARLES. Gershwin: His Life and Music. New York: Da Capo, 1979, 427 pp. (X.439/11615) SHAW, ARNOLD. Let's Dance: Popular Music in the 1930s. Edited by Bill Willard. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1998, 241 pp. (HUS.789.300973) SIMON, GEORGE T. The Big Bands. Rev. ed., New York: Macmillan; London: Collier Macmillan, 1974, 584 pp. (X.431/2139); 4th ed., New York: Shirmer; London: Collier Macmillan, 1981, 614 pp. (X.439/11888; X.439/11889) STEWART, REX. Jazz Masters of the Thirties. New York: Da Capo, 1985, 223 pp. (YM.1987.a.192) STOWE, DAVID W. Swing Changes: Big-Band Jazz in New Deal America. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1994, 299 pp. (YC.1994.b.7150) TAWA, NICHOLAS E. Serenading the Reluctant Eagle: American Musical Life, 19251945. New York: Schirmer Books, 1984, 261 pp. (YM.1989.b.577) ZANZIG, AUGUSTUS D. Music in American Life, Present and Future. London: Oxford University Press, 1932, 560 pp. (7895.t.23) R. PHOTOGRAPHY ABBOTT, BERENICE. Berenice Abbott: The 20's and the 30's: A Traveling Exhibit. Washington, D.C.: published for the National Museum of American Art by Smithsonian Institution Press, 1982, 22 pp. (X.421/25592) ABBOTT, BERENICE. Documentary Photographs of the 1930s: An Exhibition. Cleveland, Ohio: New Gallery of Contemporary Art, 1980, 64 pp. (DSC 81/11506) AGEE, JAMES R. and WALKER EVANS. Let Us Now Praise Famous Men. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1960, 471 pp. (10153.ff.26); London: Peter Owen, 1965, 471 pp. (X.800/789); London: Panther Books, 1969, 428 pp. (X.808/6149) ALSBERG, HENRY G., ed. America Fights the Depression: A Photographic Record of the Civil Works Administration. New York: Coward-McCann, 1934, 160 pp. (Mic.A.12253) AMERICAN PHOTOGRAPHERS OF THE DEPRESSION: FARM SECURITY ADMINISTRATION PHOTOGRAPHS, 1935-1942. London: Thames and Hudson, 1991, 91 pp. (YC.1991.a.4326) ANDERSON, SHERWOOD. Home Town. . . Photographs by Farm Security Photographers. New York: Alliance Book Corp., 1940, 145 pp. (10107.i.41) BLACK, PATTI CARR, ed. Documentary Portrait of Mississippi: The Thirties. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1982, 128 pp. (X.809/57759) 144 BÖGER, ASTRID. Documenting Lives: James Agee's and Walker Evans's Let Us Now Praise Famous Men. Frankfurt am Main: Lang, 1994, 173 pp. (YA.1996.a.3704) CALDWELL, ERSKINE and MARGARET BOURKE-WHITE. You Have Seen Their Faces. New York: Viking, 1937, 190 pp. (X.802/218); Athens and London: University of Georgia Press, 1995, 190 pp. (YK.1995.b.14919) CARLEBACH, MICHAEL L. and EUGENE F. PROVENZO, JR. Farm Security Administration Photographs of Florida. Gainesville: University Press of Florida, 1993, 127 pp. (YK.1996.b.1718) COOKMAN, CLAUDE. The People's America: Farm Security Administration Photographs, 1935-1943, Selections from the Henry Holmes Smith Archive. Bloomington, Ind.: Indiana University Art Museum, 1997, 32 pp. (YA.1998.a.1150) CURTIS, JAMES C. Mind's Eye, Mind's Truth: FSA Photography Reconsidered. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1989, 139 pp. (DSC q90/04579) DANIEL, PETE, et al. Official Images: New Deal Photography. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1987, 196 pp. (DSC 89/02039) DIXON, PENELOPE. Photographers of the Farm Security Administration: An Annotated Bibliography, 1930-1980. New York: Garland, 1983, 265 pp. (DSC 4072.28 vol 373) EVANS, WALKER. American Photographs. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1938, 198 pp. (Mic.A.9994); 50th anniversary ed., New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1988, 205 pp. (DSC 89/07646) EVANS, WALKER. Walker Evans. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1971, 189 pp. (X.421/24859); New York: Museum of Modern Art; London: Secker and Warburg, 1972, 191 pp. (X.421/4332) EVANS, WALKER. Walker Evans, America. Edited by Michael Brix and Birgit Mayer. New York: Rizzoli, 1991, 160 pp. (DSC q91/23471) EVANS, WALKER. Walker Evans at Work: 745 Photographs together with Documents selected from Letters, Memoranda, Interviews, Notes. New York and London: Harper and Row, 1982, 239 pp. (X.421/24063); London: Thames and Hudson, 1983, 244 pp. (X.421/24304) EVANS, WALKER. Walker Evans: Photographs for the Farm Security Administration, 1935-1938: A Catalog of Photographic Prints Available from the Farm Security Administration Collection in the Library of Congress. New York: Da Capo, 1975, 244 pp. (X.410/10238) 145 FLEISCHHAUER, CARL and BEVERLY W. BRANNAN, eds. Documenting America, 1935-1943. Berkeley: University of California Press in association with the Library of Congress, 1988, 361 pp. (YA.1992.b.2623) GUTMANN, JOHN. The Restless Decade: John Gutmann's Photographs of the Thirties. Edited by Lew Thomas. New York: Abrams, 1984, 154 pp. (DSC 84/17206) HORAN, JAMES D. The Desperate Years: A Pictorial History of the Thirties. New York: Bonanza Books, 1962, 288 pp. (X.702/252) HURLEY, F. JACK. Portrait of a Decade: Roy Stryker and the Development of Documentary Photography in the Thirties. New York: Da Capo, 1977, 196 pp. (X.415/5326) JOHNSON, BROOKS. Mountaineers to Main Street: The Old Dominion As Seen Through Farm Security Administration Photographs. Norfolk, Va.: Chrysler Museum, 1985, 165 pp. (DSC 85/23058) KEARNS, JERRY and LEROY BELLAMY, comps. The Years of Bitterness and Pride: Farm Security Administration, FSA Photographs, 1935-1943. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1975, 85 pp. (Cup.1281/434) KOBAL, JOHN. Art of the Great Hollywood Portrait Photographers, 1925-1940. London: Allen and Lane, 1980, 291 pp. (DSC F81/0469) LANGE, DOROTHEA. Dorothea Lange: Photographs of a Lifetime. Millerton, N.Y.: Aperture, 1982, 183 pp. (L.42/2063) LANGE, DOROTHEA and PAUL S. TAYLOR. An American Exodus: A Record of Human Erosion in the Thirties. New Haven, Conn., and London: published for the Oakland Museum by Yale University Press, 1969, 145 pp. (Cup.24.e.40) MACLEISH, ARCHIBALD. Land of the Free. London: Boriswood, 1938, 93 pp. (010410.b.8); New York: Da Capo, 1977, 93 pp. (X.419/34833) MELTZER, MILTON. Dorothea Lange: A Photographer's Life. New York: Farrar, Straus, Giroux, 1978, 399 pp. (X.421/11179) MYDANS, CARL, THEODOR JUNG, JOHN VACHON, ARTHUR ROTHSTEIN, BEN SHAHN, RUSSELL LEE, and MARION POST WOLCOTT. Ohio: A Photographic Portrait, 1935-1941: Farm Security Administration Photographs. Akron, Ohio: Akron Art Institute, 1980, 96 pp. (L.49/3209) NATANSON, NICHOLAS. The Black Image in the New Deal: The Politics of FSA Photography. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1992, 305 pp. (YA.1994.b.5958) OHRN, KARIN B. Dorothea Lange and the Documentary Tradition. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1980, 277 pp. (X.421/20942) 146 O'NEAL, HANK. Berenice Abbott: American Photographer. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1982, 255 pp. (LB.31.c.2003) O'NEAL, HANK, ed. A Vision Shared: A Classic Portrait of America and Its People, 1935-1943. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1976, 309 pp. (L.R.425/197) PARTRIDGE, ELIZABETH, ed. Dorothea Lange: A Visual Life. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1994, 168 pp. (YC.1996.b.354) PUCKETT, JOHN R. Five Photo-documentaries from the Great Depression. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research, 1984, 169 pp. (X.421/27164) REID, ROBERT L., ed. Back Home Again: Indiana in the Farm Security Administration Photographs, 1935-1943. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1987, 144 pp. (LB.31.a.2321) REID, ROBERT L. Picturing Texas: The FSA-OWI Photographers in the Lone Star State, 1936-1943. Austin, Tex.: Texas State Historical Association, 1994, 208 pp. (LB.37.b.581) ROGERS, AGNES and FREDERICK LEWIS ALLEN. Metropolis: An American City in Photographs. New York and London: Harper, 1934, 217 pp. (10410.y.12) ROSENHEIM, JEFF. Walker Evans and Jane Ninas in New Orleans, 1935-1936. New Orleans, La.: Historic New Orleans Collection, 1991, 24 pp. (DSC q94/24657) ROTHSTEIN, ARTHUR. The American West in the Thirties: 122 Photographs. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1981, 121 pp. (L.42/1431) ROTHSTEIN, ARTHUR. Arthur Rothstein's America in Photographs, 1930-1980. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1984, 89 pp. (LB.31.b.425) ROTHSTEIN, ARTHUR. The Depression Years as Photographed by Arthur Rothstein. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1978, 119 pp. (X.415/5569) SAROYAN, WILLIAM and ARTHUR ROTHSTEIN. Look at Us. New York: Cowles Education Corp., 1967, 202 pp. (X.800/4919) SHAHN, BEN. The Photographic Eye of Ben Shahn. Edited by Davis Pratt. Cambridge, Mass., and London: Harvard University Press, 1975, 147 pp. (Cup.1281/194) STOTT, WILLIAM. Documentary Expression and Thirties America. London: Oxford University Press, 1976, 361 pp. (X.908/40816); New York: Oxford University Press, 1973, 361 pp. (X.800/9111) 147 STRYKER, ROY E. and NANCY WOOD, comps. In This Proud Land: America, 1935-1943, as seen in the F.S.A. Photographs. London: Secker and Warburg, 1974, 191 pp. (X.805/290) WEIGLE, MARTA, ed. New Mexicans in Cameo and Camera: New Deal Documentation of Twentieth-Century Lives. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1985, 228 pp. (YA.1988.b.6357) WEIGLE, MARTA, ed. Women of New Mexico: Depression Era Images. Santa Fe, N.M.: Ancient City Press, 1993, 129 pp. (YA.1995.b.4972) WELTY, EUDORA. One Time, One Place: Mississippi in the Depression: A Snapshot Album. New York: Random House, 1971, 111 pp. (X.809/18330) WILLIS, DEBORAH and JANE LUSAKA, eds. Visual Journal: Harlem and D.C. in the Thirties and Forties. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1996, 208 pp. (LB.31.b.14108) WOLCOTT, MARION P. Marion Post Wolcott: FSA Photographs. Carmel, Calif.: Friends of Photography, 1983, 48 pp. (DSC 9121.3274 no 34) YOCHELSON, BONNIE. Berenice Abbott at Work: The Making of Changing New York. New York: New Press and Museum of the City of New York, 1997, 339 pp. (DSC f99/1243) S. V.K.4. RELIGION [See also III.I.4. Government and Politics: Opposition Parties and Movements: Coughlin, Charles E.; Social History: Racial and Ethnic Groups: Jews] CARTER, PAUL A. The Decline and Revival of the Social Gospel: Social and Political Liberalism in American Protestant Churches, 1920-1940. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1956, 265 pp. (4745.1.14) DESAULNIERS, LAWRENCE B. The Response in American Catholic Periodicals to the Crises of the Great Depression, 1930-1935. Lanham, Md., and London: University Press of American, 1984, 187 pp. (X.950/37174) DOUGLASS, H. PAUL and EDMUND DE S. BRUNNER. The Protestant Church as a Social Institution. New York and London: New York Institute of Social and Religious Research, 1935, 368 pp. (4183.e.63) HALSEY, WILLIAM M. The Survival of American Innocence: Catholicism in an Era of Disillusionment, 1920-1940. Notre Dame, Ind., and London: University of Notre Dame Press, 1980, 230 pp. (X.981/22426) JOHNSON, FREDERICK E. The Social Gospel Re-examined. New York and London: Harper, 1940, 261 pp. (04373.df.55); London: J. Clarke, 1942, 261 pp. (4381.aaa.8) 148 KINCHELOE, SAMUEL C. Research Memorandum on Religion in the Depression. Reprint, New York: Arno, 1972, 158 pp. (X.200/43785) FLYNN, GEORGE Q. American Catholics and the Roosevelt Presidency, 1932-1936. Lexington: University of Kentucky Press, 1968, 272 pp. (X.200/4204) FLYNN, GEORGE Q. Roosevelt and Romanism: Catholics and American Diplomacy, 1937-1945. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 268 pp. (X.809/42032) KANAWADA, LEO V. Franklin D. Roosevelt's Diplomacy and American Catholics, Italians and Jews. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research; Epping: Bowker, 1982, 184 pp. (X.800/35588) MEYER, DONALD B. The Protestant Search for Political Realism, 1919-1941. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1960, 482 pp. (4633.i.41) NAWYN, WILLIAM E. American Protestantism's Response to Germany's Jews and Refugees, 1933-1941. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research, 1981, 330 pp. (X.200/37416) O'BRIEN, DAVID J. American Catholics and Social Reform: The New Deal Years. New York: Oxford University Press, 1968, 287 pp. (X.100/7489) RIBUFFO, LEO P. The Old Christian Right: The Protestant Far Right from the Great Depression to the Cold War. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1983, 369 pp. (YA.1987.b.2587) ROSS, ROBERT W. So It Was True: The American Protestant Press and the Nazi Persecution of the Jews. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1980, 374 pp. (X.800/33555) SEATON, DOUGLAS P. Catholics and Radicals: The Association of Catholic Trade Unionists and the American Labor Movement, from Depression to Cold War. Lewisburg, Pa.: Bucknell University Press, 1981, 269 pp. (DSC 81/19791) SWIFT, ARTHUR L. Religion Today: A Challenging Enigma. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1933, 300 pp. (4370.eee.13) WATTS, JILL. God, Harlem U.S.A.: The Father Divine Story. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1992, 249 pp. (YC.1992.b.5653; YC.1995.a.2958) WEISBROT, ROBERT. Father Divine and the Struggle for Racial Equality. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1983, 241 pp. (DSC 83/17080) T. SCIENCE 149 HEWLETT, RICHARD G. and OSCAR E. ANDERSON. A History of the United States Atomic Energy Commission. Vol. 1, The New World, 1939-1946. University Park: Pennsylvania State University Press, 1962, 766 pp. (X.0611/118) KUZNICK, PETER J. Beyond the Laboratory: Scientists as Political Activists in 1930s America. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1987, 363 pp. (YK.1988.b.3806) LEDERER, SUSAN E. Subjected to Science: Human Experimentation in America before the Second World War. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1995, 192 pp. (YC.1995.b.3191) PANDORA, KATHERINE. Rebels within the Ranks: Psychologists' Critique of Scientific Authority and Democratic Realities in New Deal America. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1997, 260 pp. (YC.1998.b.1269) REINGOLD, NATHAN and IDA H. REINGOLD, eds.. Science in America: A Documentary History, 1900-1939. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1981, 490 pp. (X.622/12509) ROBEY, RONALD C. The America Ideology of National Science, 1919-1930. Pittsburgh, Pa.: University of Pittsburgh Press, 1971, 263 pp. (X.620/2447) WENDT, GERALD. Science for the World of Tomorrow. New York: Norton, 1939, 316 pp. (8713.aa.6) U. TECHNOLOGY AND TECHNOCRACY AKIN, WILLIAM E. Technocracy and the American Dream: The Technocrat Movement, 1900-1941. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1977, 227 pp. (X.529/31616) BENT, SILAS. Slaves by the Billion: The Story of Mechanical Progress in the Home. New York and Toronto: Longmans, 1938, 244 pp. (8288.e.11) MUMFORD, LEWIS. Technics and Civilization. London: Routledge, 1934, 495 pp. (8286.c.28) RAYMOND, ALLEN. What Is Technocracy?. New York and London: McGrawHill, 1933, 180 pp. (8277.s.16) ROSEN, S. MCKEE and LAURA ROSEN. Technology and Society: The Influence of Machines in the United States. New York: Macmillan, 1941, 474 pp. (8288.ee.62) SCOTT, HOWARD. Introduction to Technocracy. New York: John Day, 1933, 61 pp. (20016.f.21; 08206.ee.21) SZOSTAK, RICK. Technological Innovation and the Great Depression. Boulder, Colo., and Oxford: Westview, 1995, 367 pp. (DSC 95/34382) 150 TOBEY, RONALD C. Technology as Freedom: The New Deal and the Electrical Modernization of the American Home. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1996, 316 pp. (YC.1997.b.4964) VII. U.S. STATES, REGIONS AND TERRITORIES A. STATES AND THE DISTRICT OF COLUMBIA 1. Alabama BOND, HORACE M. Negro Education in Alabama: A Study in Cotton and Steel. Washington, D.C.: Associated Pub., 1939, 358 pp. (08385.f.119); Tuscaloosa and London: University of Alabama Press, 1994, 383 pp. (YC.1995.a.2454) BROWN, JAMES S., JR., ed. Up Before Daylight: Life Histories from the Alabama Writers' Project, 1938-1939. University: University of Alabama Press, 1982, 261 pp. (X.520/39314) CARTER, DAN T. Scottsboro: A Tragedy of the American South. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1969, 431 pp. (X.200/4237); London: Oxford University Press, 1971, 431 pp. (X.708/7996); rev. ed., Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1979, 479 pp. (X.709/51413; YC.1998.a.5029) DAVIS, CHARLES S. The Cotton Kingdom in Alabama. Montgomery, Ala.: Alabama State Dept. of Archives and History, 1939, 233 pp. (Mic.A.8275) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Alabama: A Guide to the Deep South. New York: R. R. Smith, 1941, 442 pp. (10413.ppp.11) JONES, JAMES H. Bad Blood: The Tuskegee Syphilis Experiment. New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan, 1981, 272 pp. (YC.1994.b.2234); New York: Free Press; London: Collier Macmillan International, 1993, 297 pp. (YC.1994.b.2234) KELLEY, ROBIN D. G. Hammer and Hoe: Alabama Communists during the Great Depression. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1990, 369 pp. (YA.1993.b.8285) KINSHASA, KWANDO M. The Man from Scottsboro: Clarence Norris and the Infamous 1931 Alabama Rape Trial, in His Own Words. Jefferson, N.C., and London: McFarland, 1997, 231 pp. (YC.1997.b.5310) 2. Alaska see Territories 3. Arizona FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Arizona: A State Guide. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 530 pp. (10413.ppp.2); 151 The WPA Guide to the 1930s Arizona. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1989, 530 pp. (YC.1989.a.7170) WEISIGER, MARSHA L. Land of Plenty: Oklahomans in the Cotton Fields of Arizona, 1933-1942. Norman and London: University of Oklahoma Press, 1995, 238 pp. (YC.1997.a.1863) 4. Arkansas ALEXANDER, DONALD C. The Arkansas Plantation, 1920-1942. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1943, 118 pp. (Ac.2692.ma/18.(2.)) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Arkansas: A Guide to the State. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 447 pp. (10413.ppp.20) HALL, W. F. and MRS. W. F. HALL. Arkansas, 1836-1936: A Study of Its Growth and Characteristics in Observance of Its Centenary Year, 1936. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Senate, 1936, 48 pp. (A.S.10/4, U.S.Senate Documents, 74th Congress, 2d Session, no. 191) WHAYNE, JEANNIE M. A New Plantation South: Land, Labor and Federal Favor in Twentieth-Century Arkansas. Charlottesville and London: University Press of Virginia, 1996, 324 pp. (YC.1996.b.7321) 5. California BURKE, ROBERT E. Olson's New Deal for California. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1953, 279 pp. (8175.dd.3) CHAMBERS, CLARKE A. California Farm Organizations: A Historical Study of the Grange, the Farm Bureau and the Associated Farmers, 1929-1941. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1952, 277 pp. (10414.e.55) CROSS, IRA B. A History of the Labor Movement in California. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1935, 354 pp. (Ac.2689.g/19; X.520/9067) CROSS, WILLIAM T. Newcomers and Nomads in California. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1937, 149 pp. (08286.a.90) CROWE, MICHAEL F. Deco by the Bay: Art Deco Architecture in the San Francisco Bay Area. New York: Viking Studio Books; London: Penguin, 1995, 122 pp. (YC.1996.b.456) DANIEL, CLETUS E. Bitter Harvest: A History of California Farmworkers, 1870-1941. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1981, 348 pp. (X.800/31360) DE SAISSET ART GALLERY AND MUSEUM. New Deal Art: California. Santa Clara, Calif.: De Saisset Art Galley and Museum, 1976, 172 pp. (X.419/4345) 152 DE WITT, HOWARD. Violence in the Fields: California Filipino Farm Labor Unionization during the Great Depression. Saratoga, Calif.: Century Twenty One, 1980, 139 pp. (DSC 80/33084) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. California's State Capitol. Sacramento, Calif.: California State Printing Office, 1942, 94 pp. (A.S.C.3/42) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Los Angeles: A Guide to the City and Its Environs. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 433 pp. (10413.ppp.12) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. San Francisco: The Bay and Its Cities. New York: Hastings House, 1940, 531 pp. (10412.ppp.5) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Santa Barbara: A Guide to the Channel City and Its Environs. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 206 pp. (10413.ppp.26) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. California: A Guide to the Golden State. New York: Hastings House, 1939, 713 pp. (010410.d.25); rev. ed., New York: Hastings House, 1967, 733 pp. (X.809/10412) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Death Valley: A Guide. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1939, 75pp. (010410.a.33) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. San Diego: A California City. Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1975, 138 pp. (YA.1990.a.22548) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. The WPA Guide to the Monterey Peninsula. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1989, 207 pp. (YC.1990.a.5582) GEBHARD, DAVID and HARRIETTE VON BRETON, comps. L.A. in the Thirties, 1931-1941. Layton, Utah: Peregrine Smith, 1975, 165 pp. (X.415/3143) GREGORY, JAMES N. American Exodus: The Dust Bowl Migration and Okie Culture in California. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1989, 338 pp. (YC.1990.b.6324) HENSTELL, BRUCE. Sunshine and Wealth: Los Angeles in the Twenties and Thirties. San Francisco, Calif.: Chronicle Books, 1984, 132 pp. (LB.31.b.1353) HUNTINGTON, EMILY H. Unemployment Relief and the Unemployed in the San Francisco Bay Region, 1929-1934. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1939, 106 pp. (8288.f.17) 153 LOFTIS, ANNE. Witnesses to the Struggle: Imaging the 1930s California Labor Movement. Reno: University of Nevada Press, 1998, 239 pp. (DSC 98/24858) MCWILLIAMS, CAREY. Factories in the Field: The Story of Migratory Farm Labor in California. Boston: Little, Brown, 1939, 334 pp. (X.319/1933) MODELL, JOHN. The Economics and Politics of Racial Accommodation: The Japanese of Los Angeles, 1900-1942. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1977, 201 pp. (X.520/12488) MULLINS, WILLIAM H. The Depression and the Urban West Coast, 1929-1933: Los Angeles, San Francisco, Seattle and Portland. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1991, 176 pp. (DSC 91/11155) NEUHAUS, EUGEN. The Art of Treasure Island: First-hand Impressions of the Architecture, Sculpture, Landscape Design, Color Effects, Mural Decorations, Illuminations and Other Artistic Aspects of the Golden Gate International Exposition of 1939. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1939, 185 pp. (7959.h.57) PERRY, LOUIS B. and RICHARD S. PERRY. A History of the Los Angeles Labor Movement, 1911-1941. Berkeley and Los Angeles: University of California Press, 1963, 622 pp. (Ac.2689.hb.(12.)) PILDAS, AVE. Art Deco: Los Angeles: Photographs. New York and London: Harper and Row, 1977, 64 pp. (X.419/34590) RUÍZ, VICKI L. Cannery Women, Cannery Lives: Mexican Women, Unionization and the California Food Processing Industry, 1930-1950. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1987, 194 pp. (YA.1989.b.7702) SAVAGE, CHRISTINE E. New Deal Adobe: The Civilian Conservation Corps and the Reconstruction of Mission La Purisima, 1934-1942. Santa Barbara, Calif.: Fithian Press, 1991, 162 pp. (YA.1992.a.21027) SELVIN, DAVID F. A Terrible Anger: The 1934 Waterfront and General Strikes in San Francisco. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1996, 272 pp. (YA.1998.a.10565) SINCLAIR, UPTON B. I, Governor of California, and How I Ended Poverty: A True Story of the Future. London: T. Wernie Laurie, 1933, 63 pp. (12601.s.4) STARR, KEVIN. Endangered Dreams: The Great Depression in California. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1996, 402 pp. (YC.1997.b.1233) STEIN, WALTER J. California and the Dust Bowl Migration. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1973, 302 pp. (X.329/7027) 154 WEBER, DEVRA. Dark Sweat, White Gold: California Farm Workers, Cotton and the New Deal. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1994, 338 pp. (YC.1995.b.2581) 6. Colorado FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Colorado: A Guide to the Highest State. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 511 pp. (10413.ppp.6) WICKENS, JAMES F. Colorado in the Great Depression. New York: Garland, 1979, 448 pp. (X.529/73677) 7. Connecticut FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. History of Milford, Connecticut, 1639-1939. Bridgeport, Conn.: Braunworth, 1939, 204 pp. (10413.k.34) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Connecticut: A Guide to Its Roads, Lore, and People. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1938, 593 pp. (X.809/25676) 8. Delaware FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Delaware: A Guide to the First State. New York: Viking, 1938, 549 pp. (010410.d.16) 9. District of Columbia BABSON, ROGER W. Washington and the Depression: Including the Career of W. N. Doak. New York, London: Harper, 1932, 296 pp. (8224.ppp.38) BLAUCH, LLOYD E. and J. ORIN POWERS. Public Education in the District of Columbia. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 15, 1938, 99 pp. (A.S. 1988) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Washington: City and Capital. Washington, D.C.: Government Printing Office, 1937, 1140 pp. (10413.p.10); Washington, D.C.: A Guide to the Nation's Capital. Rev. ed., New York: Hastings House, 1968, 528 pp. (X.809/12891) GREEN, CONSTANCE M. Washington. Vol. 2, Capital City, 1879-1950. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1963, 558 pp. (100028.ppp.6/2) PARTON, MARY F. Your Washington. New York and Toronto: Longmans, 1938, 193 pp. (010410.k.7) 155 SULLIVAN, LAWRENCE. All About Washington, Including Dining in Washington: An Intimate Guide. New York: John Day, 1932, 283 pp. (X.808/8748) WILLIS, DEBORAH and JANE LUSAKA, eds. Visual Journal: Harlem and D.C. in the Thirties and Forties. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1996, 208 pp. (LB.31.b.14108) WIRZ, HANS and RICHARD STRINER. Washington Deco: Art Deco Design in the Nation's Capital. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1984, 128 pp. (DSC 85/29175) 10. Florida CARLEBACH, MICHAEL L. and EUGENE F. PROVENZO, JR. Farm Security Administration Photographs of Florida. Gainesville: University Press of Florida, 1993, 127 pp. (YK.1996.b.1718) CERWINSKE, LAURA. Tropical Deco: The Architecture and Design of Old Miami Beach. New York: Rizzoli, 1981, 95 pp. (LB.31.a.809) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. A Guide to Key West. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 122 pp. (10413.ppp.7) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Florida: A Guide to the Southernmost State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1939, 600 pp. (010410.d.17) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Seeing St. Augustine. Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1976, 73 pp. (YA.1987.a.214) KERSEY, HARRY A. The Florida Seminoles and the New Deal, 1933-1942. Boca Raton: Florida Atlantic University Press, 1989, 214 pp. (DSC 92/00078) MCDONOGH, GARY W., ed. The Florida Negro: A Federal Writers' Project Legacy. Jackson and London: University Press of Mississippi, 1993, 177 pp. (YC.1993.b.5942) MCGOVERN, JAMES R. Anatomy of a Lynching: The Killing of Claude Neal. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1982, 170 pp. (X.520/35695; YC.1993.a.773) 11. Georgia HOLMES, MICHAEL S. The New Deal in Georgia: An Administrative History. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1975, 364 pp. (X.809/41931) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Atlanta: A City of the Modern South. New York: Smith & Durell, 1942, 266 pp. (10413.ppp.29) 156 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT. WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Drums and Shadows: Survival Stories among the Georgia Coastal Negroes. Athens: University of Georgia Press, 1940, 274 pp. (010007.h.70) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Georgia: A Guide to Its Town and Countryside. Athens: University of Georgia Press, 1940, 559 pp. (010410.dd.18) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. These Are Our Lives: As Told by the People and Written by Members of the Federal Writers' Project in North Carolina, Tennessee and Georgia. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1939, 421 pp. (012643.34) RAPER, ARTHUR F. Preface to Peasantry: A Tale of Two Black Belt Counties. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1936, 423 pp. (Mic.A.17012) 12. Hawaii see Territories 13. Idaho FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Idaho: A Guide in Word and Picture. 2d ed., New York: Oxford University Press, 1950, 300 pp. (10414.de.7) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. The Idaho Encyclopedia. Caldwell, Idaho: Caxton Printers, 1938, 452 pp. (Mic.A.9213) 14. Illinois ABBOTT, EDITH. The Tenements of Chicago, 1908-1935. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1936, 505 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2; Mic.A.16974) ALLSWANG, JOHN M. The Political Behavior of Chicago's Ethnic Groups, 1918-1932. New York: Arno, 1980, 313 pp. (X.800/42013) ASBURY, HERBERT. The Underworld of Chicago: An Informal History. London: Hale, 1941, 364 pp. (6059.b.2) BILES, ROGER. Big City Boss in Depression and War: Mayor Edward J. Kelly of Chicago. De Kalb: Northern Illinois University Press, 1984, 219 pp. (YA.1987.b.4139) BRECKINRIDGE, SOPHONISBA P. The Illinois Poor Law and Its Administration. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 541 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(44.)) CAVAN, RUTH S. and KATHERINE H. RANCK. The Family and the Depression: A Study of One Hundred Chicago Families. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1938, 208 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36.(36.)) 157 CENTURY OF PROGRESS INTERNATIONAL EXPOSITION. The Official Pictures of a Century of Progress Exposition, Chicago, 1933. Chicago: Reuben H. Donnelley Corp., 1933. (7960.k.6) COHEN, LIZABETH. Making a New Deal: Industrial Workers in Chicago, 1919-1939. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1990, 526 pp. (YC.1991.b.1030); Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1992, 526 pp. (YK.1992.a.8514) FARIS, ROBERT E. LEE. Chicago Sociology, 1929-1932. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1970, 173 pp. (X.519/10975) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Illinois: A Descriptive and Historical Guide. Chicago: A. C. McClurg, 1939, 687 pp. (010410.dd.15) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Chicago and Suburbs. Reprint, Evanston, Ill.: Chicago Historical Bookworks, 1991, 263 pp. (YA.1992.a.22839) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Cairo Guide. Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1976, 62 pp. (YA.1987.a.213) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Galena Guide. Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1976, 79 pp. (YA.1987.a.287) FRAZIER, EDWARD F. The Negro Family in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1932, 294 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(12.)); Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 686 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(22.)) GLICK, FRANK Z. The Illinois Emergency Relief Commission: A Study of Administrative and Financial Aspects of Emergency Relief. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1940, 247 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(48.)) GOSNELL, HAROLD F. Machine Politics: Chicago Model. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1937, 229 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36.(35.)); 2d ed., Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1968, 247 pp. (X.708/4456) GOSNELL, HAROLD F. Negro Politicians: The Rise of Negro Politics in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1935, 404 pp. (Ac.2691.d/36(33.)); Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1967, 396 pp. (X.709/5487) HOFFMAN, DENNIS E. Scarface Al and the Crime Crusaders: Chicago's Private War against Capone. Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press, 1993, 192 pp. (YA.1996.b.706) ILLINOIS STATE MUSEUM. After the Great Crash: New Deal Art in Illinois: An Exhibition of Art from the Period 1934-1943, Produced by Artists on the Various Federal Art 158 Projects in Illinois. Springfield, Ill.: Illinois State Museum Society, 1983, 32 pp. (A.S.I50/996) NEWELL, BARBARA W. Chicago and the Labor Movement: Metropolitan Unionism in the 1930's. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1961, 288 pp. (8280.aa.28) OBLINGER, CARL D. Divided Kingdom: Work, Community, and the Mining Wars in the Central Illinois Coal Fields during the Great Depression. Springfield, Ill.: Illinois State Historical Society, 1991, 265 pp. (YA.1994.a.12499) PUTTEE, DOROTHY F. and MARY R. COLBY. The Illegitimate Child in Illinois. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1937, 250 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(38.)) RECKLESS, WALTER C. Vice in Chicago. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1933, 314 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(15.)) THRASHER, FREDERIC M. The Gang: A Study of 1,313 Gangs in Chicago. 2d rev. ed., Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1936, 605 pp. (Ac.2691.d/37.(17.)) 15. Indiana CHAMBERS, DAVID L. Indiana: A Hoosier History Based on the Mural Paintings of Thomas Hart Benton. Indianapolis, Ind.: Bobbs-Merrill, 1933, 47 pp. (10411.I.36) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Indiana: A Guide to the Hoosier State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1941, 548 pp. (010410.dd.23) REID, ROBERT L., ed. Back Home Again: Indiana in the Farm Security Administration Photographs, 1935-1943. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1987, 144 pp. (LB.31.a.2321) 16. Iowa FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Iowa: A Guide to the Hawkeye State. New York: Viking, 1938, 583 pp. (010410.d.18) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Guide to Cedar Rapids and Northeast Iowa. Cedar Rapids, Iowa: Laurence Press, 1937, 79 pp. (Mic.A.11127) 17. Kansas FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Kansas: A Guide to the Sunflower State. New York: Viking, 1939, 538 pp. (10413.ppp.1) SCHRUBEN, FRANCIS W. Kansas in Turmoil, 1930-1936. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1969, 240 pp. (X.800/6527) 159 SUGGS, GEORGE G. Union Busting in the Tri-State: The Oklahoma, Kansas and Missouri Metal Workers' Strike of 1935. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1986, 282 pp. (DSC 86/27042) 18. Kentucky FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Kentucky: A Guide to the Bluegrass State. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1939, 489 pp. (10413.m.23) HEVENER, JOHN W. Which Side Are You On? The Harlan County Coal Miners, 1931-39. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1978, 216 pp. (X.800/29882; X.800/37354) NATIONAL COMMITTEE FOR THE DEFENSE OF POLITICAL PRISONERS. Harlan Miners Speak: Report on Terrorism in the Kentucky Coal Fields. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1932, 348 pp. (Mic.A.18925) WILLEFORD, MARY BRISTOW. Income and Health in Remote Rural Areas: A Study of 400 Families in Leslie County, Kentucky. New York: Columbia University, 1932, 88 pp. (08285.h.27) 19. Long, Huey Louisiana [See also III.I.5. Government and Politics: Opposition Parties and Protest Movements: P.] FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Louisiana: A Guide to the State. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 746 pp. (10412.ppp.8); rev. ed., New York: Hastings House, 1971, 711 pp. (X.809/18404) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. New Orleans City Guide. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1938, 430 pp. (Mic.A.11498) KANE, HARNETT T. Louisiana Hayride: The American Rehearsal for Dictatorship, 1928-1940. New York: Morrow, 1941, 471 pp. (Mic.A.9498) NOGGLE, BURL. Working with History: The Historical Records Survey in Louisiana and the Nation, 1936-1942. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1981, 139 pp. (X.800/41198) ROSENHEIM, JEFF. Walker Evans and Jane Ninas in New Orleans, 1935-1936. New Orleans, La.: Historic New Orleans Collection, 1991, 24 pp. (DSC q94/24657) SINDLER, ALLAN P. Huey Long's Louisiana: State Politics, 1920-1952. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1956, 316 pp. (9617.e.21); Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1968, 316 pp. (X.709/9314) 20. Maine 160 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Maine: A Guide 'Down East'. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1937, 476 pp. (X.809/25673) 21. Maryland ARGERSINGER, JO ANN E. Toward a New Deal in Baltimore: People and Government in the Great Depression. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1988, 284 pp. (YC.1988.b.6639) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Maryland: A Guide to the Old Line State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1940, 561 pp. (010410.d.28) 22. Massachusetts FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Boston Looks Seaward: The Story of the Port, 1630-1940. Boston: Bruce Humphries, 1941, 316 pp. (08805.h.52) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Massachusetts: A Guide to Its Places and People. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1937, 675 pp. (10413.n.10) GILBOY, ELIZABETH W. Applicants for Work Relief: A Study of Massachusetts Families Under the FERA and WPA. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1940, 273 pp. (08286.dd.93) HUTHMACHER, JACOB J. Massachusetts People and Politics, 1919-1933. Cambridge, Mass.: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1959, 328 pp. (9088.ff.8) STACK, JOHN F. International Conflict in an American City: Boston's Irish, Italians and Jews, 1935-1944. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1979, 181 pp. (X.809/45962) TROUT, CHARLES H. Boston: The Great Depression and the New Deal. New York: Oxford University Press, 1977, 401 pp. (X.809/43684) 23. Michigan CLARK, ROBERT J., et al. Design in America: The Cranbrook Vision, 1925-1950. New York: Abrams, 1983, 352 pp. (DSC 84/18182) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Michigan: A Guide to the Wolverine State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1941, 682 pp. (010410.dd.20) FUJITA, KUNIKO. Black Worker's Struggles in Detroit's Auto Industry, 1935-1975. Saratoga, Calif.: Century Twenty One, 1980, 130 pp. (X.525/8724) 161 JOHNSON, CHRISTOPHER H. Maurice Sugar: Law, Labor and the Left in Detroit, 1912-1950. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1988, 334 pp. (YA.1990.b.4428) MEIER, AUGUST and ELLIOTT RUDWICK. Black Detroit and the Rise of the UAW. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 289 pp. (X.529/36379) ORTQUIST, RICHARD T. Depression Politics in Michigan, 1929-1933. New York and London: Garland, 1982, 276 pp. (YA.1986.b.3188) SUGAR, MAURICE. Ford Hunger March. Berkeley, Calif.: Meiklejohn Civil Liberties Institute, 1980. (DSC 5536.395 v 1) THOMAS, RICHARD W. Life for Us Is What We Make It: Building Black Community in Detroit, 1915-1945. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1992, 365 pp. (DSC 92/20288) VARGAS, ZARAGOSA. Proletarians of the North: A History of Mexican Industrial Workers in Detroit and the Midwest, 1917-1933. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1993, 277 pp. (YC.1994.b.5414) 24. Minnesota FAUE, ELIZABETH. Community of Suffering and Struggle: Women, Men and the Labor Movement in Minneapolis, 1915-1945. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1991, 295 pp. (YA.1992.b.4587) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Minnesota: A State Guide. New York: Viking, 1938, 523 pp. (010410.d.20) GIESKE, MILLARD L. Minnesota Farmer-Laborism: The Third-Party Alternative. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1979, 398 pp. (X.520/30230) HAYNES, JOHN E. Dubious Alliance: The Making of Minnesota's DFL Party. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1984, 264 pp. (DSC 84/22325) MAYER, GEORGE H. The Political Career of Floyd B. Olson. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1951, 329 pp. (8177.l.19) TWETON, D. JEROME. The New Deal at the Grass Roots: Programs for the People in Otter Tail County, Minnesota. St. Paul, Minn.: Minnesota Historical Society Press, 1988, 205 pp. (YA.1992.b.6858) 25. Mississippi BLACK, PATTI CARR, ed. Documentary Portrait of Mississippi: The Thirties. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1982, 128 pp. (X.809/57759) 162 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Mississippi: A Guide to the Magnolia State. New York: Viking, 1938, 545 pp. (10413.m.12); Mississippi: The WPA Guide to the Magnolia State. Jackson and London: University Press of Mississippi, 1988, 545 pp. (YC.1989.a.2954) MORGAN, CHESTER M. Redneck Liberal: Theodore G. Bilbo and the New Deal. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1985, 274 pp. (DSC 86/07544) WELTY, EUDORA. One Time, One Place: Mississippi in the Depression: A Snapshot Album. New York: Random House, 1971, 111 pp. (X.809/18330) 26. Missouri BOAN, FERN. A History of Poor Relief Legislation and Administration in Missouri. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 243 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(53.)) DORSETT, LYLE W. The Pendergast Machine. New York: Oxford University Press, 1968, 163 pp. (X.709/6593) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Missouri: A Guide to the 'Show Me' State. New York: Duell, Sloan & Pearce, 1941, 652 pp. (10413.ppp.15); The WPA Guide to 1930s Missouri. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1986, 652 pp. (YC.1988.a.11668) KIRCHNER, L. R. Triple Cross Fire! J. Edgar Hoover and the Kansas City Union Station Massacre. Kansas City, Mo.: Janlar Books, 1993, 176 pp. (YA.1997.a.13158) POPE, ROWENA M. The Hungry Years: The Story of One Family's Struggle for Survival during the Great Depression. Circle Pines, Minn.: Bold Blue Jay Publications, 1982, 169 pp. (YA.1987.a.2831) SUGGS, GEORGE G. Union Busting in the Tri-State: The Oklahoma, Kansas and Missouri Metal Workers' Strike of 1935. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1986, 282 pp. (DSC 86/27042) 27. Montana FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Montana: A State Guide Book. New York: Viking, 1939, 427 pp. (10413.m.20) 28. Nebraska FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Nebraska: A Guide to the Cornhusker State. New York: Viking, 1939, 424 pp. (010410.dd.2) 29. Nevada 163 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Nevada: A Guide to the Silver State. Portland, Ore.: Binfords & Mort, 1940, 315 pp. (10413.ppp.3) MOEHRING, EUGENE P. Resort City in the Sunbelt: Las Vegas, 1930-1970. Reno: University of Nevada Press, 1989, 329 pp. (DSC 6081.632, no. 29) STEVENS, JOSEPH E. Hoover Dam: An American Adventure. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1988, 326 pp. (YC.1989.b.1739) 30. New Hampshire FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. New Hampshire: A Guide to the Granite State. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1938, 559 pp. (X.809/25674) 31. New Jersey FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Stories of New Jersey: Its Significant Places, People and Activities. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1972, 422 pp. (X.809/16935) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. New Jersey: A Guide to Its Present and Past. New York: Viking, 1939, 735 pp. (10413.m.21); The WPA Guide to 1930's New Jersey. New Brunswick, N.J., and London: Rutgers University Press, 1989, 735 pp. (YC.1990.a.7446) GORDON, FELICE D. After Winning: The Legacy of the New Jersey Suffragists, 19201947. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1986, 262 pp. (DSC 86/15225) 32. New Mexico FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. New Mexico: A Guide to the Colorful State. New York: Hastings House, 1940, 458 pp. (010410.dd.24); The WPA Guide to 1930s New Mexico. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1989, 458 pp. (YC.1989.a.7171) FORREST, SUZANNE. The Preservation of the Village: New Mexico's Hispanics and the New Deal. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1989, 253 pp. (DSC 89/19019) MELZER, RICHARD. Madrid Revisited: Life and Labor in a New Mexico Mining Camp in the Years of the Great Depression. Santa Fe, N.M.: Lightning Tree, 1976, 63 pp. (YA.1987.b.1079) WEIGLE, MARTA, ed. New Mexicans in Cameo and Camera: New Deal Documentation of Twentieth-Century Lives. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1985, 228 pp. (YA.1988.b.6357) 164 WEIGLE, MARTA, ed. Women of New Mexico: Depression Era Images. Santa Fe, N.M.: Ancient City Press, 1993, 129 pp. (YA.1995.b.4972) 33. World's New York [See also VI.I.4. Cultural and Intellectual History: Expositions and World Fairs: New York Fair, 1939] ABBOTT, BERENICE and ELIZABETH MCCAUSLAND. New York in the Thirties. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1973, 97 pp. (Cup.1281/50) BACHE, LOUISE F. Health Education in an American City: An Account of a Five-year Program in Syracuse, New York. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, Doran, 1934, 116 pp. (7383.e.20) BALFOUR, ALAN. Rockefeller Center: Architecture as Theater. New York and London: McGraw-Hill, 1978, 248 pp. (X.421/10730) BAYOR, RONALD H. Neighbors in Conflict: The Irish, Germans, Jews and Italians of New York City, 1929-1941. 2d ed., Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1988, 232 pp. (DSC 88/11202) BEATON, CECIL W. H. Cecil Beaton's New York. London: Batsford, 1938, 261 pp. (010410.b.13) BLETTER, ROSEMARIE H., et al. Remembering the Future: The New York World's Fair from 1939-1964. New York: Rizzoli, 1989, 208 pp. (DSC q90/00622) BLOCK, ALAN A. East Side-West Side: Organizing Crime in New York, 1930-1950. Cardiff: University College Cardiff Press, 1980, 265 pp. (X.529/48372) BREMER, WILLIAM W. Depression Winters: New York Social Workers and the New Deal. Philadelphia: Temple University Press, 1984, 231 pp. (YA.1989.a.18254) CROUSE, JOAN M. The Homeless Transient in the Great Depression: New York State, 1929-1941. Albany: State University of New York Press, 1986, 319 pp. (YC.1987.b.4429) DAVIS, KENNETH S. FDR: The New York Years, 1928-1933. New York: Random House, 1985, 512 pp. (DSC 86/03601) FAY, EDGAR R. Londoner's New York. London: Methuen, 1936, 235 pp. (010409.ee.59) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. New York: A Guide to the Empire State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1940, 782 pp. (010410.dd.11) 165 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. New York City Guide. New York: Random House, 1939, 708 pp. (010410.d.27); London: Constable, 1939, 708 pp. (10413.m.9) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. The Berkshire Hills. New York and London: Funk & Wagnalls, 1939, 368 pp. (10413.n.9) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. New York Panorama: A Comprehensive View of the Metropolis. London: Constable, 1939, 526 pp. (010410.k.18) FORD, JAMES. Slums and Housing, with Special Reference to New York City: History, Conditions, Policy. 2 vols. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1936, 1033 pp. (8287.d.11) FRANKLIN, CHARLES L. The Negro Labor Unionist of New York: Problems and Conditions among Negroes in the Labor Unions in Manhattan, with Special Reference to the N.R.A. and post-N.R.A. Situations. New York: Columbia University Press, 1936, 417 pp. (08285.h.51); reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1968, 415 pp. (Ac.2688/2.(420.)) FREEMAN, JOSHUA B. In Transit: The Transport Workers Union in New York City, 1933-1936. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1989, 434pp. (YH.1990.b.507) GARRETT, CHARLES. The La Guardia Years: Machine and Reform Politics in New York City. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1961, 423 pp. (X.709/799) GOLDMAN, E. S., ed. The New York Story: A History Of The New York Clothing Industry, 1924-1949. New York: New York Clothing Manufacturers' Exchange, 1949, 88 pp. (Mic.A.16778) GRAY, BRENDA C. Black Female Domestics during the Depression in New York City, 1930-1940. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 200 pp. (YC.1993.b.6369) GREENBERG, CHERYL L. Or Does It Explode? Black Harlem in the Great Depression. New York: Oxford University Press, 1991, 317 pp. (YC.1992.b.4986) HILLIS, MARJORIE. New York, Fair or No Fair: A Guide for the Woman Vacationist. Indianapolis, Ind., and New York: Bobbs-Merrill, 1939, 206 pp. (010410.g.56) HIMELSTEIN, MORGAN Y. Drama Was a Weapon: The Left-Wing Theatre in New York, 1929-1941. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1963, 300 pp. (X.909/8350) HINE, LEWIS W. The Empire State Building. New York and London: Prestel, 1998, 103 pp. (LB.31.c.9612) 166 INGALLS, ROBERT P. Herbert H. Lehman and New York's Little New Deal. New York: New York University Press, 1975, 287 pp. (X.802/11014) KARP, WALTER. The Center: A History and Guide to Rockefeller Center. New York: American Heritage, 1982, 128 pp. (X.805/4755) KESSNER, THOMAS. Fiorello H. La Guardia and the Making of Modern New York. New York: McGraw-Hill, 1989, 700 pp. (DSC 90/07258) KLIGER, HANNAH, ed. Jewish Hometown Associations and Family Circles in New York: The WPA Jewish Writers' Group Study. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1992, 164 pp. (DSC 99/12690) KWONG, PETER. Chinatown, New York: Labor and Politics, 1930-1950. New York and London: Monthly Review Press, 1979, 178 pp. (X.809/45531) MCKAY, CLAUDE. Harlem: Negro Metropolis. New York: Dutton, 1940, 262 pp. (010410.f.56) MANN, ARTHUR. La Guardia: A Fighter Against His Times, 1882-1933. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1969, 384 pp. (X.0709/252.(1.)) MANN, ARTHUR. La Guardia Comes to Power: 1933. Philadelphia: Lippincott, 1965, 199 pp. (X.809/4844); Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1969, 199 pp. (X.0709/252.(2.)) MESSLER, NORBERT. The Art Deco Skyscraper in New York. Frankfurt am Main: Lang, 1983, 232 pp. (X.429/16572) MILLETT, JOHN D. The Works Progress Administration in New York City. Chicago: Public Administration Service, 1938, 228 pp. (Ac.2286.b) NAISON, MARK. Communists in Harlem during the Depression. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1983, 355 pp. (X.800/40619) RADOMSKI, ALEXANDER L. Work Relief in New York State, 1931-1935. Morningside Heights, N.Y.: King's Crown Press, 1947, 332 pp. (Mic.A.12367) ROGERS, AGNES and FREDERICK LEWIS ALLEN. Metropolis: An American City in Photographs. New York and London: Harper, 1934, 217 pp. (10410.y.12) SÁNCHEZ KORROL, VIRGINIA E. From Colonia to Community: The History of Puerto Ricans in New York City, 1917-1948. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1983, 242 pp. (X.809/67188); Berkeley and London: University of California, 1994, 275 pp. (YC.1995.a.791) SCHNEIDER, DAVID M. and ALBERT DEUTSCH. The History of Public Welfare in New York State, 1867-1940. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 410 pp. (Ac.2691.dg/2.(51.)) 167 SHULMAN, HARRY M. Slums of New York. New York: Albert & Charles Boni, 1938, 394 pp. (8288.f.31) STERN, ROBERT A. M., GREGORY F. GILMARTIN and THOMAS MELLINS. New York 1930: Architecture and Urbanism between the Two Wars. New York: Rizzoli, 1987, 847 pp. (DSC 87/12958) TAURANAC, JOHN. The Empire State Building: The Making of a Landmark. New York: St. Martin's Griffin, 1997, 383 pp. (YA.1997.b.6808) WAPLES, DOUGLAS and LEON CARNOVSKY. Libraries and Readers in the State of New York: The State's Administration of Public and School Libraries with Reference to the Educational Values of Library Services. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1939, 160 pp. (Ac.2691.dia/2.(13.)) WATTS, JILL. God, Harlem U.S.A.: The Father Divine Story. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1992, 249 pp. (YC.1992.b.5653; YC.1995.a.2958) WENGER, BETH S. New York Jews and the Great Depression: Uncertain Promise. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1996, 269 pp. (YC.1997.b.844) WILLIS, DEBORAH and JANE LUSAKA, eds. Visual Journal: Harlem and D.C. in the Thirties and Forties. Washington, D.C., and London: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1996, 208 pp. (LB.31.b.14108) YOCHELSON, BONNIE. Berenice Abbott at Work: The Making of Changing New York. New York: New Press and Museum of the City of New York, 1997, 339 pp. (DSC f99/1243) 34. North Carolina ABRAMS, DOUGLAS C. Conservative Constraints: North Carolina and the New Deal. Jackson.: University Press of Mississippi, 1992, 285 pp. (YC.1993.b.4186) BADGER, Anthony. J. North Carolina and the New Deal. Raleigh, N.C.: North Carolina Dept. of Cultural Resources, Division of Archives and History, 1981, 102 pp. (DSC 84/34230) BADGER, Anthony J. Prosperity Road: The New Deal, Tobacco and North Carolina. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1980, 295 pp. (X.520/36870) BELL, JOHN L. Hard Times: Beginnings of the Great Depression in North Carolina, 1929-1933. Raleigh, N.C.: North Carolina Dept. of Cultural Resources, Division of Archives and History, 1982, 87 pp. (DSC 85/09003) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. North Carolina: A Guide to the Old North State. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1939, 601 pp. (10413.ppp.19) 168 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. These Are Our Lives: As Told by the People and Written by Members of the Federal Writers' Project in North Carolina, Tennessee and Georgia. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1939, 421 pp. (012643.34) LEFFLER, HUGH T., ed. North Carolina History Told by Contemporaries. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1934, 454 pp. (010410.ee.46) MORRISON, JOSEPH L. Governor O. Max Gardner: A Power in North Carolina and New Deal Washington. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1971, 323 pp. (X.800/7507) PURYEAR, ELMER L. Democratic Party Dissension in North Carolina, 1928-1936. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1962, 251 pp. (Ac.2685.k/4) 35. North Dakota FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. North Dakota: A Guide to the Northern Prairie State. Fargo, N.D.: Knight Printing Co., 1938, 371 pp.; 2d ed., New York: Oxford University Press, 1950, 352 pp. (10414.de.9) 36. Ohio FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. The Ohio Guide. New York: Oxford University Press, 1940, 634 pp. (010410.d.29); New York: Oxford University Press, 1953, 634 pp. (10414.b.26) KORTH, PHILIP A. and MARGARET R. BEEGLE. I Remember Like Today: The Auto-Lite Strike of 1934. East Lansing: Michigan State University Press, 1988, 245 pp. (YA.1990.b.3526) MYDANS, CARL, THEODOR JUNG, JOHN VACHON, ARTHUR ROTHSTEIN, BEN SHAHN, RUSSELL LEE and MARION POST WOLCOTT. Ohio: A Photographic Portrait, 1935-1941: Farm Security Administration Photographs. Akron, Ohio: Akron Art Institute, 1980, 96 pp. (L.49/3209) 37. Oklahoma BAKER, T. LINDSAY and JULIE P. BAKER, eds. The WPA Oklahoma Slave Narratives. Norman and London: University of Oklahoma Press, 1996, 543 pp. (DSC 96/14748) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Oklahoma: A Guide to the Sooner State. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1945, 445 pp. (010410.dd.39); The WPA Guide to 1930s Oklahoma. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1986, 442 pp. (YC.1988.a.3502) 169 FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Tulsa: A Guide to the Oil Capital. Tulsa, Okla.: Mid-West Printing Co., 1938, 79 pp. (Mic.A.18219) MCGINNIS, PATRICK E. Oklahoma's Depression Radicals: Ira M. Finley and the Veterans of Industry of America. New York: Lang, 1991, 192 pp. (YA.1993.b.1828) SUGGS, GEORGE G. Union Busting in the Tri-State: The Oklahoma, Kansas and Missouri Metal Workers' Strike of 1935. Norman: University of Oklahoma Press, 1986, 282 pp. (DSC 86/27042) WEISIGER, MARSHA L. Land of Plenty: Oklahomans in the Cotton Fields of Arizona, 1933-1942. Norman and London: University of Oklahoma Press, 1995, 238 pp. (YC.1997.a.1863) 38. Oregon CORNING, HOWARD M., ed. Dictionary of Oregon History: Compiled from the Research Files of the Former Oregon Writers' Project with Much Added Material. Portland, Ore.: Binfords & Mort, 1956, 281 pp. (Mic.A.16112) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Oregon: End of the Trail. Portland, Ore.: Binfords & Mort, 1940, 549 pp. (010410.dd.19) MULLINS, WILLIAM H. The Depression and the Urban West Coast, 1929-1933: Los Angeles, San Francisco, Seattle and Portland. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1991, 176 pp. (DSC 91/11155) 39. Pennsylvania CARTER, ROBERT. Fallingwater: Frank Lloyd Wright. London: Phaidon, 1994, 60 pp. (LB.31.b.11507) COODE, THOMAS H. and JOHN F. BAUMAN. People, Poverty, and Politics: Pennsylvanians during the Great Depression. Lewisburg, Pa.: Bucknell University Press; London: Associated University Presses, 1981, 276 pp. (X.809/59903) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Pennsylvania: A Guide to the Keystone State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1940, 660 pp. (010410.dd.7) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Erie: A Guide to the City and County. Philadelphia: William Penn Association of Philadelphia, 1938, 133 pp. (10413.p.20) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Philadelphia: A Guide to the Nation's Birthplace. Philadelphia: William Penn 170 Association, 1937, 704 pp. (10413.n.12); The WPA Guide to Philadelphia. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1988, 704 pp. (DSC 89/06179) IRWIN, RICHARD. Work for a Living: The Story of the WPA in Pennsylvania. Harrisburg, Pa.: Work Projects Administration, 1943, 99 pp. (Mic.A.16746) STUART, JAMES L. Marshaling Men in Allegheny County: A Report on the Local Civil Works Administration and Work Division Activities, November 1933 to August 1934. Allegheny Co., Pa.: Emergency Relief Administration of Allegheny County, 1934, 37 pp. (8287.cc.42) 40. Rhode Island FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Rhode Island: A Guide to the Smallest State. Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1937, 500 pp. (010410.d.9) LEVINE, ERWIN L. Theodore Francis Green: The Rhode Island Years, 1906-1936. Providence, R.I.: Brown University Press, 1963, 222 pp. (X.800/1578) LEVINE, ERWIN L. Theodore Francis Green: The Washington Years, 1937-1960. Providence, R.I.: Brown University Press, 1971, 179 pp. (X.800/8613) 41. South Carolina FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. South Carolina: A Guide to the Palmetto State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1941, 514 pp. (010410.dd.12) 42. South Dakota FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. South Dakota: A Guide to the State. 2d ed., New York: Hastings House, 1952, 421 pp. (X.809/25672) 43. Tennessee BILES, ROGER. Memphis in the Great Depression. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1986, 174 pp. (DSC 88/12760) COLE, WILLIAM E. Rural Rehabilitation Services in Knox County, Tennessee, 1935: Economic and Social Effects of the Depression upon Relief Families in Knoxville, Tennessee. Knoxville: University of Tennessee, 1936, 32 pp. (8286.f.54) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Tennessee: A Guide to the State. New York: Viking, 1939, 558 pp. (010410.dd.5) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. These Are Our Lives: As Told by the People and Written by Members of the Federal Writers' 171 Project in North Carolina, Tennessee and Georgia. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1939, 421 pp. (012643.34) LEE, DAVID D. Tennessee in Turmoil: Politics in the Volunteer State, 1920-1932. Memphis, Tenn.: Memphis State University Press, 1979, 204 pp. (X.800/32229) MINTON, JOHN D. The New Deal in Tennessee, 1932-1938. New York: Garland, 1979, 351 pp. (X.809/65962) 44. Texas ALLEN, RUTH A. Chapters in the History of Organized Labor in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1941, 258 pp. (Mic.A.8328) ALLEN, RUTH A. and SAM B. BARTON. Wage Earners Meet the Depression. Austin: University of Texas, 1935, 105 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) BLACKWELDER, JULIA K. Women of the Depression: Caste and Culture in San Antonio, 1929-1939. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1984, 279 pp. (YA.1989.b.5948) CASE, HARRY L. Municipal Libraries in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1937, 89 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) COTNER, ROBERT C., et al. Texas Cities and the Great Depression. Austin, Tex.: Texas Memorial Museum, 1973, 215 pp. (X.700/25843) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Beaumont: A Guide to the City and Its Environs. Houston: Anson Jones Press, 1939, 167 pp. (010410.dd.6) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Corpus Christi: A History and Guide. Corpus Christi, Tex.: Corpus Christi Caller Times, 1942, 245 pp. (010410.dd.35) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Texas: A Guide to the Lone Star State. New York: Hastings House, 1940, 718 pp. (010410.dd.25) GARCIA, RICHARD A. Rise of the Mexican American Middle Class: San Antonio, 1929-1941. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1991, 398 pp. (YA.1992.b.4125) GREEN, GEORGE N. The Establishment in Texas Politics: The Primitive Years, 19381957. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1979, 306 pp. (X.800/28086) HALL, CHARLES E. Progress of the Negro in Texas. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Bureau of the Census, 1936, 7 pp. (A.S.67/14) 172 MENEFEEE, SELDON C. Mexican Migratory Workers of South Texas. Washington, D.C.: Work Projects Administration, 1941, 67 pp. (A.S.978/48) PATENAUDE, LIONEL V. Texans, Politics and the New Deal. New York: Garland, 1983, 237 pp. (DSC 87/10409) REID, ROBERT L. Picturing Texas: The FSA-OWI Photographers in the Lone Star State, 1936-1943. Austin, Tex.: Texas State Historical Association, 1994, 208 pp. (LB.37.b.581) WEISENBERGER, CAROL A. Dollars and Dreams: The National Youth Administration in Texas. New York: Lang, 1994, 198 pp. (DSC 7303.9990 vol 6) WHISENHUNT, DONALD W. The Depression in Texas: The Hoover Years. New York and London: Garland, 1983, 249 pp. (X.800/38929) WINTERS, JET C. A Report on the Health and Nutrition of Mexicans Living in Texas. Austin: University of Texas, 1931, 99 pp. (Ac.2685.c/5) 45. Utah FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Utah: A Guide to the State. New York: Hastings House, 1941, 595 pp. (10413.ppp.10) 46. Vermont FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. Vermont: A Guide to the Green Mountain State. 3d ed., Boston: Houghton Mifflin, 1968, 452 pp. (X.809/7819) JUDD, RICHARD M. The New Deal in Vermont: Its Impact and Aftermath. New York: Garland, 1979, 409 pp. (YA.1986.a.4383) 47. Virginia ELLISON, JOHN M. Negro Organizations and Leadership in Relation to Rural Life in Virginia. Blacksburg, Va.: Virginia Agricultural Experiment Station, 1933, 88 pp. (A.S.v.50/2) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. The Negro in Virginia. New York: Hastings House, 1940, 380 pp. (010410.dd.21) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Prince William: The Story of Its People and Its Places. Richmond, Va.: Whittet & Shepperson, 1941, 261 pp. (10413.ppp.17) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Virginia: A Guide to the Old Dominion. New York: Oxford University Press, 1940, 173 699 pp. (010410.dd.13); New York: Oxford University Press, 1953, 710 pp. (10414.b.27) HEINEMANN, RONALD L. Depression and New Deal in Virginia: The Enduring Dominion. Charlottesville: University Press of Virginia, 1983, 267 pp. (YA.1989.b.5932) JOHNSON, BROOKS. Mountaineers to Main Street: The Old Dominion As Seen Through Farm Security Administration Photographs. Norfolk, Va.: Chrysler Museum, 1985, 165 pp. (DSC 85/23058) MARTIN-PERDUE, NANCY J. and CHARLES L. PERDUE, JR., eds. Talk About Trouble: A New Deal Portrait of Virginians in the Great Depression. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1996, 493 pp. (YA.1997.b.5980) 48. Washington BLUMELL, BRUCE D. The Development of Public Assistance in the State of Washington during the Great Depression. New York and London: Garland, 1984, 490 pp. (X.520/38827) CLARK, NORMAN H. The Dry Years: Prohibition and Social Change in Washington. Seattle: University of Washington Press, 1965, 304 pp. (X.809/3621) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Washington: A Guide to the Evergreen State. Portland, Ore.: Binsfords & Mort, 1941, 687 pp. (10413.ppp.22) HILLMAN, ARTHUR. The Unemployed Citizens League of Seattle. University of Washington Publications in the Social Sciences vol. 5, no. 3. Seattle: University of Washington Press, 1934. (Ac.2692.x/8) MULLINS, WILLIAM H. The Depression and the Urban West Coast, 1929-1933: Los Angeles, San Francisco, Seattle and Portland. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1991, 176 pp. (DSC 91/11155) 49. West Virginia FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. West Virginia: A Guide to the Mountain State. New York: Oxford University Press, 1941, 559 pp. (010410.dd.22) TROTTER, JOE W. Coal, Class and Color: Blacks in Southern West Virginia, 191532. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1990, 290 pp. (YA.1993.a.17633) 50. Wisconsin FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Wisconsin: A Guide to the Badger State. New York: Duell, Sloan & Pearce, 1941, 651 pp. (10413.ppp.9) 174 FROKER, RUDOLPH K. and JOSEPH G. KNAPP. Farmers' Purchasing Associations in Wisconsin. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Farm Credit Administration, 1937, 118 pp. (A.S.929/6) GARLOCK, FRED L. Country Banking in Wisconsin during the Depression. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of Agriculture, 1941, 112 pp. (A.S.800/2) LIPMAN, JONATHAN. Frank Lloyd Wright and the Johnson Wax Buildings. London: Architectural Press, 1986, 192 pp. (YV.1987.b.1630) LORENCE, JAMES J. Gerald J. Boileau and the Progressive-Farmer-Labor Alliance: Politics of the New Deal. Columbia and London: University of Missouri Press, 1994, 324 pp. (YC.1994.b.3865) MILLER, JOHN E. Governor Philip F. La Follette, the Wisconsin Progressives and the New Deal. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1982, 229 pp. (DSC 83/01017) TROTTER, JOE W., JR. Black Milwaukee: The Making of an Industrial Proletariat, 1915-45. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1985, 302 pp. (DSC 85/12464) YOUNG, KIMBALL, JOHN LEWIS GILLIN and CALVERT L. DEDRICK. The Madison Community. University of Wisconsin Studies in the Social Sciences and History no. 21. Madison: University of Wisconsin, 1934, 229 pp. (Ac.1792/6) 51. Wyoming FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Wyoming: A Guide to Its History, Highways, and People. New York: Oxford University Press, 1941, 490 pp. (010410.dd.10) B. REGIONAL STUDIES 1. General Studies DAVIDSON, DONALD G. The Attack on Leviathan: Regionalism and Nationalism in the United States. Reprint, Gloucester, Mass.: Peter Smith, 1962, 368 pp. (X.809/2161) DORMAN, ROBERT L. Revolt of the Provinces: The Regionalist Movement in America, 1920-1945. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1993, 366 pp. (DSC 93/11652) 2. Midwest and West BONNIFIELD, PAUL M. The Dust Bowl: Men, Dirt and Depression. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1980, 232 pp. (X.800/31118) 175 DONNELLY, THOMAS C., ed. Rocky Mountain Politics. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1940, 340 pp. (X.800/42068) FEINMAN, ROBERT L. Twilight of Progressivism: The Western Republican Senators and the New Deal. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1981, 262 pp. (DSC 4672.031, v.1 99th series) HURT, R. DOUGLAS. The Dust Bowl: An Agricultural and Social History. Chicago: Nelson-Hall, 1981, 214 pp. (DSC 81/31451) LOWITT, RICHARD. The New Deal and the West. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1984, 283 pp. (YA.1988.b.6077); Norman and London: University of Oklahoma, 1993, 283 pp. (YC.1994.a.1955) MORGAN, DAN. Rising in the West: The True Story of an 'Okie' Family from the Great Depression through the Reagan Years. New York: Knopf, 1992, 532 pp. (YA.1993.b.3123) MULLINS, WILLIAM H. The Depression and the Urban West Coast, 1929-1933: Los Angeles, San Francisco, Seattle and Portland. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1991, 176 pp. (DSC 91/11155) ROTHSTEIN, ARTHUR. The American West in the Thirties: 122 Photographs. New York: Dover; London: Constable, 1981, 121 pp. (L.42/1431) SALOUTOS, THEODORE and JOHN D. HICKS. Twentieth-Century Populism: Agricultural Discontent in the Middle West, 1900-1939. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1961, 581 pp. (X.319/2219) SHINDO, CHARLES J. Dust Bowl Migrants in the American Imagination. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1997, 252 pp. (YC.1997.b.4928) VARGAS, ZARAGOSA. Proletarians of the North: A History of Mexican Industrial Workers in Detroit and the Midwest, 1917-1933. Berkeley and Oxford: University of California Press, 1993, 277 pp. (YC.1994.b.5414) WHISENHUNT, DONALD W., ed. The Depression in the Southwest. Port Washington, N.Y.: Kennikat Press, 1980, 162 pp. (DSC 80/22466) WORSTER, DONALD. Dust Bowl: The Southern Plains in the 1930s. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 277 pp. (X.800/35630); New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 277 pp. (X.800/15315) 3. South BECKER, JANE S. Selling Tradition: Appalachia and the Construction of an American Folk, 1930-1940. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1998, 331 pp. (YC.1999.b.522) 176 BECKHAM, SUE B. Depression Post Office Murals and Southern Culture: A Gentle Reconstruction. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1989, 338 pp. (DSC 89/20879) BILES, ROGER. The South and the New Deal. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1994, 205 pp. (DSC 94/06564) COBB, JAMES C. Industrialization and Southern Society, 1877-1984. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1984, 185 pp. (YC.1988.a.11787) COBB, JAMES C. and MICHAEL V. NAMORATO, eds. The New Deal and the South. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi, 1984, 173 pp. (YA.1989.a.19488) COBB, JAMES C. The Selling of the South: The Southern Crusade for Industrial Development, 1936-1980. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1982, 293 pp. (X.520/29042) DAVIS, ALLISON and JOHN DOLLARD. Children of Bondage: The Personality Development of Negro Youth in the Urban South. New York: Harper and Row, 1964, 299 pp. (X.808/189) DOLLARD, JOHN. Caste and Class in a Southern Town. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press for Institute of Human Relations, 1937, 502 pp. (20031.bb.23) DUNBAR, ANTHONY P. Against the Grain: Southern Radicals and Prophets, 19291959. Charlottesville: University Press of Virginia, 1981, 306 pp. (X.800/40793) FREIDEL, FRANK B. F.D.R. and the South. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1965, 102 pp. (X.708/3048) GLEASON, ELIZA A. The Southern Negro and the Public Library: A Study of the Government and Administration of Public Library Service to Negroes in the South. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1941, 218 pp. (Ac.2691.dia/2.(23.)) HEARD, ALEXANDER and DONALD S. STRONG. Southern Primaries and Elections, 1920-1949. Freeport, N.Y.: Books for Libraries Press, 1970, 206 pp. (YA.1992.b.2826) HERRING, HARRIET L. Southern Industry and Regional Development. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1940, 103 pp. (Mic.A.10120) HODGES, JAMES A. New Deal Labor Policy and the Southern Cotton Textile Industry, 1933-1941. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1986, 252 pp. (DSC 88/31623) HOLLEY, WILLIAM C., ELLEN WINSTON and T. J. WOOFTER. The Plantation South, 1934-1937. Washington, D.C.: Work Projects Administration, 1940, 124 pp. (A.S.978/7) 177 KIRBY, JACK TEMPLE. Rural Worlds Lost: The American South, 1920-1960. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University, 1987, 390 pp. (DSC 87/14987) KNEEBONE, JOHN T. Southern Liberal Journalists and the Issue of Race, 1920-1944. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1985, 312 pp. (DSC 86/06485) KRUEGER, THOMAS A. And Promises to Keep: The Southern Conference for Human Welfare, 1938-1948. Nashville, Tenn.: Vanderbilt University Press, 1967, 218 pp. (X.800/3881) LEMERT, BENJAMIN F. The Cotton Textile Industry of the Southern Appalachian Piedmont. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1933, 188 pp. (8231.bb.27) LISIO, DONALD J. Hoover, Blacks and Lily-Whites: A Study of Southern Strategies. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1985, 373 pp. (DSC 85/29520) MERTZ, PAUL E. New Deal Policy and Southern Rural Poverty. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1978, 279 pp. (X.520/13552) MICHIE, ALLAN A. and FRANK RHYLICH. Dixie Demagogues. New York: Vanguard Press, 1939, 298 pp. (20033.b.25) OATES, MARY J. The Role of the Cotton Textile Industry in the Economic Development of the American Southeast, 1900-1940. New York: Arno, 1975, 221 pp. (X.520/14988) O'BRIEN, MICHAEL. The Idea of the American South, 1920-1941. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1979, 273 pp. (X.800/27917) ODUM, HOWARD W. Southern Regions of the United States. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1936, 664 pp. (Mic.A.8814); reprint, New York: Agathon Press, 1969, 664 pp. (X.800/39858) ROBINSON, JOHN L. Living Hard: Southern Americans in the Great Depression. Washington, D.C.: University Press of America, 1981, 262 pp. (DSC 81/23094) SALMOND, JOHN A. A Southern Rebel: The Life and Times of Aubrey Willis Williams, 1890-1965. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1983, 337 pp. (YA.1986.b.226) SCHULMAN, BRUCE J. From Cotton Belt to Sunbelt: Federal Policy, Economic Development and the Transformation of the South, 1938-1980. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1991, 333 pp. (YC.1991.b.2994); Durham, N.C., and London: Duke University Press, 1994, 333 pp. (YC.1995.b.7479) SMITH, DOUGLAS L. The New Deal in the Urban South. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1988, 287 pp. (YC.1991.b.4258) 178 TERRILL, TOM E. and JERROLD HIRSCH, eds. Such as Us: Southern Voices of the Thirties. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1979, 302 pp. (X.800/36843) TINDALL, GEORGE B. The Emergence of the New South, 1913-1945. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press; Austin, Tex.: Littlefield Fund for Southern History of the University of Texas, 1967, 807 pp. (W.P.b.9/10) TWELVE SOUTHERNERS. I'll Take My Stand: The South and the Agrarian Tradition. New York and London: Harper, 1930, 359 pp. (010410.f.44) UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF AGRICULTURE. Economic and Social Problems and Conditions of the Southern Appalachians. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of Agriculture, 1935, 184 pp. (A.S.802/5) VANCE, RUPERT B. Human Geography of the South: A Study in Regional Resources and Human Adequacy. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Social Study Series, 1932, 596 pp. (Ac.2685.kc.(55)) VANCE, RUPERT B. and GORDON W. BLACKWELL New Farm Homes for Old: A Study of Rural Public Housing in the South. University: University of Alabama Press, 1946, 245 pp. (Mic.A.17705) WOODRUFF, NAN E. As Rare as Rain: Federal Relief in the Great Southern Drought of 1930-31. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1985, 203 pp. (DSC 86/09035) ZIEGER, HAROLD H., ed. Organized Labor in the Twentieth-Century South. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1991, 289 pp. (YA.1993.b.11674) C. TERRITORIES 1. General Studies BLAUCH, LLOYD E. Public Education in the Territories and Outlying Posssessions. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Advisory Committee on Education Staff Study no. 16, 1939, 243 pp. (A.S.988) CONN, STETSON, ROSE C. ENGELMAN and BYRON FAIRCHILD. Guarding the United States and Its Outposts. Washington, D.C.: Office of the Chief of Military History, Dept. of the Army, 1964, 593 pp. (A.S.742/14) REID, CHARLES F. Education in the Territories and Outlying Possessions of the United States. New York: Teachers College, Columbia University, 1941, 593 pp. (08385.e.128) 2. Alaska 179 ANDERSON, H. DEWEY and WALTER C. EELLS. Alaska Natives: A Study of Their Sociological and Educational Status. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1935, 472 pp. (Ac.2692.ne) CLARK, HENRY W. Alaska: The Last Frontier. New York: Grosset & Dunlap, 1939, 246 pp. (9555.pp.17) COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in Alaska. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Office of Education Bulletin no. 12, 1937, 56 pp. (A.S.202) FEDERAL WRITERS' PROJECT, WORKS PROGRESS ADMINISTRATION. A Guide to Alaska: Last American Frontier. By Merle Colby. New York: Macmillan, 1939, 427 pp. (10413.m.15) 3. Guam POMEROY, EARL S. Pacific Outpost: American Strategy in Guam and Micronesia. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1951, 198 pp. (Ac.2692.n/12.(23.)) 4. Hawaii BARBER, JOSEPH, JR. Hawaii: Our Restless Rampart. Indianapolis, Ind.: BobbsMerrill, 1941, 285 pp. (10493.ff.41) DU PUY, WILLIAM A. Hawaii and Its Race Problem. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1932, 130 pp. (A.S.190/23) HOBBS, JEAN. Hawaii: A Pageant of the Soil. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press; London: Oxford University Press, 1935, 185 pp. (10493.bb.13) SHAPIRO, HARRY L. Migration and Environment: A Study of the Physical Characteristics of the Japanese Immigrants to Hawaii and the Effects of Environment on Their Descendants. London: Oxford University Press, 1939, 594 pp. (10008.ppp.23) SHOEMAKER, JAMES H. Labor in the Territory of Hawaii. Washington, D.C.: U.S. House Doc., 76th Congress, 3d Session, no. 848, 1940, 244 pp. (A.S.10) UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR. General Information Regarding the Territory of Hawaii. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1937, 56 pp. (A.S.193/41); 1941, 56 pp. (A.S.193/57) WAKUKAWA, ERNEST K. A History of the Japanese People in Hawaii. Honolulu: Toyo Shoin, 1938, 439 pp. (YA.1987.a.9620) 5. Panama Canal Zone COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in the Panama Canal Zone. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Office of Education Bulletin no. 8, 1939, 63 pp. (A.S.202) 180 DIMOCK, MARSHALL E. Government-operated Enterprises in the Panama Canal Zone. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1934, 248 pp. (Ac.2691.d/53.(1.)) PADELFORD, NORMAN J. The Panama Canal in Peace and War. New York: Macmillan, 1942, 327 pp. (X.809/28347) 6. Philippine Islands CHURCHILL, BERNARDITA R. The Philippine Independence Missions to the United States, 1919-1934. Manila: National Historical Institute, 1983, 442 pp. (ST 310/310) COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in the Philippine Islands. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Office of Education Bulletin no. 9, 1935, 53 pp. (A.S.202) DURAN, PIO. Philippine Independence and the Far Eastern Question. Manila: Community Pub., 1935, 303 pp. (YA.1988.a.5454) FRIEND, THEODORE. Between Two Empires: The Ordeal of the Philippines, 19291946. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1965, 312 pp. (Ac.2692.md; X.700/2009) GALLEGO, MANUEL V. The Price of Philippine Independence under the TydingsMcDuffie Act. Manila: Barristers' Book Co., 1939, 732 pp. (YA.1988.b.388) KIRK, GRAYSON L. Philippine Independence: Motives, Problems and Prospects. New York: Farrar & Rinehart, 1936, 278 pp. (20032.b.18) MALCOLM, GEORGE A. The Commonwealth of the Philippines. New York and London: Appleton-Century, 1936, 511 pp. (010056.c.17) MATTHEWS, M. ALICE. Philippine Independence: Select List of Books and Articles on Independence of the Philippine Islands, Published since 1930. Washington, D.C.: Carnegie Endowment for International Peace Library, 1939, 7 pp. (YA.1990.b.8632) OSIAS, CAMILO and MAURO BARADI. The Philippine Charter of Liberty. Baltimore, Md.: French-Bray Printing Co., 1933, 225 pp. (20018.h.34) PHILIPPINE ISLANDS. Statistical Handbook of the Philippine Islands. Manila: Philippine Islands Dept. of Agriculture and Natural Resources, 1933, 187 pp. (S.T.220/20) 7. Puerto Rico ARGÜELLES, MARÍA DEL PILAR. Morality and Power: The U.S. Colonial Experience in Puerto Rico from 1898 to 1948. Lanham, Md., and London: University Press of America, 1996, 237 pp. (YC.1996.a.3487) 181 CLARK, TRUMAN R. Puerto Rico and the United States, 1917-1933. Pittsburgh, Pa.: University of Pittsburgh Press; London: Feffer and Simons, 1975, 238 pp. (X.809/40685) COOK, KATHERINE M. Public Education in Puerto Rico. Washington, D.C.: U.S Office of Education Bulletin no. 5, 1934, 52 pp. (A.S. 202) MATHEWS, THOMAS G. Puerto Rican Politics and the New Deal. Gainesville: University of Florida Press, 1960, 345 pp. (X.700/365) PUERTO RICO RECONSTRUCTION ADMINISTRATION in cooperation with THE WORK PROJECTS ADMINISTRATION. Puerto Rico: A Guide to the Island Boriquén. New York: University Society, 1940, 409 pp. (010481.cc.6; X.809/27669) RECK, DAISY. Puerto Rico and the Virgin Islands. New York and Toronto: Farrar & Rinehart, 1939, 241 pp. (010481.cc.3) SÁNCHEZ KORROL, VIRGINIA E. From Colonia to Community: The History of Puerto Ricans in New York City, 1917-1948. Westport, Conn.: Greenwood, 1983, 242 pp. (X.809/67188); Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1994, 275 pp. (YC.1995.a.791) 8. Virgin Islands BOYER, WILLIAM W. Civil Liberties in the U.S. Virgin Islands, 1917-1949. St. Croix: Antilles Graphic Arts, 1982, 184 pp. (X.529/58209) COCHRAN, HAMILTON. These Are the Virgin Islands. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1937, 236 pp. (10482.h.40) EVANS, LUTHER H. The Virgin Islands: From Naval Base to New Deal. Ann Arbor, Mich.: Edwards, 1945, 365 pp. (O8157.f.71) RECK, DAISY. Puerto Rico and the Virgin Islands. New York and Toronto: Farrar & Rinehart, 1939, 241 pp. (010481.cc.3) REID, CHARLES F., ed. Bibliography of the Virgin Islands of the United States. New York: H. W. Wilson Co., 1941, 225 pp. (11924.d.33) UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR. Annual Report of the Governor of the Virgin Islands, 1931. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1931. (A.S.227/4) UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF THE INTERIOR. General Information Regarding the Virgin Islands of the United States. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of the Interior, 1936, 43 pp. (A.S.227/5); 1939, 53 pp. (A.S.193/52) VIII. MILITARY AFFAIRS 182 ABBAZIA, PATRICK. Mr. Roosevelt's Navy: The Private War of the U.S. Atlantic Fleet, 1939-1942. Annapolis, Md.: Naval Institute Press, 1975, 520 pp. (X.800/28435) ARNOLD, HENRY H. and IRA C. EAKER. This Flying Game. New York and London: Funk & Wagnalls, 1936, 275 pp. (08770.c.44); 2d ed., New York and London: Funk & Wagnalls, 1938, 307 pp. (08771.cc.15) BLAND, LARRY I. and SHARON R. RITENOUR, eds. The Papers of George Catlett Marshall. Vol. 1, 'The Soldierly Spirit,' December 1880-June 1939. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1981. (X.0520/709(1)) BLAND, LARRY I., SHARON R. RITENOUR and CLARENCE E. WUNDERLIN, JR., eds. The Papers of George Catlett Marshall. Vol. 2, 'We Cannot Delay', July 1, 1939-December 6, 1941. Baltimore, Md., and London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1986. (X.0520/709(2)) CONN, STETSON and BYRON FAIRCHILD. The Framework of Hemispheric Defense. Washington, D.C.: Office of the Chief of Military History, Dept. of the Army, 1960, 470 pp. (A.S.742/14) CONN, STETSON, ROSE C. ENGELMAN and BYRON FAIRCHILD. Guarding the United States and Its Outposts. Washington, D.C.: Office of the Chief of Military History, Dept. of the Army, 1964, 593 pp. (A.S.742/14) COPP, DEWITT. A Few Great Captains: The Men and Events that Shaped the Development of U.S. Air Power. Garden City, N.Y.: Doubleday, 1980, 531 pp. (X.622/16425) COWMAN, IAN. Dominion or Decline: Anglo-American Naval Relations on the Pacific, 1937-1941. Oxford: Berg, 1996, 327 pp. (YC.1997.a.3278) DALFIUME, RICHARD M. Desegregation of the U.S. Armed Forces: Fighting on Two Fronts, 1939-1953. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1969, 252 pp. (X.809/10878) DAVIS, GEORGE T. A Navy Second to None: The Development of Modern American Naval Policy. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1940, 508 pp. (Ac.2692.mef.(2.)) DORWART, JEFFERY M. Conflict of Duty: The U.S. Navy's Intelligence Dilemma, 1919-1945. Annapolis, Md.: Naval Institute Press, 1983, 262 pp. (YC.1987.b.67) GRIFFITH, ROBERT K. Men Wanted for the U.S. Army: America's Experience with an All-Volunteer Army Between the World Wars. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1982, 259 pp. (X.800/35352) HARROD, FREDERICK S. Manning the New Navy: The Development of a Modern Naval Enlisted Force, 1899-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1978, 276 pp. (X.800/27650) 183 HUZAR, ELIAS. The Purse and the Sword: Control of the Army by Congress through Military Appropriations, 1933-1950. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1950, 417 pp. (8175.dd.13) JAKEMAN, ROBERT J. The Divided Skies: Establishing Segregated Flight Training at Tuskegee, Alabama, 1934-1942. Tuscaloosa and London: University of Alabama Press, 1992, 416 pp. (YC.1997.a.977) JAMES, D. CLAYTON. The Years of MacArthur. Vol. 1, 1880-1941. London: Leo Cooper, 1970. (X.0809/396) KELSEY, BENJAMIN S. The Dragon's Teeth? The Creation of United States Air Power for World War II. Washington, D.C.: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1982, 148 pp. (X.800/43223) LEUTZE, JAMES. Bargaining for Supremacy: Anglo-American Naval Collaboration, 1937-1941. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina, 1977, 328 pp. (X.800/28720) LINN, BRIAN M. Guardians of Empire: The U.S. Army and the Pacific, 1902-1940. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1997, 343 pp. (YA.1998.b.1764) MACARTHUR, DOUGLAS. Reminiscences. London: Heinemann, 1964, 438 pp. (X.631/109) MCFARLAND, KEITH D. Harry H. Woodring: A Political Biography of FDR's Controversial Secretary of War. Lawrence: University Press of Kansas, 1975, 346 pp. (X.800/28060) MAROLDA, EDWARD J., ed. FDR and the U.S. Navy. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1998, 202 pp. (DSC 98/32346) MATLOFF, MAURICE. Mr. Roosevelt's Three Wars: FDR as War Leader. Colorado Springs, Colo.: U.S. Air Force Academy, 1964, 21 pp. (A.S.1030/4) MAURER, MAURER. Aviation in the U.S. Army, 1919-1939. Washington, D.C.: Office of Air Force History, U.S. Air Force, 1987, 626 pp. (DSC OP-US/6443) MILLER, EDWARD S. War Plan Orange: The U.S. Strategy to Defeat Japan, 18971945. Annapolis, Md.: Naval Institute Press, 1991, 509 pp. (YC.1994.b.430) PARRISH, THOMAS. Roosevelt and Marshall: Partners in Politics and War. New York: Morrow, 1989, 608 pp. (DSC 89/30260) PATTON, GERALD W. War and Race: The Black Officer in the American Military, 1915-1941. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1981, 214 pp. (X.529/47051) 184 POGUE, FORREST C. George C. Marshall: Education of a General, 1880-1939. London: MacGibbon & Kee, 1964, 447 pp. (X.0631/1) POGUE, FORREST C. George C. Marshall: Ordeal and Hope, 1939-1942. London: MacGibbon & Kee, 1968, 491 pp. (X.0631/1.(2.)) RICHARDSON, JAMES O., AS TOLD TO GEORGE C. DYER, JR. On the Treadmill to Pearl Harbor: The Memoirs of Admiral James O. Richardson. Washington, D.C.: Office of Naval History, Navy Dept.,1973, 558 pp. (A.S.332/38) SIMPSON, B. MITCHELL. Admiral Harold R. Stark: Architect of Victory, 1939-1945. Columbia: University of South Carolina Press, 1989, 326 pp. (DSC 89/19023) UNDERWOOD, JEFFERY S. The Wings of Democracy: The Influence of Air Power on the Roosevelt Administration, 1933-1941. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 1991, 234 pp. (YA.1993.b.6174) VILLARD, OSWALD G. Our Military Chaos: The Truth about Defense. New York and London: Knopf, 1939, 202 pp. (8011.b.2) WATSON, MARK S. The War Department: Chief of Staff: Prewar Plans and Preparations. Washington, D.C.: Historical Division, Dept. of the Army, 1950, 551 pp. (A.S.742/1) WHEELER, GERALD E. Prelude to Pearl Harbor: The United States Navy and the Far East, 1921-1931. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1963, 212 pp. (X.631/301); Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1968, 211 pp. (X.709/24790) WILSON, JOHN R. M. Herbert Hoover and the Armed Forces: A Study of Presidential Attitudes and Policy. New York and London: Garland, 1993, 275 pp. (YC.1993.b.5264) IX. FOREIGN RELATIONS A. GENERAL STUDIES ADAMS, FREDERICK C. Economic Diplomacy: The Export-Import Bank and American Foreign Policy, 1934-1939. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1976, 289 pp. (X.520/11681) ADLER, SELIG. The Uncertain Giant: 1921-1941: American Foreign Policy Between the Wars. New York: Macmillan; London: Collier-Macmillan, 1965, 340 pp. (X.709/3051); New York: Collier Books; London: Collier-Macmillan, 1969, 340 pp. (X.708/5624) AMBROSE, STEPHEN E. Rise to Globalism: American Foreign Policy since 1938. London: Allen Lane, 1971, 352 pp. (X.800/5812); Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1973, 352 pp. (X.708/10640) 185 BARBER, WILLIAM J. Designs within Disorder: Franklin D. Roosevelt, the Economists and the Shaping of American Foreign Policy, 1933-1945. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1996, 178 pp. (YC.1997.b.200) BEARD, CHARLES A. American Foreign Policy in the Making, 1932-1940: A Study in Responsibilities. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1946, 336 pp. (9617.c.10) BECKETT, GRACE. The Reciprocal Trade Agreements Program. New York: Columbia University Press, 1941, 142 pp. (8222.bb.23) BLOOMFIELD, ARTHUR I. Capital Imports and the American Balance of Payments, 1934-39: A Study in Abnormal International Capital Transfers. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1950, 340 pp. (8230.bb.47) BUELL, RAYMOND L. The Hull Trade Program and the American System. New York: Foreign Policy Association, 1938, 48 pp. (Mic.A.12246(7)) BUTLER, MICHAEL A. Cautious Visionary: Cordell Hull and Trade Reform, 19331937. Kent, Ohio, and London: Kent State University Press, 1998, 240 pp. (DSC 98/29466) COLE, WAYNE S. Determinism and American Foreign Relations during the Franklin D. Roosevelt Era. Lanham, Md., and London: University Press of America, 1995, 110 pp. (YC.1997.a.2348) CRAIG, GORDON A. AND FELIX GILBERT, eds. The Diplomats, 1919-1939. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1953, 700 pp. (8009.1.21) CULBERT, DAVID H. News for Everyman: Radio and Foreign Affairs in Thirties America. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 238 pp. (X.809/42065) DALLEK, ROBERT. Franklin D. Roosevelt and American Foreign Policy, 1932-1945. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 657 pp. (X:809/44883); Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 657 pp. (X.808/34988); New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1979, 671 pp. (YC.1995.a.3878) DESMOND, ROBERT W. Crisis and Conflict: World News Reporting between Two Wars, 1920-1940. Iowa City: University of Iowa Press, 1982, 518 pp. (2708.e.1416) DEXTER, BYRON, ed. The Foreign Affairs Bibliography: New Evaluations of Significant Books on International Relations, 1920-1970. New York and London: published for the Council on Foreign Relations by Bowker, 1972, 936 pp. (X.800/13802) DUBOFSKY, MELVYN and STEPHEN BURWOOD, eds. American Foreign Policy in the 1930s. New York and London: Garland, 1990, 261 pp. (YC.1991.b.561) EDWARDS, JEROME E. The Foreign Policy of Colonel McCormick's Tribune, 19291941. Reno: University of Nevada Press, 1971, 232 pp. (X.981/4748) 186 FEIS, HERBERT. The Diplomacy of the Dollar: First Era, 1919-1932. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins Press, 1950, 81 pp. (Ac.2689/5) FEIS, HERBERT. 1933: Characters in Crisis. Boston, Toronto: Little, Brown, 1966, 366 pp. (X.709/6925) FERRELL, ROBERT H. American Diplomacy in the Great Depression: Hoover-Stimson Foreign Policy, 1929-1933. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1957, 319 pp. (Ac.2692.md) FLEMING, DENNA F. The United States and the World Court, 1920-1966. Rev. ed., New York: Russell & Russell, 1968, 233 pp. (X.808/6794) FLEMING, DENNA F. The United States and World Organization, 1920-1933. New York: Columbia University Press, 1938, 569 pp. (08286.k.15) FLYNN, GEORGE Q. Roosevelt and Romanism: Catholics and American Diplomacy, 1937-1945. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 268 pp. (X.809/42032) GARDNER, LLOYD C. Economic Aspects of New Deal Diplomacy. Madison: University of Wisconsin, 1964, 409 pp. (X.700/2309) HALASZ, NICHOLAS. Roosevelt Through Foreign Eyes. Princeton, N.J.: Van Nostrand, 1961, 340 pp. (10866.cc.26) HEALD, MORREL. Transatlantic Vistas: American Journalists in Europe, 1900-1940. Kent, Ohio, and London: Kent State University Press, 1988, 281 pp. (YH.1989.b.592) HIGHAM, CHARLES. Trading with the Enemy: An Exposé of the Nazi-American Money Plot, 1933-1949. London: Hale, 1983, 277 pp. (X.809/57463) HILTON, STANLEY E. Brazil and the Great Powers, 1930-1939: The Politics of Trade Rivalry. Austin and London: University of Texas Press, 1976, 304 pp. (X.800/12344; X.0700/112 (38)) HOSLEY, DAVID H. As Good as Any: Foreign Correspondence on American Radio, 1930-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1984, 165pp. (X.809/65044) JABLON, HOWARD. Crossroads of Decision: The State Department and Foreign Policy, 1933-1937. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1983, 182 pp. (X.809/60658) KANAWADA, LEO V. Franklin D. Roosevelt's Diplomacy and American Catholics, Italians and Jews. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research; Epping: Bowker, 1982, 184 pp. (X.800/35588) 187 KENNAN, GEORGE F. From Prague after Munich: Diplomatic Papers, 1938-1940. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1968, 266 pp. (X.709/7079; X.709/12668) KENNAN, GEORGE F. Memoirs, 1925-1950. London: Hutchinson, 1968, 583 pp. (X.700/2743) KENNEDY, THOMAS C. Charles A. Beard and American Foreign Policy. Gainesville: University Press of Florida, 1975, 199 pp. (X.800/28643) KOTTMAN, RICHARD N. Reciprocity and the North Atlantic Triangle, 1932-1938. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1968, 294 pp. (X.519/6146) KRENN, MICHAEL L., ed. Race and U.S. Foreign Policy from 1900 through World War II. New York and London: Garland, 1998, 354 pp. (YC.1999.b.652) LANGER, WILLIAM L. and S. EVERETT GLEASON. The Challenge to Isolation: The World Crisis of 1937-1940 and American Foreign Policy. 2 vols. New York: Harper and Row, 1964, 794 pp. (X.709/1379) LEIGH, MICHAEL. Mobilizing Consent: Public Opinion and American Foreign Policy, 1937-1947. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 187 pp. (X.809/42070) LEWIS, CLEONA. America's Stake in International Investments. Washington, D.C.: Institute of Economics, 1938, 710 pp. (Ac.2391.(13.)) LOCKWOOD, WILLIAM W. The Foreign Trade Policy of the United States. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 58 pp. (Ac.1915.b.) LOCKWOOD, WILLIAM W. Trade and Trade Rivalry between the United States and Japan. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 66 pp. (Ac.1915.b) LONG, BRECKINRIDGE. The War Diary of Breckinridge Long: Selections from the Years 1939-1944. Edited by Fred L. Israel. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1966, 410 pp. (X.700/3119) MADDEN, JOHN T., MARCUS NADLER and HARRY C. SAUVAIN. America's Experience as a Creditor Nation. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1937, 333 pp. (Mic.A.8712) MARKS, FREDERICK W., III. Wind over Sand: The Diplomacy of Franklin Roosevelt. Athens and London: University of Georgia Press, 1988, 462 pp. (YC.1988.b.8022; YC.1991.b.1271) MINNEN, CORNELIS A. VAN and JOHN F. SEARS, eds. FDR and His Contemporaries: Foreign Perceptions of an American President. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1992, 248 pp. (YC.1993.a.919) 188 MOFFAT, JAY P. The Moffat Papers: Selections from the Diplomatic Journals of Jay Pierrepont Moffat, 1919-1943. Edited by Nancy H. Hooker. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1956, 408 pp. (8178.c.5) MURESIANU, JOHN M. American Intellectuals and the World Crisis, 1938-1945. New York and London: Garland, 1988, 483 pp. (YC.1991.b.4869) MYERS, WILLIAM S. The Foreign Policies of Herbert Hoover, 1929-1933. New York and London: Scribner's, 1940, 259 pp. (08004.ee.59) NEVINS, J. ALLAN. The New Deal and World Affairs: A Chronicle of International Affairs, 1933-1945. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1950, 332 pp. (W.P.14751/56) NEVINS, J. ALLAN and LOUIS M. HACKER, eds. The United States and Its Place in World Affairs, 1918-1943. Boston: Heath, 1943, 612 pp. (9617.aa.21) NEVINS, J. ALLAN. The United States in a Chaotic World: A Chronicle of International Affairs, 1918-1933. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1950, 252 pp. (X.709/1384.(55.)) NINKOVICH, FRANK A. The Diplomacy of Ideas: U.S. Foreign Policy and Cultural Relations, 1938-1950. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1981, 253pp. (X.800/30372) NIXON, EDGAR B., ed. Franklin D. Roosevelt and Foreign Affairs, March 1933January 1937. 3 vols. Cambridge, Mass.: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1969. (X.0702/111); Donald B. Shewe, ed. Franklin D. Roosevelt and Foreign Affairs. Second series, January 1937-August 1939. Vol. 17, Index. Edited by Daryl L. Revoldt. New York and Toronto: Clearwater Pub. Co., 1983. (X.805/5362) OLSSON, CHRISTER. Congress and the Executive: The Making of United States Foreign Policy, 1933-1940. Stockholm: Esselte Studium, 1982, 209 pp. (X.0709/430(16)) OSTROWER, GARY B. Collective Insecurity: The United States and the League of Nations during the Early Thirties. Lewisburg, Pa.: Bucknell University Press; London: Associated University Presses, 1979, 287 pp. (X.809/50272; X.809/58058) PHILLIPS, WILLIAM. Ventures in Diplomacy. London: John Murray, 1955, 308 pp. (10864.df.48) PLUMMER, BRENDA G. Rising Wind: Black Americans and U.S. Foreign Affairs, 1935-1960. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1996, 423 pp. (DSC 96/19793) RANDALL, STEPHEN J. United States Foreign Oil Policy, 1919-1948: For Profits and Security. Kingston and Montreal: McGill-Queen's University Press, 1985, 328 pp. (DSC 85/17019) 189 RANGE, WILLARD. Franklin D. Roosevelt's World Order. Athens: University of Georgia Press, 1959, 219 pp. (9105.c.15) RAUCH, BASIL. Roosevelt: From Munich to Pearl Harbor: A Study in the Creation of a Foreign Policy. New York: Da Capo, 1967, 527 pp. (X.809/65584) RIGGS, A. R. and TOM VELK. Cordell Hull, The New Deal, and Inter-American Trade. Montreal: Dept. of Economics, McGill University, 1993, 17 pp. (DSC 9349.7383 2/93) ROBERTS, JOHN W. Putting Foreign Policy to Work: The Role of Organized Labor in American Foreign Relations, 1932-1941. New York: Garland, 1995, 322 pp. (DSC 95/35655) ROWLAND, BENJAMIN M. Commercial Conflict and Foreign Policy: A Study in Anglo-American Relations, 1932-1938. New York: Garland, 1987, 431 pp. (YC.1988.a.8209) STALEY, ALVAH E. Raw Materials in Peace and War. New York: Council on Foreign Relations, 1937, 326 pp. (8290.d.18) SCHATTSCHNEIDER, ELMER E. Politics, Pressures and the Tariff: A Study of Free Private Enterprise in Pressure Politics, as Shown in the 1929-1930 Revision of the Tariff. New York: Prentice-Hall, 1935, 301 pp. (20030.c.1) STEWARD, DICK. Trade and Hemisphere: The Good Neighbor Policy and Reciprocal Trade. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1975, 307 pp. (X.520/11498) TASCA, HENRY J. The Reciprocal Trade Policy of the United States: A Study in Trade Philosophy. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1938, 371 pp. (8231.f.4) TAYLOR, ALONZO E. The New Deal and Foreign Trade. New York: Macmillan, 1935, 301 pp. (8231.aa.14; 8232.b.44) WALLACE, BENJAMIN B. and LYNN R. EDMINSTER. International Control of Raw Materials. Washington, D.C.: Brookings Institution, 1930, 479 pp. (8224.aa.34) WALLACE, HENRY A. America Must Choose: The Advantages and Disadvantages of Nationalism, of World Trade and of a Planned Middle Course. New York: Foreign Policy Association; Boston: World Peace Foundation, 1934, 33 pp. (X.510/993) WILSON, HUGH R. Diplomat Between the Wars. New York and Toronto: Longmans, 1941, 344 pp. (10888.d.21; 9100.b.37) B. APPROACH TO ENTRY INTO SECOND WORLD WAR BARRON, GLORIA J. Leadership in Crisis: FDR and the Path to Intervention. New York and London: Kennikat Press, 1973, 145 pp. (X.800/8830) 190 BEARD, CHARLES A. President Roosevelt and the Coming of War, 1941: A Study in Appearances and Realities. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1948, 614 pp. (YA.1993.b.7893) DIVINE, ROBERT A. The Reluctant Belligerent: American Entry into World War II. New York: Wiley, 1965, 172 pp. (X.709/1834) HEINRICHS, WALDO H. Threshold of War: Franklin D. Roosevelt and American Entry into World War II. New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1988, 279 pp. (YH.1989.b.793; 1991.a.3256) KETCHUM, RICHARD M. The Borrowed Years, 1938-1941: America on the Way to War. New York: Random House, 1989, 896 pp. (DSC 90/07233) KINSELLA, WILLIAM E. Leadership in Isolation: FDR and the Origins of the Second World War. Boston: G. K. Hall, 1978, 282 pp. (X.800/28430) MURESIANU, JOHN M. American Intellectuals and the World Crisis, 1938-1945. New York and London: Garland, 1988, 483 pp. (YC.1991.b.4869) OFFNER, ARNOLD A., ed. The Origins of the Second World War: American Foreign Policy and World Politics, 1917-1941. New York: Praeger, 1975, 268 pp. (X.800/28522) RUPP, LEILA J. Mobilizing Women for War: German and American Propaganda, 19391945. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1978, 243 pp. (X.809/43415) RUSSETT, BRUCE M. No Clear and Present Danger: A Skeptical View of the U.S. Entry into World War II. Boulder, Colo., and Oxford: Westview, 1997, 111 pp. (YC.1998.a.533) SMITH, GEOFFREY S. To Save a Nation: American Countersubversives, the New Deal and the Coming of World War II. New York: Basic Books, 1973, 244 pp. (X.800/9320; X.800/8482) TANSILL, CHARLES C. Back Door to War: The Roosevelt Foreign Policy, 1933-1941. Chicago: Regnery, 1952, 690 pp. (8177.m.26) C. ISOLATIONISM, PACIFISM AND NEUTRALITY ADLER, SELIG. The Isolationist Impulse: Its Twentieth-Century Reaction. London and New York: Abelard-Schuman, 1957, 538 pp. (9617.1.11) BAIGELL, MATTHEW and JULIA WILLIAMS, eds. Artists Against War and Fascism: Papers of the First American Artists' Congress. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1985, 310 pp. (DSC 89/09287) 191 BRADLEY, PHILLIPS. Can We Stay out of War? New York: Norton, 1936, 288 pp. (08008.aa.54) BUELL, RAYMOND L. Isolated America. 2d ed., New York and London: Knopf, 1940, 457 pp. (9617.aa.9) CHATFIELD, CHARLES. For Peace and Justice: Pacifism in America, 1914-1941. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1971, 447 pp. (X.800/8033) COLE, WAYNE S. Roosevelt and the Isolationists, 1932-45. Lincoln: University of Nebraska Press, 1983, 698 pp. (X.800/42365) COLE, WAYNE S. Senator Gerald P. Nye and American Foreign Relations. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1963, 293 pp. (9317.i.13) CRECRAFT, EARL W. Freedom of the Seas. New York and London: AppletonCentury, 1935, 304 pp. (6836.ee.17) DAVIDSON, FRANK P. and GEORGE S. VIERECK, eds. Before America Decides: Foresight in Foreign Affairs. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1938, 318 pp. (08004.ee.10) DE CONDE, ALEXANDER, ed. Isolation and Security. Durham, N.C.: Duke University Press, 1957, 204 pp. (8178.c.20) DIVINE, ROBERT A. The Illusion of Neutrality. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1962, 370 pp. (09059.m.39) DOENECKE, JUSTUS D. Anti-intervention: A Bibliographical Introduction to Isolationism and Pacifism from World War I to the Early Cold War. New York and London: Garland, 1987, 421 pp. (YC.1992.a.1232) DRUMMOND, DONALD F. The Passing of American Neutrality, 1937-1941. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1955, 409 pp. (Ac.2685/33) DULLES, ALLEN W. and HAMILTON F. WELSH. Can America Stay Neutral? New York and London: Harper, 1939, 277 pp. (20033.ff.25) DULLES, ALLEN W. and HAMILTON F. WELSH. Can We Be Neutral? 2d ed., New York: published for the Council on Foreign Relations by Harper, 1936, 192 pp. (8177.k.37) DULLES, JOHN FOSTER. War, Peace and Change. New York and London: Harper, 1939, 170 pp. (8425.s.43); London: Macmillan, 1939, 170 pp. (8425.s.56) FENWICK, CHARLES C. American Neutrality: Trial and Failure. New York: New York University Press; London: Oxford University Press, 1940, 190 pp. (Ac.2686.ca.(8.)) 192 HOOVER, HERBERT C. Shall We Send Our Youth to War? New York: CowardMcCann, 1939, 36 pp. (8011.aa.3) JESSUP, PHILIP C. International Security: The American Role in Collective Action for Peace. New York: Council on Foreign Relations, 1935, 157 pp. (8011.c.62) JOHNSON, WALTER. The Battle Against Isolationism. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1944, 269 pp. (08176.a.52) JONAS, MANFRED. Isolationism in America, 1935-1941. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1966, 315 pp. (X.709/4266) MATTHEWS, MARY ALICE, comp. The Peace Movement: Select List of References on the Work of National and International Organizations for the Advancement of Peace, with Special Attention to the Movement in the United States. Washington, D.C.: Carnegie Endowment for International Peace Library, 1940, 67 pp. (Mic.A.10146) NELSON, JOHN K. The Peace Prophets: American Pacifist Thought, 1919-1941. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1967, 153 pp. (Ac.2685.k/4) POWASKI, RONALD E. Toward an Entangling Alliance: American Isolationism, Internationalism and Europe, 1901-1950. New York and London: Greenwood, 1991, 288 pp. (YC.1991.b.2970) SCHACHT, JOHN N., ed. Three Faces of Midwestern Isolationism: Gerald P. Nye, Robert E. Wood, John L. Lewis. Iowa City, Iowa: Center for the Study of the Recent History of the United States, 1981, 72 pp. (X.809/67229) SCHNEIDER, JAMES C. Should America Go to War? The Debate over Foreign Policy in Chicago, 1939-1941. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1989, 289 pp. (YC.1989.b.5934) SEAVEY, JAMES M. Neutrality Legislation in the United States. Washington, D.C.: J. M. Seavey, 1939, 129 pp. (Mic.A.12380) THOMAS, NORMAN M. and BERTRAM D. WOLFE. Keep America Out of War: A Program. New York: Frederick A. Stokes, 1939, 184 pp. (Mic.A.10024) VILLARD, OSWALD G. Our Military Chaos: The Truth about Defense. New York and London: Knopf, 1939, 202 pp. (8011.b.2) WILTZ, JOHN E. From Isolation to War, 1931-1941. London: Routledge & Kegan Paul, 1968, 152 pp. (X.709/7722) WRIGHT, PHILIP QUINCY, ed. Neutrality and Collective Security: Lectures on the Harris Foundation 1936. Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1936, 276 pp. (08008.aa.44) D. ARMAMENTS AND NAVAL LIMITATION 193 COULTER, MATTHEW W. The Senate Munitions Inquiry of the 1930s: Beyond the Merchants of Death. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1977, 182 pp. (YC.1998.b.198) DETZER, DOROTHY. Appointment on the Hill. New York: Henry Holt, 1948, 262 pp. (10891.aa.21) ENGELBRECHT, HELMUTH C. and FRANK C. HANIGHEN. Merchants of Death: A Study of the International Armament Industry. London: Routledge, 1934, 312 pp. (08425.ee.66) KAUFMAN, ROBERT G. Arms Control during the Pre-Nuclear Era: The United States and Naval Limitation between the Two World Wars. New York: Columbia University Press, 1990, 289 pp. (DSC 90/17239) O'CONNOR, RAYMOND G. Perilous Equilibrium: The United States and the London Naval Conference of 1930. Lawrence: University of Kansas Press, 1962, 188 pp. (X.631/523); New York: Greenwood, 1969, 188 pp. (X.800/4471) STEDMAN, MURRAY S. Exporting Arms: The Federal Arms Exports Administration, 1935-1945. New York: Kings Crown Press, 1947, 150 pp. (08425.f.99) UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF STATE. The London Naval Conference, 1935: Report of the Delegates of the United States of America, Text of the London Naval Treaty of 1936 and Other Documents. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Dept. of State, 1936, 444 pp. (A.S.420/45) WILTZ, JOHN E. In Search of Peace: The Senate Munitions Inquiry, 1934-1936. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1963, 277 pp. (X.631/703) E. IMMIGRATION, REFUGEES, JEWS AND THE HOLOCAUST [See also V.K.4. Social History: Racial and Ethnic Groups: Jews] ADAMIC, LOUIS. America and the Refugees. New York: Public Affairs Committee, 1939, 32 pp. (8288.f.13) BALDERRAMA, FRANCISCO E. In Defense of La Raza: The Los Angeles Mexican Consulate and the Mexican Community, 1929 to 1936. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1982, 137 pp. (YA.1989.a.16903) BALDERRAMA, FRANCISCO E. and RAYMOND RODRÍGUEZ. Decade of Betrayal: Mexican Repatriation in the 1930s. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1995, 283 pp. (DSC 95/30384) BAUER, YEHUDA. American Jewry and the Holocaust: The American Jewish Joint Distribution Committee, 1939-1945. Jerusalem: Institute of Contemporary Jewry, Hebrew University, 1981, 522 pp. (DSC 81/18775) 194 BAUER, YEHUDA. My Brother's Keeper: A History of the American Jewish Joint Distribution Committee, 1929-1939. Philadelphia: Jewish Publication Society of America, 1974, 350 pp. (X.809/43744) BERMAN, AARON. Nazism, the Jews and American Zionism, 1933-1948. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1990, 238 pp. (YA.1992.b.2475) BRECHER, FRANK W. Reluctant Ally: United States Foreign Policy toward the Jews from Wilson to Roosevelt. New York and London: Greenwood, 1991, 168 pp. (YC.1992.b.1264) CATT, CARRIE CHAPMAN. Asylum for Refugees under our Immigration Laws. New York: Committee of Ten, 1934, 32 pp. (8286.d.31) CHENG, LUCIE and EDNA BONACICH, eds. Labor Immigration under Capitalism: Asian Workers in the United States before World War II. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1984, 634pp. (X.800/41614) DAVIE, MAURICE R. World Immigration: With Special Reference to the United States. New York: Macmillan, 1936, 588 pp. (8287.c.19) DIVINE, ROBERT A. American Immigration Policy, 1924-1952. New Haven, Conn.: Yale University Press, 1957, 220 pp. (Ac.2692.md/3) FEINGOLD, HENRY L. The Politics of Rescue: The Roosevelt Administration and the Holocaust, 1938-1945. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1970, 394 pp. (X.800/6805) FERMI, LAURA. Illustrious Immigrants: The Intellectual Migration from Europe, 193041. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1968, 440 pp. (X.800/3238) FIELDS, HAROLD. The Refugee in the United States. New York: Oxford University Press, 1938, 229 pp. (08286.ee.33) FLEMING, DONALD and BERNARD BAILYN, eds. The Intellectual Migration, Europe and America, 1930-1960. Cambridge, Mass.: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1969, 748 pp. (X.800/3982) FRIEDMAN, SAUL S. No Haven for the Oppressed: United States Policy toward Jewish Refugees, 1938-1945. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1973, 315 pp. (X.800/11011) GUROCK, JEFFREY S., ed. America, American Jews and the Holocaust. New York and London: Routledge, 1998, 486 pp. (YC.1999.b.2665) ROSENTHAL, BERNARD M. The Gentle Invasion: Continental Emigré Booksellers of the Thirties and Forties and Their Impact on the Antiquarian Booktrade in the United States: 195 A Lecture Given 15 December 1986. New York: Book Arts Press, School of Library Service, Columbia University, 1987, 17 pp. (ORW.1986.a.3519 OIOC) HEILBUT, ANTHONY. Exiled in Paradise: German Refugee Artists and Intellectuals in America, from the 1930s to the Present. Berkeley and London: University of California Press, 1997, 524 pp. (YC.1998.a.67) HOFFMAN, ABRAHAM. Unwanted Mexican Americans in the Great Depression: Repatriation Pressures, 1929-1939. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1976, 207 pp. (X.700/25335) HUGHES, H. STUART. The Sea Change: The Migration of Social Thought, 19301965. New York and London: Harper and Row, 1975, 283 pp. (X.809/45874) KAUFMAN, MENAHEM. An Ambiguous Partnership: Non-Zionists and Zionists in America, 1939-1948. Jerusalem: Magnes Press, Hebrew University, 1991, 418 pp. (YA.1993.b.8665) KENT, DONALD P. The Refugee Intellectual: The Americanization of the Immigrants of 1933-1941. New York: Columbia University Press, 1953, 317 pp. (10414.cc.15) LIPSTADT, DEBORAH E. Beyond Belief: The American Press and the Coming of the Holocaust, 1933-1945. New York: Free Press, 1986, 370 pp. (DSC 85/35303) LOOKSTEIN, HASKEL. Were We Our Brothers' Keepers? The Public Response of American Jews to the Holocaust, 1938-1944. New York: Hartmore House, 1985, 287 pp. (DSC 86/10994) NAWYN, WILLIAM E. American Protestantism's Response to Germany's Jews and Refugees, 1933-1941. Ann Arbor, Mich.: UMI Research, 1981, 330 pp. (X.200/37416) NEWTON, VERNE W., ed. FDR and the Holocaust. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1996, 278 pp. (YA.1997.a.8147) REISLER, MARK. By the Sweat of Their Brow: Mexican Immigrant Labor in the United States, 1900-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 298 pp. (X.529/31635) ROSS, ROBERT W. So It Was True: The American Protestant Press and the Nazi Persecution of the Jews. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1980, 374 pp. (X.800/33555) SHAPIRO, HARRY L. Migration and Environment: A Study of the Physical Characteristics of the Japanese Immigrants to Hawaii and the Effects of Environment on Their Descendants. London: Oxford University Press, 1939, 594 pp. (10008.ppp.23) 196 STRAUSS, HERBERT A., ed. Jewish Immigrants of the Nazi Period in the USA. 6 vols. New York and London: Saur, 1978-1987. (vols. 1-3, 5-6: X.0800/1550; vol. 4: DSC 93/01718-9) UNITED JEWISH APPEAL. Report to American Jews on Overseas Relief, Palestine and Refugees in the United States. New York and London: Harper, 1942, 92 pp. (X.808/35095) WYMAN, DAVID S. Paper Walls: America and the Refugee Crisis, 1938-1941. Amherst: University of Massachusetts Press, 1968, 306 pp. (X.800/4942) F. SPECIFIC AREAS 1. Regions a. Asia ALDRICH, RICHARD J. The Key to the South: Britain, the United States and Thailand during the Approach of the Pacific War, 1929-1942. Kuala Lumpur, Oxford and New York: Oxford University Press, 1993, 416 pp. (YC.1993.a.4357) ANDERSON, IRVINE H., JR. The Standard-Vacuum Oil Company and United States East Asian Policy, 1933-1941. Princeton, N.J., and London: Princeton University Press, 1975, 260 pp. (X.809/40412) BEN-ZVI, ABRAHAM. The Illusion of Deterrence: The Roosevelt Presidency and the Origins of the Pacific War. Boulder, Colo., and London: Westview, 1987, 136pp. (YC.1988.a.6970) BISSON, T. A. American Policy in the Far East, 1931-1940. New York: International Secretariat, Institute of Pacific Relations, 1940, 162 pp. (09059.c.19.(1); 09059.c.19(2)) BORG, DOROTHY. The United States and the Far Eastern Crisis of 1933-1938: From the Manchurian Incident through the Initial Stage of the Undeclared Sino-Japanese War. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1964, 674 pp. (15235.a.99/14) BORG, DOROTHY and SHUMPEI OKAMOTO. Pearl Harbor as History: JapaneseAmerican Relations, 1931-1941. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1973, 801 pp. (Ac.2688.q./10.(22.); Ac.2688.q/10.(27.)) BURNS, RICHARD D. and EDWARD M. BENNETT, eds. Diplomats in Crisis: United States-Chinese-Japanese Relations, 1919-1941. Santa Barbara, Calif.: ABC-Clio, 1974, 346 pp. (X.800/25318) CONROY, HILARY and HARRY WRAY, eds. Pearl Harbor Reexamined: Prologue to the Pacific War. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press, 1990, 200 pp. (DSC 90/14786) 197 DOENECKE, JUSTUS D., comp. The Diplomacy of Frustration: The Manchurian Crisis of 1931-1933, as Revealed in the Papers of Stanley K. Hornbeck. Stanford, Calif.: Hoover Institution Press, 1981, 214 pp. (X.800/32705) DOENECKE, JUSTUS D. When the Wicked Rise: American Opinion-Makers and the Manchurian Crisis of 1931-1933. Lewisburg, Pa.: Bucknell University Press; Cranbury, N.J.: Associated University Presses, 1984, 188 pp. (DSC 84/09921) ESTHUS, RAYMOND A. From Enmity to Alliance: U.S.-Australian Relations, 19311941. Seattle: University of Washington Press, 1964, 180 pp. (X.709/4393) FEIS, HERBERT. The Road to Pearl Harbor: The Coming of War between the United States and Japan. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1950, 356 pp. (09059.k.2) GREW, JOSEPH C. Ten Years in Japan. London: Hammond, 1944, 480 pp. (09059.b.19; T3342); New York: Simon and Schuster, 1944, 554 pp. (9059.df.35) GREW, JOSEPH C. Turbulent Era: A Diplomatic Record of Forty Years, 1904-1945. Edited by Walter Johnson. 2 vols. London: Hammond, 1953. (10889.b.27) GRISWOLD, A. WHITNEY. The Far Eastern Policy of the United States. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1939, 530 pp. (Ac.2692.mef.(1)) HEINRICHS, WALDO H. American Ambassador: Joseph C. Grew and the Development of the United States Diplomatic Tradition. Boston and Toronto: Little, Brown, 1966, 460 pp. (X.800/4038); New York and Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1986, 460 pp. (YC.1987.a.10183) HERZOG, JAMES H. Closing the Open Door: American-Japanese Diplomatic Negotiations, 1936-1941. Annapolis, Md.: Naval Institute Press, 1973, 295 pp. (YA.1989.b.7911) IRIYE, AKIRA. After Imperialism: The Search for a New Order in the Far East, 19211931. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1965, 375 pp. (15235.a.99/22) IRIYE, AKIRA. The Origins of the Second World War in Asia and the Pacific. London: Longman, 1987, 375 pp. (YC.1987.a.4422; YK.1989.a.772) IRIYE, AKIRA and WARREN COHEN, eds. American, Chinese and Japanese Perspectives on Wartime Asia, 1931-1939. Wilmington, Del.: SR Books, 1990, 308 pp. (DSC 90/16191) JOHNSTONE, WILLIAM C. The United States and Japan's New Order. Rev. ed., New York: Oxford University Press, 1941, 403 pp. (9010.bb.15) KESARIS, PAUL. The MAGIC Documents: Summaries and Transcripts of the Top Secret Diplomatic Communications of Japan, 1938-1945. Washington, D.C.: University Publications of America, 1980. (SPR.MIC.A.169; OPL327.52) 198 KOGINOS, MANNY T. The Panay Incident: Prelude to War. Lafayette, Ind.: Purdue University Studies, 1967, 154 pp. (X.800/6594) KUHL, STANLEY. The United States and the Far East: Certain Fundamentals of Policy. Boston: World Peace Foundation, 1942, 100 pp. (08175.bb.30) LOCKWOOD, WILLIAM W. Trade and Trade Rivalry between the United States and Japan. New York: Institute of Pacific Relations, 1936, 66 pp. (Ac.1915.b) MODELL, JOHN. The Economics and Politics of Racial Accommodation: The Japanese of Los Angeles, 1900-1942. Urbana and London: University of Illinois Press, 1977, 201 pp. (X.520/12488) NEU, CHARLES E. The Troubled Encounter: The United States and Japan. New York: Wiley, 1975, 257 pp. (X.809/20607) POOLE, PETER A. The United States and Indochina, from FDR to Nixon. Hinsdale, Ill.: Dryden Press, 1973, 247 pp. (X.709/16088) RAPPAPORT, ARMIN. Henry L. Stimson and Japan, 1931-33. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1963, 238 pp. (9458.k.9) SCHALLER, MICHAEL. The U.S. Crusade in China, 1938-1945. New York and Guildford: Columbia University Press, 1979, 364 pp. (X.800/27574; X.809/52217) SCHROEDER, PAUL W. The Axis Alliance and Japanese-American Relations, 1941. Ithaca, N.Y.: published for the American Historical Association by Cornell University Press, 1958, 246 pp. (9103.w.5) SCHWARTZ, BRUNO. The Story of Japan in China, As Told in American Cartoons. New York: Trans-Pacific News Service, 1938, 30 pp. (20032.h.10) SHAPIRO, HARRY L. Migration and Environment: A Study of the Physical Characteristics of the Japanese Immigrants to Hawaii and the Effects of Environment on Their Descendants. London: Oxford University Press, 1939, 594 pp. (10008.ppp.23) STIMSON, HENRY L. The Far Eastern Crisis: Recollections and Observations. New York and London: Harper, 1936, 293 pp. (9059.cc.26) THOMSON, JAMES CLAUDE. While China Faced West: American Reformers in Nationalist China, 1928-1937. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1969, 310 pp. (15235.a.99/38); Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1974, 310 pp. (15235.a.99/38.(2.)) THORNE, CHRISTOPHER G. The Limits of Foreign Policy: The West, the League and the Far Eastern Crisis of 1931-1933. London: Hamilton, 1972, 442 pp. (X.800/7278); London: Macmillan, 1973, 442 pp. (X.700/14315) 199 TUCHMAN, BARBARA W. Sand Against the Wind: Stilwell and the American Experience in China, 1911-45. London: Macdonald Futura, 1981, 794 pp. (X.808/34465) UTLEY, JONATHAN G. Going to War with Japan, 1937-1941. Knoxville: University of Tennessee Press, 1985, 238 pp. (YA.1988.a.18306) WAKUKAWA, ERNEST K. A History of the Japanese People in Hawaii. Honolulu: Toyo Shoin, 1938, 439 pp. (YA.1987.a.9620) b. Europe ADAMS, DAVID K. FDR, The New Deal and Europe: Inaugural Lecture. Keele: University of Keele, 1974, 9 pp. (X.709/30023) CLAVIN, PATRICIA. The Failure of Economic Diplomacy: Britain, Germany, France and the United States, 1931-36. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1996, 279 pp. (YC.1996.a.640) COSTIGLIOLA, FRANK. Awkward Dominion: American Political, Economic and Cultural Relations with Europe, 1919-1933. Ithaca, N.Y.: Cornell University Press, 1984, 381 pp. (DSC 85/08141) GRAEBNER, NORMAN A. Roosevelt and the Search for a European Policy, 19371939: An Inaugural Lecture Delivered before the University of Oxford on 21 May 1979. Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1980, 47 pp. (X.809/51313) JONES, KENNETH P., ed. U.S. Diplomats in Europe, 1919-1941. Santa Barbara, Calif., and Oxford: ABC-Clio, 1981, 240 pp. (X.800/31889) PAYNE, HOWARD C., RAYMOND CALLAHAN and EDWARD M. BENNETT. As the Storm Clouds Gathered: European Perceptions of American Foreign Policy in the 1930s. Durham, N.C.: Moore Pub. Co., 1979, 173 pp. (YC.1987.b.77) PEASE, NEAL. Poland, the United States and the Stabilization of Europe, 1919-1933. New York: Oxford University Press, 1986, 238 pp. (YH.1988.b.386) c. Middle East ANDERSON, IRVINE H. Aramco, the United States and Saudi Arabia: A Study of the Dynamics of Foreign Oil Policy, 1933-1950. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1981, 259 pp. (X.529/43326; T44152 OIOC) BARAM, PHILIP J. The Department of State in the Middle East, 1919-1945. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press, 1978, 343 pp. (X.800/36932) BERMAN, AARON. Nazism, the Jews and American Zionism, 1933-1948. Detroit, Mich.: Wayne State University Press, 1990, 238 pp. (YA.1992.b.2475) 200 DENOVO, JOHN A. American Interests and Policies in the Middle East, 1900-1939. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1963, 447 pp. (8184.n.4) d. Western Hemisphere BEMIS, SAMUEL FLAGG. The Latin American Policy of the United States: An Historical Interpretation. New York: Harcourt, Brace, 1943, 470 pp. (Ac.2692.mef.(5.)) BUSHNELL, DAVID. Eduardo Santos and the Good Neighbor, 1938-1942. Gainesville: University of Florida Press, 1967, 128 pp. (Ac.2687.hb/2) CONN, STETSON and BYRON FAIRCHILD. The Framework of Hemispheric Defense. Washington, D.C.: Office of the Chief of Military History, Dept. of the Army, 1960, 470 pp. (A.S.742/14) CURRY, E. R. Hoover's Dominican Diplomacy and the Origins of the Good Neighbor Policy. New York: Garland, 1979, 277 pp. (YA.1986.a.2157) DE CONDE, ALEXANDER. Herbert Hoover's Latin-American Policy. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1951; London: Oxford University Press, 1951, 154 pp. (Ac.2692.n/12.(21.)) DOZER, DONALD M. Are We Good Neighbors? Three Decades of Inter-American Relations, 1930-1960. Gainesville: University of Florida Press, 1961, 456 pp. (X.809/28662) FEJES, FRED. Imperialism, Media and the Good Neighbor: New Deal Foreign Policy and United States Shortwave Broadcasting to Latin America. Norwood, N.J.: Ablex Pub. Corp., 1986, 190 pp. (DSC 86/23843) FRYE, ALTON. Nazi Germany and the American Hemisphere, 1933-1941. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1967, 229 pp. (Ac.2692.md/3) GELLMAN, IRWIN F. Good Neighbor Diplomacy: United States Policies in Latin America, 1933-1945. Baltimore, Md.: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1979, 296 pp. (X.800/34438) GREEN, DAVID. The Containment of Latin America: A History of the Myths and Realities of the Good Neighbor Policy. Chicago: Quadrangle Books, 1971, 370 pp. (X.809/16033) GROW, MICHAEL. The Good Neighbor Policy and Authoritarianism in Paraguay: United States Economic Expansion and Great-Power Rivalry in Latin America during World War II. Lawrence, Kans.: Regents Press of Kansas, 1981, 163 pp. (DSC 81/21591) GUERRANT, EDWARD O. Roosevelt's Good Neighbor Policy. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1950, 235 pp. (X.800/15109) 201 HILTON, STANLEY E. Brazil and the Great Powers, 1930-1939: The Politics of Trade Rivalry. Austin and London: University of Texas Press, 1976, 304 pp. (X.800/12344; X.0700/112 (38)) HILTON, STANLEY E. Hitler's Secret War in South America, 1939-1945: German Military Espionage and Allied Counterespionage in Brazil. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1981, 353 pp. (X.800/30692) KAMMAN, WILLIAM. A Search for Stability: United States Diplomacy towards Nicaragua, 1925-1933. Notre Dame and London: University of Notre Dame Press, 1968, 263 pp. (Ac.2692.wda.(27.)) KOFAS, JON V. The Struggle for Legitimacy: Latin American Labor and the United States, 1930-1960. Tempe: Center for Latin American Studies, Arizona State University, 1992, 425 pp. (YA.1992.b.2973; YA.1993.a.2203) LANGLEY, LESTER D. The Banana Wars: An Inner History of American Empire, 1900-1934. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1983, 255 pp. (X.800/38061); The Banana Wars: United States Intervention in the Caribbean, 1898-1934. Rev. ed., Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1985, 255 pp. (DSC 86/23941) MCCANN, FRANK D. The Brazilian-American Alliance, 1937-1945. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1973, 527 pp. (X.809/18078) MUNRO, DANA G. The United States and the Caribbean Republics, 1921-1933. Princeton, N.J., and London: Princeton University Press, 1974, 394 pp. (X.800/9532) NEWTON, WESLEY P. The Perilous Sky: U.S. Aviation Diplomacy and Latin America, 1919-1931. Coral Gables, Fla.: University of Miami Press, 1978, 457 pp. (X.629/21066) O'BRIEN, THOMAS F. The Revolutionary Mission: American Business in Latin America, 1900-1945. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1996, 356 pp. (YC.1996.b.4280) RANDALL, STEPHEN J. The Diplomacy of Modernization: Colombian-American Relations, 1920-1940. Toronto: University of Toronto Press, 1977, 239 pp. (X.800/37529) SCHMIDT, HANS. The United States Occupation of Haiti, 1915-1934. New Brunswick, N.J.: Rutgers University Press, 1971, 303 pp. (X.800/8232) SCHWOCH, JAMES. The American Radio Industry and Its Latin American Activities, 1900-1939. Urbana: University of Illinois Press, 1990, 184 pp. (YA.1993.b.4521) SPECTOR, ROBERT M. W. Cameron Forbes and the Hoover Commissions to Haiti (1930). Lanham, Md., and London: University Press of America, 1985, 258 pp. (X.800/42761) 202 STEWARD, DICK. Trade and Hemisphere: The Good Neighbor Policy and Reciprocal Trade. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1975, 307 pp. (X.520/11498) WOOD, BRYCE. The Making of the Good Neighbor Policy. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1961, 438 pp. (9526.h.1) WOOD, BRYCE. The United States and Latin American Wars, 1932-1942. New York and London: Columbia University Press, 1966, 519 pp. (X.700/1466) 2. Countries a. Canada DRUMMOND, IAN and NORMAN HILLMER. Negotiating Freer Trade: The United Kingdom, the United States, Canada and the Free Trade Agreements of 1938. Waterloo, Ont.: Wilfred Laurier University Press, 1989, 197 pp. (DSC 89/l4851) DZIUBAN, STANLEY W. Military Relations between the United States and Canada, 1939-1945. Washington, D.C.: Office of the Chief of Military History, Dept. of the Army, 1959, 432 pp. (A.S.7412/13.(4.)) PERRAS, GALEN R. Franklin Roosevelt and the Origins of the Canadian-American Security Alliance, 1933-1945: Necessary, but Not Necessary Enough. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1998, 156 pp. (DSC 98/17824) b. Cuba FITZGIBBON, RUSSELL H. Cuba and the United States, 1900-1935. Menasha: Banta Pub. Co., 1935, 311 pp. (9771.r.4) GELLMAN, IRWIN F. Roosevelt and Batista: Good Neighbor Diplomacy in Cuba, 1933-1945. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1973, 303 pp. (X.800/11126) SMITH, ROBERT F. The United States and Cuba: Business and Diplomacy, 1917-60. New York: Bookman Associates, 1962, 256 pp. (9477.1.19) c. France ALLEN, DONALD R. French Views of America in the 1930s. New York: Garland, 1979, 348 pp. (X.809/52112) HAIGHT, JOHN M. American Aid to France, 1938-1940. New York: Atheneum, 1970, 278 pp. (X.809/12960) LEFFLER, MELVYN P. The Elusive Quest: America's Pursuit of European Stability and French Security, 1919-1933. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1979, 409 pp. (X.800/30873) 203 ROSSI, MARIO. Roosevelt and the French. Westport, Conn., and London: Praeger, 1993, 193 pp. (YC.1994.b.3631) d. Intellectual Olympics] Germany [See also VI.M.2. Cultural and History: Leisure, Recreation and Sports: ABBAZIA, PATRICK. Mr. Roosevelt's Navy: The Private War of the U.S. Atlantic Fleet, 1939-1942. Annapolis, Md.: Naval Institute Press, 1975, 520 pp. (X.800/28435) BAILEY, THOMAS A. and PAUL B. RYAN. Hitler vs. Roosevelt: The Undeclared Naval War. London: Free Press, 1979, 303 pp. (X.800/31511) BELL, LELAND V. In Hitler's Shadow: The Anatomy of American Nazism. Port Washington, N.Y., and London: Kennikat Press, 1973, 135 pp. (X.800/8554) BENNETT, EDWARD W. German Rearmament and the West, 1932-1933. Princeton, N.J., and Guildford: Princeton University Press, 1979, 569 pp. (X.800/28865) COMPTON, JAMES V. The Swastika and the Eagle: Hitler, the United States and the Origins of the Second World War. London: Bodley Head, 1968, 297 pp. (X.709/6483) DALLEK, ROBERT. Democrat and Diplomat: The Life of William E. Dodd. New York: Oxford University Press, 1968, 415 pp. (X.709/9014) DODD, WILLIAM E. Ambassador Dodd's Diary, 1933-1938. Edited by William E. Dodd, Jr., and Martha Dodd. London: Gollancz, 1941, 452 pp. (9101.b.1) FARNHAM, BARBARA R. Roosevelt and the Munich Crisis: A Study of Political Decision-making. Princeton, N.J., and Chichester: Princeton University Press, 1997, 313 pp. (YC.1998.b.2213) FRIEDLÄNDER, SAUL. Prelude to Downfall: Hitler and the United States, 1939-1941. Translated by Aline B. and Alexander Werth. London: Chatto & Windus, 1967, 328 pp. (X.709/6359) FRYE, ALTON. Nazi Germany and the American Hemisphere, 1933-1941. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1967, 229 pp. (Ac.2692.md/3) GOTTLIEB, MOSHE R. American Anti-Nazi Resistance, 1933-1941: An Historical Analysis. New York: Ktav Pub. House, 1982, 426 pp. (X.800/38794) HART-DAVIS, DUFF. Hitler's Games: The 1936 Olympics. London: Century, 1986, 256 pp. (YC.1986.a.1658); Sevenoaks: Coronet, 1988, 256 pp. (YC.1988.a.9545) 204 HEARDEN, PATRICK J. Roosevelt Confronts Hitler: America's Entry into World War II. De Kalb: Northern Illinois University Press, 1987, 328 pp. (YH.1988.a.651) HERZSTEIN, ROBERT E. Roosevelt and Hitler: Prelude to War. New York: Paragon House, 1989, 500 pp. (YA.1991.b.9287); New York and Chichester: Wiley, 1994, 500 pp. (YA.1997.a.1626) HIGHAM, CHARLES. Trading with the Enemy: An Exposé of the Nazi-American Money Plot, 1933-1949. London: Hale, 1983, 277 pp. (X.809/57463) HILTON, STANLEY E. Hitler's Secret War in South America, 1939-1945: German Military Espionage and Allied Counterespionage in Brazil. Baton Rouge and London: Louisiana State University Press, 1981, 353 pp. (X.800/30692) LOCHNER, LOUIS P. Herbert Hoover and Germany. New York: Macmillan, 1960, 244 pp. (9196.1.27) MANDELL, RICHARD D. The Nazi Olympics. London: Souvenir Press, 1972, 316 pp. (X.629/4437) OFFNER, ARNOLD A. American Appeasement: United States Foreign Policy and Germany, 1933-1938. Cambridge, Mass.: Belknap Press of Harvard University Press, 1969, 328 pp. (X.700/3893); New York: Norton, 1976, 328 pp. (X.708/22291) OLYMPIC GAMES. Olympic Games 1936: Official Organ of the XI. Olympic Games Berlin 1936, no. 15, 88 pp. (Cup.1264.hh.33) SCHUKER, STEPHEN A. American 'Reparations' to Germany, 1919-33: Implications for Third World Debt Crisis. Princeton, N.J.: Dept. of Economics, Princeton University, 1988, 170 pp. (DSC 6612.955 61) SCHULER, FRIEDRICH E. Mexico Between Hitler and Roosevelt: Mexican Foreign Relations in the Age of Lázaro Cárdenas, 1934-1940. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1998, 269 pp. (DSC 98/20039) SMITH, ARTHUR L. The Deutschtum of Nazi Germany and the United States. The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff, 1965, 172 pp. (W.P.2005/16) TURROU, LEON G. The Nazi Spy Conspiracy in America. London: Harrap, 1939, 276 pp. (20032.h.39) WILSON, HUGH R. A Career Diplomat; The Third Chapter: The Third Reich. Edited by Hugh Wilson, Jr. New York: Vantage Press, 1960, 112 pp. (X.708/618) ZALAMPAS, MICHAEL. Adolf Hitler and the Third Reich in American Magazines, 1923-1939. Bowling Green, Ohio: Bowling Green State University Popular Press, 1989, 266 pp. (YA.1992.b.1543) e. Italy 205 DIGGINS, JOHN P. Mussolini and Fascism: The View from America. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1972, 524 pp. (X.800/6545) HARRIS, BRICE. The United States and the Italo-Ethiopian Crisis. Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1964, 187 pp. (X.709/4620) HARRIS, JOSEPH E. African-American Reactions to War in Ethiopia, 1936-1941. Baton Rouge: Louisiana State University Press, 1994, 185 pp. (YC.1996.b.46) SALVEMINI, GAETANO. Italian Fascist Activities in the United States. New York: Center for Migration Studies, 1977, 267 pp. (X.800/15021) SCHMITZ, DAVID F. The United States and Fascist Italy, 1922-1940. Chapel Hill and London: University of North Carolina Press, 1988, 273 pp. (YH.1988.b.929) SCOTT, WILLIAM R. The Sons of Sheba's Race: African Americans and the ItaloEthiopian War, 1935-1941. Bloomington: Indiana University Press, 1993, 288 pp. (ORW.1993.a.2504 OIOC) f. Mexico BALDERRAMA, FRANCISCO E. In Defense of La Raza: The Los Angeles Mexican Consulate and the Mexican Community, 1929 to 1936. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1982, 137 pp. (YA.1989.a.16903) BALDERRAMA, FRANCISCO E. and RAYMOND RODRÍGUEZ. Decade of Betrayal: Mexican Repatriation in the 1930s. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1995, 283 pp. (DSC 95/30384) BODAYLA, STEPHEN D. Financial Diplomacy: The United States and Mexico, 19191933. New York and London: Garland, 1987, 216 pp. (YC.1988.a.8196) HOFFMAN, ABRAHAM. Unwanted Mexican Americans in the Great Depression: Repatriation Pressures, 1929-1939. Tucson: University of Arizona Press, 1976, 207 pp. (X.700/25335) KNIGHT, ALAN. U.S.-Mexican Relations, 1910-1940: An Interpretation. San Diego: Center for U.S. Mexican Studies, University of California, San Diego, 1987, 149 pp. (DSC 5917.1275 28) MEYER, LORENZO. Mexico and the United States in the Oil Controversy, 1917-1942. Austin and London: University of Texas Press, 1977, 367 pp. (X.320/11064) REISLER, MARK. By the Sweat of Their Brow: Mexican Immigrant Labor in the United States, 1900-1940. Westport, Conn., and London: Greenwood, 1976, 298 pp. (X.529/31635) 206 SCHULER, FRIEDRICH E. Mexico Between Hitler and Roosevelt: Mexican Foreign Relations in the Age of Lázaro Cárdenas, 1934-1940. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press, 1998, 269 pp. (DSC 98/20039) SMITH, ROBERT F. The United States and Revolutionary Nationalism in Mexico, 1916-1932. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1972, 288 pp. (X.809/15728) g. Spain BOWERS, CLAUDE G. My Mission to Spain: Watching the Rehearsal for World War II. London: Gollancz, 1954, 437 pp. (08042.c.41) GERASSI, JOHN. The Premature Antifascists: North American Volunteers in the Spanish Civil War, 1936-39: An Oral History. New York: Praeger, 1986, 275 pp. (DSC 86/13735) GUTTMANN, ALLEN, ed. American Neutrality and the Spanish Civil War. Boston: Heath, 1963, 115 pp. (9196.k.5/39) GUTTMANN, ALLEN. The Wound in the Heart: America and the Spanish Civil War. New York: Free Press of Glencoe, 1962, 292 pp. (9317.h.14) JOHNSTON, VERLE B. Legions of Babel: The International Brigades in the Spanish Civil War. University Park and London: Pennsylvania State University Press, 1967, 228 pp. (X.709/6315) LANDIS, ARTHUR H. The Abraham Lincoln Brigade. New York: Citadel Press, 1967, 677 pp. (X.639/3014) LITTLE, DOUGLAS. Malevolent Neutrality: The United States, Great Britain and the Origins of the Spanish Civil War. Ithaca, N.Y., and London: Cornell University Press, 1985, 290 pp. (YH.1988.b.628) RICHARDSON, R. DAN. Comintern Army: The International Brigades and the Spanish Civil War. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1982, 232 pp. (X.809/57466) ROSENSTONE, ROBERT ALLAN. Crusade of the Left: The Lincoln Battalion in the Spanish Civil War. New York: Pegasus, 1969, 415 pp. (X.809/12079) TAYLOR, F. JAY. The United States and the Spanish Civil War. New York: Bookman Associates, 1956, 288 pp. (9617.e.24) TRAINA, RICHARD PAUL. American Diplomacy and the Spanish Civil War. Bloomington and London: Indiana University Press, 1968, 301 pp. (X.700/3435) h. Turkey 207 TRASK, ROGER R. The United States Response to Turkish Nationalism and Reform, 1914-1939. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1971, 280 pp. (X.800/5541) i. III.I.3. Movements Union of Soviet Socialist Republics [See also Government and Politics: Opposition and Protest Movements: Communism] BENNETT, EDWARD M. Franklin D. Roosevelt and the Search for Security: AmericanSoviet Relations, 1933-1939. Wilmington, Del.: Scholarly Resources, 1985, 213 pp. (DSC 86/00257) BENNETT, EDWARD M. Franklin D. Roosevelt and the Search for Victory: AmericanSoviet Relations, 1939-1945. Wilmington, Del.: SR Books, 1990, 207 pp. (YA.1992.b.4128) BENSON, ROBERT L. and MICHAEL WARNER, eds. Venona: Soviet Espionage and the American Response, 1939-1957. Laguna Hills, Calif.: Aegean Park, 1996, 450 pp. (DSC 3490.15546 75) BISHOP, DONALD GORDON. The Roosevelt-Litvinov Agreements: The American View. Syracuse, N.Y.: Syracuse University Press, 1965, 297 pp. (X.700/1700) BROWDER, ROBERT P. The Origins of Soviet-American Diplomacy. Princeton, N.J.: Princeton University Press, 1953, 256 pp. (8096.c.13) BUEHLER, E. C., comp. Selected Articles on Recognition of Soviet Russia. New York: Wilson, 1931, 387 pp. (Mic.A.17154) DAVIES, JOSEPH E. Mission to Moscow. London: Gollancz, 1942, 415 pp. (09455.df.55) DE SANTIS, HUGH. The Diplomacy of Silence: The American Foreign Service, the Soviet Union and the Cold War, 1933-1947. Chicago and London: University of Chicago Press, 1980, 270 pp. (X.800/30471) DUNN, DENNIS J. Caught Between Roosevelt and Stalin: American Ambassadors to Moscow. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1998, 394 pp. (DSC 98/07638) EAGLES, KEITH D. Ambassador Joseph E. Davies and American-Soviet Relations, 19371941. New York: Garland, 1985, 371 pp. (YC.1988.a.8129) FARNSWORTH, BEATRICE. William C. Bullitt and the Soviet Union. Bloomington and London: Indiana University Press, 1967, 244 pp. (X.709/5813) FILENE, PETER G. Americans and the Soviet Experiment, 1917-1933. Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, 1967, 389 pp. (X.709/5783) 208 FILENE, PETER G., ed. American Views of Soviet Russia, 1917-1965. Homewood, Ill.: Dorsey Press, 1968, 404 pp. (X.709/13683) GRAHAM, OTIS L., JR., ed. Soviet-American Dialogue on the New Deal. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1989, 296 pp. (DSC 8359.0769 vol 1) HAYNES, JOHN E. and HARVEY KLEHR. Venona: Decoding Soviet Espionage in America. New Haven, Conn., and London: Yale University Press, 1999, 487 pp. (YC.1999.b.4337) FISCHER, LOUIS. Why Recognize Russia? The Arguments for and against the Recognition of the Soviet Government by the United States. New York: J. Cape & H. Smith, 1931, 298 pp. (8094.dd.16) LEFFLER, MELVYN P. The Spector of Communism: The United States and the Origins of the Cold War, 1917-1953. New York: Hill and Wang, 1994, 147 pp. (DSC 94/25447) LEVERING, RALPH B. American Opinion and the Russian Alliance, 1939-1945. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 1976, 262 pp. (X.800/14688) LOVENSTEIN, MENO. American Opinion of Soviet Russia. Washington, D.C.: American Council on Public Affairs, 1941, 210 pp. (8093.d.55) MORRIS, M. WAYNE. Stalin's Famine and Roosevelt's Recognition of Russia. Lanham, Md., and London: University Press of America, 1994, 224 pp. (YC.1994.a.3581) PILARSKI, KIM, translator. Soviet-U.S. Relations, 1933-1942. Moscow: Progress Pub., 1989, 315 pp. (YA.1993.a.12024) REYNOLDS, DAVID, WARREN F. KIMBALL and A. O. CHUBARIAN, eds. Allies at War: The Soviet, American and British Experience, 1939-1945. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1994, 456 pp. (YC.1994.a.1662) RICHMAN, JOHN. The United States and the Soviet Union: The Decision to Recognize. Raleigh, N.C.: Camberleigh & Hall, 1980, 287 pp. (DSC 80/15464) SIEGEL, KATHERINE A. S. Loans and Legitimacy: The Evolution of Soviet-American Relations, 1919-1933. Lexington: University Press of Kentucky, 1996, 211 pp. (DSC 96/25424) SOBEL, ROBERT. The Origins of Interventionism: The United States and the RussoFinnish War. New York: Bookman Associates, 1960, 204 pp. (X.709/838) WILSON, JOAN HOFF. Ideology and Economics: U.S. Relations with the Soviet Union, 1918-1933. Columbia: University of Missouri Press, 1974, 192 pp. (X.529/20092) j. United Kingdom 209 BESCHLOSS, MICHAEL R. Kennedy and Roosevelt: The Uneasy Alliance. New York: Norton, 1980, 318 pp. (X.800/35375) COWMAN, IAN. Dominion or Decline: Anglo-American Naval Relations on the Pacific, 1937-1941. Oxford: Berg, 1996, 327 pp. (YC.1997.a.3278) DE BEDTS, RALPH F. Ambassador Joseph Kennedy, 1938-1940: An Anatomy of Appeasement. New York: Lang, 1985, 263 pp. (YA.1990.a.10160) DIZIKES, JOHN. Britain, Roosevelt and the New Deal: British Opinion 1932-1938. New York and London: Garland, 1979, 330 pp. (X.800/32899) DRUMMOND, IAN and NORMAN HILLMER. Negotiating Freer Trade: The United Kingdom, the United States, Canada and the Free Trade Agreements of 1938. Waterloo, Ont.: Wilfred Laurier University Press, 1989, 197 pp. (DSC 89/l4851) KREIDER, CARL J. The Anglo-American Trade Agreement: A Study of British and American Commercial Policies, 1934-1939. Princeton, N.J.: Dept. of Economics and Social Institutions, Princeton University, 1943, 270 pp. (Ac.1833.ga) LASH, JOSEPH P. Roosevelt and Churchill, 1939-1941: The Partnership that Saved the West. London: Deutsch, 1977, 528 pp. (X.800/26202) LEUTZE, JAMES. Bargaining for Supremacy: Anglo-American Naval Collaboration, 1937-1941. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina, 1977, 328 pp. (X.800/28720) MACDONALD, CALLUM A. The United States, Britain and Appeasement, 19361939. London: Macmillan in association with St. Antony's College, Oxford, 1981, 220 pp. (X.809/49136) REYNOLDS, DAVID. The Creation of the Anglo-American Alliance, 1937-41: A Study in Competitive Co-operation. London: Europa, 1981, 397 pp. (X.800/32101) REYNOLDS, DAVID. Lord Lothian and Anglo-American Relations, 1939-1940. Philadelphia: American Philosophical Society, 1983, 65 pp. (Ac.1830/3) REYNOLDS, DAVID, WARREN F. KIMBALL and A. O. CHUBARIAN, eds. Allies at War: The Soviet, American and British Experience, 1939-1945. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1994, 456 pp. (YC.1994.a.1662) ROCK, WILLIAM R. Chamberlain and Roosevelt: British Foreign Policy and the United States, 1937-1940. Columbus: Ohio State University Press, 1988, 330 pp. (YH.1989.b.791) ROWLAND, BENJAMIN M. Commercial Conflict and Foreign Policy: A Study in Anglo-American Relations, 1932-1938. New York: Garland, 1987, 431 pp. (YC.1988.a.8209) 210 WEISS, STEVE. Allies in Conflict: Anglo-American Strategic Negotiations, 1938-1944. Basingstoke: Macmillan, 1996, 213 pp. (YC.1997.a.798) 211 A special grant from the late Viscount Eccles helped to fund the compilation of The United States and the 1930s: A Selective Guide to Materials in the British Library. The guide's distribution has been made possible through a donation by current and former members of the Council of the Grolier Club of New York, in memory of the late Viscount and as a token of its respect and affection for his widow, Mary. 212